Elite IPK II Programming Manual
Elite IPK II Programming Manual
Note that when converting this document from its original format to a .pdf file, some minor font and format changes may occur causing slight variations. When viewing and printing this document, we cannot guarantee that your specific PC or printer will support all of the fonts or graphics. Therefore, when you view the document fonts may be substituted and your individual printer may not have the capability to print the document correctly.
PROGRAMMING MANUAL
NEC Unified Solutions, Inc. reserves the right to change the specifications, functions, or features at any time without notice. NEC Unified Solutions, Inc. has prepared this document for use by its employees and customers. The information contained herein is the property of NEC Unified Solutions, Inc. and shall not be reproduced without prior written approval of NEC Unified Solutions, Inc. Dterm is a registered trademark of NEC Corporation and Electra Elite is a registered trademark of NEC America, Inc. Windows is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation. AT&T is a registered trademark of American Telephone and Telegraph Company. Lucent Technologies is a trademark or service mark of Lucent Technologies Inc. Nortel Networks and the Nortel Networks logo are trademarks of Nortel Networks.
Copyright 2006
Preface
THIS MANUAL
The Programming Manual provides the technician with all of the necessary information for programming the Electra Elite IPK II system. Programming can be accomplished using a PC or a Multiline Terminal.
SUPPORTING DOCUMENTS
Electra Elite IPK II General Description Manual This Manual provides general information about the system, its features, system configuration and standards. This manual provides an overview of the Electra Elite IPK II system and can be used to present information to potential customers. Electra Elite IPK II System Hardware Manual The System Hardware Manual is provided for the system installer. This manual has detailed instructions for installing the Electra Elite IPK II KSU, ETUs, Multiline Terminals, and optional equipment. Electra Elite IPK II Features and Specifications Manual This manual provides detailed information for each of the system features. If you are not familiar with the features, the Table of Contents lists each of the features and where to find the feature within the manual. Electra Elite IPK II Key-Common Channel Interoffice Signaling (K-CCIS) Manual This manual provides information installing and programming the Key-Common Channel Interoffice Signaling (K-CCIS) System.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
___________________________________________________________________________________
Chapter 1
Section 1 Section 2 Section 3 Section 4 Section 5 Section 6 Section 7 Section 8 Section 9
Introduction
Before You Start Programming ......................................................... 1-1 How to Use Manual ............................................................................. 1-1 How to Enter Programming Mode ..................................................... 1-2 How to Exit Programming Mode ....................................................... 1-3 Using Keys to Move Around in the Programs ................................. 1-4 Programming Names and Text Messages ....................................... 1-5 Using Softkeys For Programming .................................................... 1-6 What the Softkey Display Prompts Mean ......................................... 1-7 System Number Plan/Capacities ....................................................... 1-8
Chapter 2
Section 1
___________________________________________________________________________________ Programming i
Document Revision 1 Electra Elite IPK II ___________________________________________________________________________________ 10-14 : Managed Network Setup ......................................................... 2-21 10-15 : Client Information Setup .......................................................... 2-22 10-16 : Option Information Setup ........................................................ 2-23 10-20 : LAN Setup for External Equipment ......................................... 2-25 10-21 : CPUII Hardware Setup ............................................................ 2-26 10-24 : Daylight Savings Setup ........................................................... 2-27 10-38 : BGM Resource Setup ............................................................. 2-29 Program 11 : System Numbering 11-01 : System Numbering .................................................................. 2-31 11-02 : Extension Numbering .............................................................. 2-40 11-04 : Virtual Extension Numbering ................................................... 2-42 11-06 : ACI Extension Numbering ....................................................... 2-44 11-07 : Department Group Pilot Numbers ........................................... 2-45 11-08 : ACI Group Pilot Number .......................................................... 2-46 11-09 : Trunk Access Code ................................................................. 2-47 11-10 : Service Code Setup (for System Administrator) ...................... 2-49 11-11 : Service Code Setup (for Setup/Entry Operation) .................... 2-52 11-12 : Service Code Setup (for Service Access) ............................... 2-56 11-13 : Service Code Setup (for ACD) ................................................ 2-60 11-14 : Service Code Setup (for Hotel) ............................................... 2-62 11-15 : Service Code Setup, Administrative (for Special Access) ....... 2-64 11-16 : Single Digit Service Code Setup ............................................. 2-66 11-17 : ACD Group Pilot Number ........................................................ 2-68 Program 12 : Night Mode Setup 12-01 : Night Mode Function Setup ..................................................... 2-69 12-02 : Automatic Night Service .......................................................... 2-70 12-03 : Weekly Night Service Switching .............................................. 2-72 12-04 : Holiday Night Service Switching .............................................. 2-74 12-05 : Night Mode Group Assignment for Extensions ....................... 2-75 12-06 : Night Mode Group Assignment for Trunks .............................. 2-76 12-07 : Text Data for Night Mode ........................................................ 2-77 ___________________________________________________________________________________ ii Table of Contents
Electra Elite IPK II Document Revision 1 ___________________________________________________________________________________ 12-08 : Night Mode Service Range ...................................................... 2-78 Program 13 : Speed Dialing 13-01 : Speed Dialing Option Setup .................................................... 2-79 13-02 : Group Speed Dialing Bins ....................................................... 2-80 13-03 : Speed Dialing Group Assignment for Extensions ....................2-81 13-04 : Speed Dialing Number and Name ........................................... 2-82 13-05 : Speed Dial Trunk Group .......................................................... 2-84 Program 14 : Trunk, Basic Setup 14-01 : Basic Trunk Data Setup ........................................................... 2-85 14-02 : Analog Trunk Data Setup ........................................................ 2-91 14-04 : Behind PBX Setup ................................................................... 2-94 14-05 : Trunk Group ............................................................................ 2-95 14-06 : Trunk Group Routing ............................................................... 2-96 14-07 : Trunk Access Map Setup ........................................................ 2-98 14-08 : Music on Hold Source for Trunks .......................................... 2-100 14-09 : Conversation Recording Destination for Trunks .................... 2-101 14-13 : CCIS System Route ID .......................................................... 2-102 14-14 : CCIS Trunk CIC Assignment ................................................. 2-103 Program 15 : Extension, Basic Setup 15-01 : Basic Extension Data Setup ................................................. 2-105 15-02 : Multiline Telephone Basic Data Setup ................................... 2-107 15-03 : Single Line Telephone Basic Data Setup .............................. 2-113 15-05 : IP Telephone Terminal Basic Data Setup ............................. 2-116 15-06 : Trunk Access Map for Extensions ......................................... 2-117 15-07 : Programmable Function Keys ............................................... 2-118 15-08 : Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Setup ........................ 2-128 15-09 : Virtual Extension Ring Assignment ....................................... 2-130 15-10 : Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Order Setup .............. 2-131 15-11 : Virtual Extension Delayed Ring Assignment ......................... 2-133 15-12 : Conversation Recording Destination for Extensions ............. 2-134 15-14 : Programmable One-Touch Keys ........................................... 2-135 ___________________________________________________________________________________ Programming iii
Document Revision 1 Electra Elite IPK II ___________________________________________________________________________________ 15-15 : Wireless DECT Terminal Basic Data Setup .......................... 2-136 15-17 : CO Message Waiting Indication ............................................ 2-139 15-18 : Virtual Extension Key Enhanced Options .............................. 2-140 15-20 : LCD Line Key Name Assignment .......................................... 2-141 Program 16 : Department Group Setup 16-01 : Department Group Basic Data Setup .................................... 2-143 16-02 : Department Group Assignment for Extensions ..................... 2-146 16-03 : Secondary Department Group .............................................. 2-147 Program 20 : System Option Setup 20-01 : System Options ..................................................................... 2-149 20-02 : System Options for Multiline Telephones .............................. 2-151 20-03 : System Options for Single Line Telephones ......................... 2-154 20-04 : System Options for Virtual Extensions .................................. 2-156 20-06 : Class of Service for Extensions ............................................. 2-157 20-07 : Class of Service Options (Administrator Level) ..................... 2-158 20-08 : Class of Service Options (Outgoing Call Service) ................. 2-161 20-09 : Class of Service Options (Incoming Call Service) ................. 2-164 20-10 : Class of Service Options (Answer Service) ........................... 2-166 20-11 : Class of Service Options (Hold/Transfer Service) ................. 2-168 20-12 : Class of Service Options (Charging Cost Service) ............... 2-171 20-13 : Class of Service Options (Supplementary Service) .............. 2-172 20-14 : Class of Service Options for DISA/E&M ................................ 2-177 20-15 : Ring Cycle Setup ................................................................... 2-179 20-16 : Selectable Display Messages ............................................... 2-181 20-17 : Operators Extension ............................................................. 2-184 20-18 : Service Tone Timers ............................................................. 2-185 20-19 : System Options for Caller ID ................................................. 2-187 20-20 : Message Setup for Non-Caller ID Data ................................. 2-188 20-21 : System Options for Long Conversation ................................. 2-189 20-22 : System Options for Wireless DECT Service ........................ 2-190 20-23 : System Options for CTI ......................................................... 2-191 ___________________________________________________________________________________ iv Table of Contents
Electra Elite IPK II Document Revision 1 ___________________________________________________________________________________ 20-25 : ISDN Options ......................................................................... 2-192 20-26 : Multiplier Changing CO ......................................................... 2-194 20-28 : Trunk to Trunk Conversation ................................................. 2-195 20-29 : Timer Class for Extension ..................................................... 2-196 20-30 : Timer Class for Trunks .......................................................... 2-197 20-31 : Timer Class Timer Assignment ............................................. 2-198 Program 21 : Outgoing Call Setup 21-01 : System Options for Outgoing Calls ....................................... 2-201 21-02 : Trunk Group Routing for Extensions ..................................... 2-204 21-03 : Trunk Group Routing for Trunks ............................................ 2-205 21-04 : Toll Restriction Class for Extensions ..................................... 2-206 21-05 : Toll Restriction Class ............................................................. 2-207 21-06 : Toll Restriction Table Data Setup .......................................... 2-210 21-07 : Toll Restriction Override Password Setup ............................. 2-213 21-08 : Repeat Dial Setup ................................................................. 2-214 21-09 : Dial Block Setup .................................................................... 2-215 21-10 : Dial Block Restriction Class Per Extensions ......................... 2-216 21-11 : Extension Ringdown (Hotline) Assignment ........................... 2-217 21-12 : ISDN Calling Party Number Setup for Trunks ....................... 2-218 21-13 : ISDN Calling Party Number Setup for Extensions ................. 2-219 21-14 : Walking Toll Restriction Password Setup .............................. 2-220 21-15 : Individual Trunk Group Routing for Extensions ..................... 2-221 21-21 : Toll Restriction for Trunks (Seized Trunk Basis Setting) ....... 2-222 21-22 : CO Message Waiting Indication - Call Back Settings ............ 2-223 Program 22 : Incoming Call Setup 22-01 : System Options for Incoming Calls ....................................... 2-225 22-02 : Incoming Call Trunk Setup ................................................... 2-227 22-03 : Trunk Ring Tone Range ........................................................ 2-228 22-04 : Incoming Extension Ring Group Assignment ........................ 2-230 22-05 : Incoming Trunk Ring Group Assignment ............................... 2-231 22-06 : Normal Incoming Ring Mode ................................................. 2-232 ___________________________________________________________________________________ Programming v
Document Revision 1 Electra Elite IPK II ___________________________________________________________________________________ 22-07 : DIL Assignment ..................................................................... 2-233 22-08 : DIL/IRG No Answer Destination ............................................ 2-234 22-09 : DID Basic Data Setup ........................................................... 2-235 22-10 : DID Translation Table Setup ................................................. 2-237 22-11 : DID Translation Number Conversion .................................... 2-239 22-12 : DID Intercept Ring Group ...................................................... 2-243 22-13 : DID Trunk Group to Translation Table Assignment .............. 2-245 22-14 : VRS Delayed Message for IRG ............................................. 2-246 22-15 : VRS Waiting Message for Department Group ...................... 2-247 22-16 : Private Call Refuse Target Area Setup ................................. 2-248 22-17 : Dial-In Conversion Table Area Setup for Time Pattern ......... 2-249 22-18 : Private Call Assignment Setup .............................................. 2-250 Program 23 : Answer Features Setup 23-02 : Call Pickup Groups ................................................................ 2-251 23-03 : Universal Answer/Auto Answer ............................................. 2-252 23-04 : Ringing Line Preference for Virtual Extensions ..................... 2-254 Program 24 : Hold/Transfer Setup 24-01 : System Options for Hold ....................................................... 2-255 24-02 : System Options for Transfer ................................................. 2-257 24-03 : Park Group ............................................................................ 2-259 24-04 : Automatic Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer Target Setup ................. 2-260 24-05 : Department Group Transfer Target Setup ............................ 2-261 24-09 : Call Forward Split Settings .................................................... 2-262 Program 25 : DID/DISA Setup 25-01 : VRS/DISA Line Basic Data Setup ......................................... 2-265 25-02 : DID/DISA VRS Message ....................................................... 2-266 25-03 : VRS/DISA Transfer Ring Group With Incorrect Dialing ......... 2-267 25-04 : VRS/DISA Transfer Ring Group With No Answer/Busy ........ 2-268 25-05 : VRS/DISA Error Message Assignment ................................. 2-269 25-06 : VRS/DISA One-Digit Code Attendant Setup ......................... 2-270 25-07 : System Timers for VRS/DISA ............................................... 2-272 ___________________________________________________________________________________ vi Table of Contents
Electra Elite IPK II Document Revision 1 ___________________________________________________________________________________ 25-08 : DISA User ID Setup ............................................................... 2-274 25-09 : Class of Service for DISA Users ............................................ 2-275 25-10 : Trunk Group Routing for DISA .............................................. 2-276 25-11 : DISA Toll Restriction Class ................................................... 2-277 25-12 : Alternate Trunk Group Routing for DISA ............................... 2-278 25-13 : System Option for DISA ........................................................ 2-279 Program 26 : ARS Service 26-01 : Automatic Route Selection Service ....................................... 2-281 26-02 : Dial Analysis Table for ARS/LCR .......................................... 2-283 26-03 : ARS Dial Treatments ............................................................. 2-285 26-04 : ARS Class of Service ............................................................ 2-287 26-05 : LCR Carrier Table ................................................................. 2-288 26-06 : LCR Authorization Table ....................................................... 2-289 26-07 : LCR Cost Center Code Table ................................................ 2-290 26-08 : LCR Manual Override Access Code Table ............................ 2-291 26-09 : LCR Manual Override Exemption Table ................................ 2-292 26-11 : Transit Network ID Table ....................................................... 2-294 Program 30 : DSS/DLS Console Setup 30-01 : DSS Console Operating Mode .............................................. 2-295 30-02 : DSS Console Extension Assignment .................................... 2-296 30-03 : DSS Console Key Assignment .............................................. 2-297 30-05 : DSS Console Lamp Table ..................................................... 2-304 Program 31 : Paging Setup 31-01 : System Options for Internal/External Paging ......................... 2-307 31-02 : Internal Paging Group Assignment ........................................ 2-309 31-03 : Internal Paging Group Settings ............................................. 2-310 31-04 : External Paging Zone Group ................................................. 2-313 31-05 : Universal Night Answer/Ring Over Page ............................... 2-314 31-06 : External Speaker Control ...................................................... 2-315 31-07 : Combined Paging Assignments ............................................ 2-317 31-08 : BGM on External Paging ....................................................... 2-318 ___________________________________________________________________________________ Programming vii
Document Revision 1 Electra Elite IPK II ___________________________________________________________________________________ Program 32 : Door Box and Sensor Setup 32-01 : Door Box Timers ................................................................... 2-319 32-02 : Door Box Ring Assignment ................................................... 2-320 32-03 : Door Box Basic Setup ........................................................... 2-321 Program 33 : CTA and ACI Setup 33-01 : ACI Port Type Setup ............................................................. 2-323 33-02 : ACI Department Calling Group .............................................. 2-324 Program 34 : Tie Line Setup 34-01 : E&M Tie Line Basic Setup ..................................................... 2-325 34-02 : E&M Tie Line Class of Service .............................................. 2-327 34-03 : Trunk Group Routing for E&M Tie Lines ............................... 2-328 34-04 : E&M Tie Line Toll Restriction Class ...................................... 2-329 34-05 : Tie Line Outgoing Call Restriction ......................................... 2-330 34-06 : Add / Delete Digit for E&M Tie Line ....................................... 2-331 34-07 : E&M Tie Line Timer ............................................................... 2-332 34-08 : Toll Restriction Data for E&M Tie Lines ................................ 2-333 34-09 : ANI/DNIS Service Options .................................................... 2-334 Program 35 : SMDR Account Code Setup 35-01 : SMDR Options ...................................................................... 3-337 35-02 : SMDR Output Options ........................................................... 3-339 35-03 : SMDR Port Assignment for Trunk Group .............................. 3-342 35-04 : SMDR Port Assignment for Department Groups ................... 3-343 35-05 : Account Code Setup ............................................................. 3-344 35-06 : Verified Account Code Table ................................................. 3-346 Program 40 : Voice Recording System 40-01 : Voice Mail Basic Setup .......................................................... 2-347 40-02 : Mailbox Setup ........................................................................ 2-349 40-03 : Message Recording Setup .................................................... 2-350 40-04 : Live Recording Setup ............................................................ 2-351 40-05 : Call Information Setup ........................................................... 2-352 40-06 : Voice Mail Automated Attendant Data Setup ........................ 2-353 ___________________________________________________________________________________ viii Table of Contents
Electra Elite IPK II Document Revision 1 ___________________________________________________________________________________ 40-07 : Voice Prompt Language Assignment for VRS ....................... 2-354 40-08 : Voice Prompt Language Assignment for Mailboxes .............. 2-355 40-09 : Voice Mail Multiple Address Group Setup ............................. 2-356 40-10 : Voice Announcement Service Option .................................... 2-357 40-11 : Pre-Amble Message Assignment .......................................... 2-359 Program 41 : ACD Setup 41-01 : System Options for ACD ....................................................... 2-361 41-02 : ACD Group and Agent Assignments ..................................... 2-362 41-03 : Incoming Ring Group Assignment for ACD Group ................ 2-363 41-04 : ACD Group Supervisor ......................................................... 2-365 41-05 : ACD Agent Work Schedules ................................................. 2-366 41-06 : Trunk Work Schedules .......................................................... 2-367 41-07 : ACD Weekly Schedule Setup ................................................ 2-368 41-08 : ACD Overflow Options .......................................................... 2-369 41-09 : ACD Overflow Table Setting .................................................. 2-371 41-10 : ACI Delay Announcement ..................................................... 2-372 41-11 : VRS Delay Announcement .................................................... 2-373 41-12 : Night Announcement Setup ................................................... 2-375 41-13 : VRS Message Number for Night Announcement .................. 2-376 41-14 : ACD Options .......................................................................... 2-377 41-15 : ACD Queue Alarm Information .............................................. 2-379 41-16 : ACD Threshold Overflow ....................................................... 2-381 41-17 : ACD Login Mode Setup ......................................................... 2-382 41-18 : ACD Agent Identity Code Setup ............................................ 2-383 41-20 : ACD Queue Display Settings ................................................ 2-384 Program 42 : Hotel Setup 42-01 : System Options for Hotel/Motel ............................................. 2-387 42-02 : Hotel/Motel Telephone Setup ................................................ 2-388 42-03 : Class of Service Options (Hotel/Motel) .................................. 2-389 42-04 : Hotel Mode One-Digit Service Codes .................................... 2-391 42-05 : Hotel Room Status Printer ..................................................... 2-392 ___________________________________________________________________________________ Programming ix
Document Revision 1 Electra Elite IPK II ___________________________________________________________________________________ Program 44 : ARS/F-Route Setup 44-01 : System Options for ARS/F-Route ......................................... 2-393 44-02 : Dial Analysis Table for ARS/F-Route Access ........................ 2-394 44-03 : Dial Analysis Extension Table ............................................... 2-396 44-04 : ARS/F-Route Selection for Time Schedule ........................... 2-398 44-05 : ARS/F-Route Table ............................................................... 2-399 44-06 : Additional Dial Table ............................................................. 2-401 44-07 : Gain Table for ARS/F-Route Access .................................... 2-402 44-08 : Time Schedule for ARS/F-Route ........................................... 2-404 44-09 : Weekly Schedule for ARS/F-Route ....................................... 2-406 44-10 : Holiday Schedule for ARS/F-Route ....................................... 2-407 Program 45 : Voice Mail Integration 45-01 : Voice Mail Integration Options .............................................. 2-409 Program 47 : In-Mail 47-01 : IPK II In-Mail System Options ............................................... 2-411 47-02 : IPK II In-Mail Station Mailbox Options ................................... 2-418 47-03 : IPK II In-Mail Master Mailbox Options ................................... 2-423 47-04 : Master Call Routing Mailbox Options .................................... 2-425 47-05 : Master Announcement Mailbox Options ............................... 2-427 47-06 : Master Subscriber Mailbox Options ...................................... 2-429 47-07 : IPK II In-Mail Routing Mailbox Options .................................. 2-433 47-08 : Call Routing Mailbox Options ................................................ 2-434 47-09 : Announcement Mailbox Options ........................................... 2-436 47-10 : IPK II In-Mail Trunk Options .................................................. 2-438 47-11 : IPK II In-Mail Answer Table Options ..................................... 2-439 47-12 : IPK II In-Mail Answer Schedules ........................................... 2-443 47-13 : IPK II In-Mail Dial Action Tables ............................................ 2-452 47-14 : Master Directory Mailbox Options ........................................ 2-459 47-15 : Routing Directory Mailbox Options ....................................... 2-460
Electra Elite IPK II Document Revision 1 ___________________________________________________________________________________ Program 50 : Common Channel Interoffice Signaling Service 50-01 : CCIS System Setting ............................................................. 2-461 50-02 : Connecting System Settings ................................................. 2-462 50-03 : CCIS Destination System Settings ........................................ 2-464 50-04 : CCIS Office Code Assignment .............................................. 2-465 50-05 : CCIS Maximum Call Forwarding Hop Counter ...................... 2-466 50-06 : CCIS Feature Availability ....................................................... 2-467 50-07 : CCIS Centralized Billing Center Office .................................. 2-468 50-08 : CCIS Centralized BLF Sending Group Assignment .............. 2-469 50-09 : CCIS Centralized BLF Sending Extension Number Assignment ............................................................................ 2-470 50-10 : CCIS Centralized BLF Interval Time Assignment .................. 2-472 50-11 : CCIS Centralized Day/Night Switching Sending Group Assignment ............................................................................ 2-473 50-12 : CCIS Centralized Day/Night Mode to System Mode Assignment ............................................................................ 2-474 50-13 : CCIS Centralized Response Timeout Assignment ................ 2-475 Program 80 : Basic Hardware Setup for System 80-01 : Service Tone Setup ............................................................... 2-477 80-02 : DTMF Tone Setup ................................................................. 2-483 80-03 : DTMF Tone Receiver Setup .................................................. 2-485 80-04 : Call Progress Tone Detector Setup ....................................... 2-488 80-05 : Date Format for SMDR and System ...................................... 2-490 Program 81 : Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk 81-04 : ISDN BRI Layer 1 (T-Point) Initial Data Setup ....................... 2-491 81-05 : ISDN BRI & PRI Layer 2 (T-Point) Initial Data Setup ............ 2-492 81-06 : ISDN BRI & PRI Layer 3 (T-Point) Timer Setup .................... 2-493 81-10 : COI Initial Data Setup ............................................................ 2-495 81-11 : Tie Line Initial Setup .............................................................. 2-497 81-12 : Trunk Gain Level Data Setup ................................................ 2-500
___________________________________________________________________________________ Programming xi
Document Revision 1 Electra Elite IPK II ___________________________________________________________________________________ Program 82 : Basic Hardware Setup for Extension 82-01 : Incoming Ring Tone .............................................................. 2-501 82-03 : DSS Console LED Pattern Setup .......................................... 2-503 82-08 : Sidetone Volume Setup ......................................................... 2-505 82-11 : SLI Initial Setup ..................................................................... 2-506 82-12 : OPX Initial Data ..................................................................... 2-507 Program 83 : Hardware Setup for IPK II Wireless 83-11 : Wireless DECT Configuration ............................................... 2-509 83-12 : Wireless DECT Measurement ............................................... 2-510 Program 84 : Hardware Setup for VoIP 84-03 : IP Phone Information Basic Setup ........................................ 2-511 Program 84 : Hardware Setup for VoIP 84-04 : VoIP DHCP Server Mode Setup ........................................... 2-513 84-05 : VoIP IP Address .................................................................... 2-514 84-06 : VoIP Info ................................................................................ 2-516 84-09 : VLAN Setup ........................................................................... 2-518 84-10 : ToS Setup ............................................................................. 2-519 84-11 : Dterm IP CODEC Information Basic Setup ............................ 2-521 84-21 : CCIS over IP CODEC ........................................................... 2-524 Program 85 : HUB(8) LAN Setup 85-01 : HUB(8) LAN Setup ................................................................ 2-527 85-02 : HUB(8) VLAN Setup .............................................................. 2-529 85-03 : Priority Setup ........................................................................ 2-531 85-04 : Port Mirroring Setup .............................................................. 2-533 85-05 : HUB(8) VLAN Group Settings ............................................... 2-534 Program 90 : Maintenance Program 90-01 : Installation Date ..................................................................... 2-537 90-02 : Programming Password Setup .............................................. 2-538 90-03 : Save Data .............................................................................. 2-540 90-04 : Load Data .............................................................................. 2-541
Electra Elite IPK II Document Revision 1 ___________________________________________________________________________________ 90-05 : Slot Control ............................................................................ 2-542 90-06 : Trunk Control ......................................................................... 2-543 90-07 : Extension Control .................................................................. 2-544 90-08 : System Reset ........................................................................ 2-545 90-09 : Automatic System Reset Time .............................................. 2-546 90-10 : System Alarm Setup .............................................................. 2-547 90-11 : System Alarm Report ............................................................ 2-550 90-12 : System Alarm Output ............................................................ 2-552 90-13 : System Information Output .................................................... 2-553 90-16 : Main Software Information ..................................................... 2-554 90-19 : Dial Block Release ................................................................ 2-555 90-20 : Traffic Report Data Setup ...................................................... 2-556 90-21 : Traffic Report Output ............................................................. 2-557 90-23 : Deleting Registration of IP Telephones ................................. 2-558 90-24 : System Alarm Report Notification Time Setup ...................... 2-559 90-25 : System Alarm Report CC Mail Setup .................................... 2-560 90-26 : Program Access Level Setup ................................................ 2-561 90-27 : Wireless DECT System ID ................................................... 2-562 90-31 : DIM Access over Ethernet .................................................... 2-563 90-34 : Firmware Information ............................................................ 2-564 90-35 : Wizard Programming Level Setup ........................................ 2-565 90-36 : Firmware Update Time Setting ............................................. 2-566 Program 91 : IPK II Wireless DECT PS Entry 91-06 : DECT Obtaining Access Rights ............................................. 2-569 91-07 : DECT Deleting Access Rights ............................................... 2-572 Program 92 : Copy Program 92-01 : Copy Program ....................................................................... 2-573 92-02 : Delete All Extension Numbers ............................................... 2-577 92-03 : Copy Program by Port Number ............................................. 2-578 92-04 : Extension Data Swap ............................................................ 2-579 92-05 : Extension Data Swap Password ........................................... 2-580 ___________________________________________________________________________________ Programming xiii
LIST OF TABLES
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 1-1 Table 1-2 Table 1-3 Table 1-4 Table 2-1 Table 2-2 Table 2-3 Table 2-4 Table 2-5 Table 2-6 Table 2-7 Table 2-8
Keys for Entering Data ...................................................................................... 1-4 Keys for Entering Names .................................................................................. 1-5 Softkey Display Prompts ................................................................................... 1-7 System Number Plan/Capacities ....................................................................... 1-8 Programming Modes .................... .................................................................... 2-1 System Numbering Default Settings ............................................................... 2-33 Program 15 : 02 Incoming Signal Frequency Patterns ............................... 2-112 Program 15 : 08 Incoming Signal Frequency Patterns ............................... 2-129 Ringing Cycles .............................................................................................. 2-179 Program 22 : 03 Incoming Signal Frequency Patterns ............................... 2-228 LED Patterns for DSS Console ..................................................................... 2-305 Basic Tones ................................................................................................... 2-478
___________________________________________________________________________________ Programming xv
Introduction
SECTION 1
1
Before customizing your system be sure to read this chapter first.
This chapter provides you with detailed information about the system programs. By changing a program, you change the way the feature associated with that program works. In this chapter, you find out about each program, the features that the program affects and how to enter the program data into system memory.
SECTION 2
Programming
1-1
n o i t c u d o r t n I
Document Revision 1
Feature Cross Reference provides you with a table of all the features affected by the program. You will want to keep the referenced features in mind when you change a program. Customizing a feature may have an effect on another feature that you did not intend. Telephone Programming Instructions shows how to enter the program data into system memory. For example: 1. 2. Enter the programming mode. 15-07-01
15-07-01 TEL KY01 = *01
tells you to enter the programming mode, dial 150701 from the telephone dial pad. After you do, you will see the message 15-07-01 TEL on the first line of the telephone display. This indicates the program number (15-07), item number (01), and that the options are being set for the extension . The second row of the display KY01 = *01 indicates that Key 01 is being programmed with the entry of *01. The third row allows you to move the cursor to the left or right, depending on which arrow is pressed. To learn how to enter the programming mode, refer to Section 3 How to Enter Programming Mode below.
SECTION 3
2. 3. 4.
Password
5.
Dial the system password + Transfer. Refer to the following table for the default system passwords. To change the passwords, use 90-02 : Programming Password Setup.
1-2
, ,
#
Press Speaker.
#
Introduction
Document Revision 1
Password
Level
47544
1 (MF)
12345678
tech
2 (IN)
Installation (IN):
All programs in this section not listed below for SA and SB 0000 ADMIN1 3 (SA) System Administrator - Level 1 (SA): 10-01, 10-02, 10-12, 10-13, 10-14, 10-15, 10-16, 10-17, 10-18, 10-22, 12-02, 12-03, 12-04, 15-01, 15-07, 15-09, 15-10, 15-11, 20-16, 21-07, 21-14, 22-04, 22-11, 25-08, 30-03, 32-02, 40-02, 41-02, 41-03, 41-04, 41-05, 41-06, 41-07, 41-08, 41-09, 41-10, 41-11, 41-12, 41-13, 41-14, 41-15, 41-16, 41-17, 41-18, 90-03, 90-04, 90-06, 90-07, 90-18, 90-19 9999 ADMIN2 4 (SB) System Administrator - Level 2 (SB): 13-04, 13-05, 13-06
SECTION 4
2. 3.
Press Speaker. If changes were to the system programming, "Saving System Data" is displayed. The display shows "Complete Data Save" when completed and exits the telephone to an idle mode.
To save a customers database, a blank Compact Flash (CF) is required. Insert the CF into the CPUII and, using Program 90-03, save the software to the Compact Flash. (Program 90-04 is used to reload the customer data if necessary.) Note that a Compact Flash can only hold one customer database. Each database to be saved will require its own separate card.
Programming
1-3
Document Revision 1
SECTION 5
TRANSFER
CONF
HOLD ANSWER
REDIAL
LINE KEYS
1-4
0~9 and
Enter data into a program. Complete the programming step you just made (e.g., pressing Enter on a PC keyboard). When a program entry displays, press TRANSFER to bypass the entry without changing it. Delete the entry to the left (e.g., pressing Backspace on a PC keyboard). Delete or clear all characters to the right of the cursor. Exit one step at a time from the program window currently being viewed. For example, if programming item 5 in 15-03, pressing ANSWER allows you to enter a new option in program 15-03. Pressing ANSWER again allows you to select a new program in the 15-XX series. Pressing ANSWER a third time allows you to enter a new program beginning with 1. Pressing ANSWER one last time brings you to the beginning program display, allowing you to enter any program number. Switch between the different input data fields by pressing REDIAL. The cursor moves up to the top row of the display. Pressing REDIAL again moves the cursor back to the middle row. Use pre-programmed settings to help with the program entry. These settings vary between programs from LINE 1 = 0 (off) and LINE 2 = 1 (on) to preset values for timers where LINE 1 = 5, LINE 2 = 10, LINE 3 = 15, etc. For programs with this option, the line key, which currently matches the programmed setting, lights steady. The display can also indicate Softkey, which will allow you to select the values as well (-1 and +1 will step through these pre-programmed settings.) Program a pause into an Speed Dialing bin. Program a recall/flash into an Speed Dialing bin. Program an @ into an Speed Dialing bin.
Introduction
Document Revision 1
Table 1-1 Keys for Entering Data (Continued) Keys for Entering Data
Use this key...
VOL
VOL
SECTION 6
Programming
L M
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0
Scroll backward through a list of entry numbers (e.g., from extension etc.) or through entries in a table (e.g., Common Permit Table). If you enter data and then press this key, the system accepts the data before scrolling forward. Scroll forward through a list of entry numbers (e.g., from extension etc.) or through entries in a table (e.g., Common Permit Table). If you enter data and then press this key, the system accepts the data before scrolling backward.
Enter characters:
1 @ [ ] ^ _ ` { | }
Enter characters A-C, a-c, 2. Enter characters D-F, d-f, 3. Enter characters G-I, g-i, 4. Enter characters J-L, j-l, 5. Enter characters M-O, m-o, 6. Enter characters P-S, p-s, 7. Enter characters T-V, t-v, 8. Enter characters W-Z, w-z, 9. Enter characters: 0 ! # $ % & ( )
1-5
Document Revision 1
Enter characters:
# = Accepts an entry (only required if two letters on the same key are needed - ex: TOM). Pressing # again = Space. (In system programming mode, use the right arrow Softkey instead to accept and/or add a space.) Clear the character entry one character at a time. Clear all the entries from the point of the flashing cursor and to the right.
CONF HOLD
SECTION 7
or VOLUME
1-6
HHHH
CCIS
HHHH
Base
OP2
Introduction
E B
<
>
Document Revision 1
SECTION 8
back
Go back one step in the program display. You can press VOLUME or VOLUME backward through a list of programs.
select
Scroll down through the available programs. Scroll up through the available programs. Select the currently displayed program. Move the cursor to the left. Move the cursor to the right. Move back through the available program options. Move forward through the available program options.
-1 +1
Programming
to scroll forward or
1-7
Document Revision 1
SECTION 9
System
Analog Caller ID Detector Classes of Service Day/Night Mode Numbers Day/Night Service Patterns Dial Tone Detector DTMF Receiver Toll Restriction Classes Verifiable Account Code Table 64 15 8 32 64 15 2000
Trunk
Trunk Port Number Trunk Ports (Total): Analog Trunks BRI Trunk Ports T1/PRI Trunk Ports 1~200 200 184 184 200 46 92 184 if IAD 200 is PVA 20 2000 15 1~15 1~100 15 15 1~200 1~100
Ring Groups Tie Line Classes of Service Tie Line Toll Restriction Classes Trunk Access Maps Trunk Group Numbers
1-8
H H H H H H H H
E&M Analog Trunk Ports DID Analog Trunk Ports VoIP Trunk Ports
Introduction
Document Revision 1
Extension
Telephone Extension Port Numbers Multiline Terminals Single Line Phones/Analog Devices VoIP Extensions Electra Elite IPK II Wireless Extension Ports (Total): Multiline Terminals Single Line Phones/Analog Devices ESIU:
Physical Ports
1~256 (1~240) (1~184) (1~256) 256 240 184 01~16 01~16 1~99999999 256 001~256 Undefined 56 240 16 256 8 1~8 32 0 1 512 16 240
SLIU:
Physical Ports
Telephone Extension Number Range Virtual Extension Ports Virtual Extension Port Numbers Virtual Extension Number Range PGD(2)-U10 Modules ADA (Recording Jack) Adapters Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT Base Stations Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT Telephones Door Boxes Door Box Numbers DSS Consoles Numbers: 60 Button DSS Console Operator Access Number Operator Extension Ringdown Assignments SLT Adapters HF-R Adapters
Programming
H H H H H H H H H
1-9
Document Revision 1
Speed Dialing
Speed Dialing Groups Speed Dialing Bins Speed Dialing Table-Common 64 0~1999 1000
ACD
ACD Groups ACD Agent Extensions 64 256
ACI
ACI Groups ACI Ports 16 96
Automated Attendant
VRS Message Numbers 1~48
Conference
Conference Circuits 64 - maximum (32 Parties Per Conference)
Hotline
Internal Hotline External Hotline 512 512
1 - 10
Introduction
Document Revision 1
SMDR
SMDR Ports 1~8
VRS
VRS (on DSP Daughter Board) VRS Channels VRS Attendant Messages VRS Recordable Messages 1 16 3 48
Voice Mail
Ports for IPK II In-Mail Ports for External Voice Mail 8 48
VoIP
ADA2 (Recording Jack) Adapters IP Adapters PSA (Power Failure) Adapters RTP Ports RTCP Ports DSP Resources 240 256 256 0~65535 0~65535 01~208
Programming
H H
1 - 11
Document Revision 1
Passwords
Programming Passwords: Level 1 (MF) PCPro/WebPro User Name: Level 2 (IN) PCPro/WebPro User Name: Level 3 (SA) PCPro/WebPro User Name: Level 4 (SB) PCPro/WebPro User Name: Programming Password Users Footnotes Extension numbers can be one to eight digits long. Refer to the Flexible System Numbering feature in the Electra Elite IPK II Features and Specifications manual. 47544 necii 12345678 tech 0000 ADMIN1 9999 ADMIN2 8
1 - 12
Introduction
2
g ni m m a r g o r P
2-1
Program 10 : System Configuration Setup Program 11 : System Numbering Program 12 : Night Mode Setup Program 13 : Speed Dialing Program 14 : Trunk, Basic Setup Program 15 : Extension, Basic Setup Program 16 : Department Group Setup Program 20 : System Option Setup Program 21 : Outgoing Call Setup Program 22 : Incoming Call Setup Program 23 : Answer Features Setup Program 24 : Hold/Transfer Setup Program 25 : DID/DISA Setup Program 26 : ARS Service Program 30 : DSS/DLS Console Setup (no Programs 27~29) Program 31 : Paging Setup
Programming
Document Revision 1
Program 32 : Door Box and Sensor Setup Program 33 : CTA and ACI Setup Program 34 : Tie Line Setup Program 35 : SMDR Account Code Setup Program 40 : Voice Recording System (no Programs 36~39) Program 41 : ACD Setup Program 42 : Hotel Setup Program 44 : ARS/F-Route Setup (no Program 43) Program 45 : Voice Mail Integration Program 47 : In-Mail (no Program 46) Program 50 : Common Channel Interoffice Signaling Service (CCIS) Program 80 : Basic Hardware Setup for System (no Programs 48, 49, 51~79) Program 81 : Basic Hardware Setup for Trunk Program 82 : Basic Hardware Setup for Extension Program 83 : Hardware Setup for IPK II Wireless Program 84 : Hardware Setup for VoIP Program 85 : HUB(8) LAN Setup Program 90 : Maintenance Program (no Programs 86~89) Program 91 : IPK II Wireless DECT PS Entry Program 92 : Copy Program
2-2
Description
Use Program 10-01 : Time and Date to change the system Time and Date through system programming. Extension users can also dial Service Code 728 to change the Time if allowed by an extensions Class of Service.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 Item
Year Month
Input Data 00~99 01~12 01~31 1~7 (Sun~Sat) 00~23 00~59 00~59
Description Enter two digits for year (00~99). Enter two digits (01~12) for the month. Enter two digits (01~31) for the day. Enter digit for the day of the week (1=Sunday, 7=Saturday). Enter two digits for the hour (00~23). Enter two digits for the minute (00~59). Enter two digits for the second (00~59).
Day Week
Hour Minute
Second
Conditions None
margorP
10
2-3
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-02 : Location Setup to define the location of the installed system.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 Item Country Code International Access Code Other Area Access Code Area Code Trunk Access Code Input Data Dial (up to 4 digits) 0~9, , # Dial (up to 4 digits) 0~9, , # Dial (up to 2 digits) 0~9, , # Dial (up to 6 digits) 0~9, , # Dial (up to 8 digits): 0~9, #, Default 1 9 Description Enter the country code. Enter the international access code. Enter the other area access code Enter the local area code. Enter the trunk access code digits required to place an outgoing call. This is the code which will be added to the Caller ID information for incoming trunk calls to allow the call to dial out if allowed in 20-19-03.
Conditions None
2-4
, , , ,
IMPORTANT
Program 10-02-05 is only supported by telephone programming. PCPro and WebPro cannot edit this option.
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-03 : ETU Setup to setup and confirm the Basic Configuration data for each ETU. When changing a defined terminal type, first set the type to 0 and then plug the new device in to have the system automatically define it or you may have to reseat the ETU.
01 01 02 03
The items highlighted in gray are read only and cannot be changed. The item numbers indicated below are different when using PCPro/WebPro due to the window layout of the applications. Refer to the program within the PCPro/ WebPro application to determine the correct item number.
Item No.
Item
Logical Port Number
Default 0
Item No.
Item
Logical Port Number The start port number of a T1 line is displayed. 24 logic ports are automatically assigned to a DTI (T1) line. T1 Signal Format Selection
Default 0
1 0
2-5
Document Revision 1
04
0 = 0 feet ~ 133 feet 1 = 134 feet ~ 266 feet 2 = 267 feet ~ 399 feet 3 = 400 feet ~ 533 feet 4 = 534 feet ~ 655 feet
Item No. 01
Item
Logical Port Number
Default 0
Item No. 01
Item
Terminal Type (B1)
Input Data
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = Not set Multiline Terminal SLT Adapter -- Not Used --- Not Used --- Not Used -PGD (Paging) PGD (Tone Ringer) PGD (Doorbox) PGD (ACI) DSS Console -- Not Used -Not set Multiline Terminal SLT Adapter Not Used Not Used 2DCI Adapter 1~32 PGD (Paging) PGD (for Tone Ringer) 1~4 or 1~8 PGD (for Door Box) 1~4 or 1~8 PGD (for Analog I/F) 1~8 or 1~96 DSS -- Not Used --
Default 0
02
03
2-6
Document Revision 1
Item No. 04
Item
Optional Installed Unit 1
Input Data
0 1 2 3 4 0 1 2 3 4 = = = = = = = = = = None APR Module APA Module ADA Module CTA/CTU Module None APR Module APA Module ADA Module CTA/CTU Module
Default 0
05
Input Data
0 6 7 8 9 12 = = = = = = Not set PGD (Paging) PGD (Tone Ringer) PGD (Door Box) PGD (ACI) APR
Default 0
07
PGD (Paging/Tone Ringer) = 1-PGmax PGD (for Door Box) = 1-DBmax PGD (Analog I/F) = 1-ACImax APR (for B2 mode) 193~256
Item No. 01 02 03 04
Item
Logical Port Number --- Not Used --Transmit Gain Level (S-Level) Receive Gain Level (R-Level)
Default 0
32 (0dB) 32 (0dB)
2-7
Document Revision 1
Item No. 01
Item
Logical Port Number
Default 0
Item No. 01
Item
Logical Port Number
Default 0
Item No. 01
Item
Logical Port Number
Default 0
Item No. 01
Item
Logical Port Number
Default 0
2-8
Document Revision 1
Item No 01 02
--- Not Used ---
Item
Input Data
Default
The starting port number of a BRI line is displayed. Two logic ports are automatically assigned to a BRI line.
0 = Net Set 1 = For T-Bus (1~200) 2 = For S-Bus (1~256) 0 1 = Point-to-Multipoint (not available for Networking) = Point-to-Point
03
04
05
06 07 08 09
10 11 12 13 14
Connection Type
1~5
Each timer value of Layer 3 are set up for every type using Program 81-06 (T-Bus)
CLIP Information Announcement Based on this setting, the system will include a Presentation Allowed (1) or Presentation Restricted (0) in the Setup message to allow or deny the Calling Party Number. Program 15-01-04 must also be set to a 1 if this option is enabled. --- Not Used ----- Not Used --Dial Sending Mode
0 1
= Disable = Enable
0 1 0 1
Dial Information Element (Only when Dialing Sending Mode (1003-08) is set for 1 (Overlap Sending) --- Not Used ----- Not Used ----- Not Used ----- Not Used ----- Not Used ---
2-9
Document Revision 1
Item No. 01 02
--- Not Used ---
Item
Input Data
Default
= for T-Bus
1~200
The start port number of a PRI line is displayed. 24 logic ports are automatically assigned to a PRI line.
03 04
05
06
07 08 09
10 11 12
2 - 10
1~5
Each timer value of Layer 3 is set up for each type in Program 81-06 (T-Bus)
CLIP Information
Based on this setting, the system will include a Presentation Allowed (1) or Presentation Restricted (0) in the Setup message to allow or deny the Calling Party Number. Program 15-01-04 must also be set to a 1 if this option is enabled.
Length of Cable
0 1
= Disable = Enable
0 1 2 3 4
= = = = =
0 1 0 1
Dial Information Element (Only when Dialing Sending Mode (10-03-08) is set for 1 (Overlap Sending) --- Not Used ----- Not Used --Short / Long-Haul
0 1
= Short-Haul = Long-Haul
Document Revision 1
Item No. 13
Item
Loss-Of-Signal Detection Limit
Input Data
In Short-Haul Mode: 0 = 0.91V 1 = 0.74V 2 = 0.59V 3 = 0.42V 4 = 0.32V 5 = 0.21V 6 = 0.16V 7 = 0.10V In Long-Haul Mode: 0 = 1.70V 1 = 0.84V 2 = 0.84V 3 = 0.45V 4 = 0.45V 5 = 0.20V 6 = 0.10V 7 = Not Defined
Default 0
14
Item No. 01
Item
Logical Port Number The start port number of a T1 line is displayed. 24 logic ports are automatically assigned to a DTI (T1) line.
Default 0
02 03 04
0 1
1 0
0 1 2 3 4
= = = = =
0 feet ~ 133 feet 134 feet ~ 266 feet 267 feet ~ 399 feet 400 feet ~ 533 feet 534 feet ~ 655 feet
2 - 11
Document Revision 1
05
0 1 2 3
= = = =
Item No. 01
Item
Logical Port Number
Default 0
Conditions
When changing a defined terminal type, first set the type to 0 and then plug the new device in to have the system automatically define it or redefine the type manually. The system must have a ETU installed in order to view/change the options for that type of ETU.
2 - 12
H H
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-04 : Music on Hold Setup to set the Music on Hold (MOH) source. For internal Music on Hold, the system can provide a service tone callers on hold or one of eleven synthesized selections.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Music on Hold Source Selection
Default 2
Description
The Music on Hold (MOH) source can be internal (synthesized) or from a customer-provided music source. The customer-provided source can connect to a PGD(2)-U10 ADP or the connector on the side of the Base Cabinets MOH/IN connection. Trunk MOH and Extension MOH music source use the same Music on Hold source.
02 03
32 (0dB)
Conditions None
J J J
2 - 13
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-05 : General Purpose Relay Setup to define which Relay circuits (5~8) on PGD(2)-U10 Adapter are used for General Purpose Relay.
Input Data - INDEX-1 General Purpose Relay No. 1~8
Item No. 01
Slot No.
Item
Input Data Slot No: 0~16 ESIU Port: 0~16 Relay No: 0, 5~8
After each entry, pressing the Transfer Key will advance to the next entry.
Default 0-0-0
Conditions None
2 - 14
J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-06 : ISDN - BRI Setup to configure the ISDN - BRIs Terminal Endpoint Identifier (TEI), mode of operation, and Service Profile Identifier (SPID) number for each circuits B-Channels.
J J
Input Data
ISDN - BRI Circuit 1~4
Item No. 01
Item
TEI Selection Selects the method the system will use when assigning Terminal Endpoint Identifier (TEI) values to BRI ports.
Default 0
02
DID Mode
0 = Route by Called Party Number 1 = Route by Redirecting Number Dial up to 20 digits Dial up to 20 digits
03 04
SPID 1 SPID 2
Conditions None
2 - 15
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-08 : Ringing Setup to enable or disable pre-ringing for trunk calls. This sets how a trunk initially rings a telephone. With pre-ringing, a burst of ringing occurs as soon as the trunks LED flashes. The call then continues ringing with the normal ring cadence cycle. Without pre-ringing, the call starts ringing only when the normal ring cadence cycle occurs. This may cause a ring delay, depending on when call detection occurs in reference to the ring cycle.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Description
Ringing Setup
Input Data
0 = Disable 1 = Enable
Default 0
Conditions
2 - 16
J J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-09 : DTMF and Dial Tone Circuit Setup to allocate the circuits on the CPUII for either DTMF receiving or dial tone detection. The CPUII has 16 circuits initially. On the Electra Elite IPK II, with additional PGD(2)-U10 ADPs installed, the system can provide a total of 64 circuits (32 + 32). These are used as follows:
Extension Trunk DTMF receiver for single line telephone DTMF receiver for analog trunks, dial tone & busy tone detection for analog trunks
J J J J J J J
Input Data
Circuit/Resource Number 01~64
Item No. 01
Input Data
0 = Common Use 1 = Extension Only 2 = Trunk Only
Default Setting Circuit/Resource 01-08: 1 (Extension Only) Circuit/Resource 09-32: 2 (Trunk Only) Circuit/Resource 33-64: 0 (Common Use)
Conditions None
2 - 17
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-12 : CPUII Network Setup to setup the IP Address, Subnet-Mask, and Default Gateway addresses. Caution! If any of the IPK Address or NIC settings are changed, the system must be reset in order for the changes to take affect.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item IP Address Input Data
1.0.0.1 ~ 126.255.255.254 128.1.0.1 ~ 191.254.255.254 192.0.1.1 ~ 223.255.254.254
Default
172.16.0.10
Conditions
02
Subnet Mask
128.0.0.0 240.0.0.0 254.0.0.0 255.192.0.0 255.252.0.0 255.255.128.0 255.255.248.0 255.255.255.0 255.255.255.224 255.255.255.252
192.0.0.0 248.0.0.0 255.0.0.0 255.224.0.0 255.254.0.0 255.255.192.0 255.255.252.0 255.255.255.128 255.255.255.240 255.255.255.254
224.0.0.0 252.0.0.0 255.128.0.0 255.248.0.0 255.255.0.0 255.255.224.0 255.255.254.0 255.255.255.192 255.255.255.248 255.255.255.255
255.255.0.0
The setting of Subnet-Mask is invalid when all Host Address are 0. If the network section is: 0, 127 128.0 191.255 192.0.0 223.255.255 The setting of Subnet-Mask is invalid.
03
Default Gateway
0.0.0.0
2 - 18
Document Revision 1
05
NIC Interface
0 = Auto Detect 1 = 100Mbps, Full Duplex 2 = 100Mbps, Half Duplex 3 = 10Mbps, Full Duplex 4 = 10Mbps, Half Duplex
08
Conditions
The system must be reset in order for these changes to take affect.
2 - 19
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-13 : In-DHCP Server Setup to setup the DHCP Server built into the CPUII. Caution! The system must be reset in order for these changes to take affect.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 Item
DHCP Server Mode Lease Time
Input Data
0: Disable 1: Enable
Description
Enable or disable the use of the built-in DHCP Server. Lease Time of the IP address to a client. Note: Pressing the Transfer Key will increment to the next setting data.
Minutes 1~59 03 04
--- Not Used --Number of Networks
30 minutes
The number of networks to manage. With a single network, select Single. When dividing and managing the same network as multiple networks, select Divide.
Conditions None
2 - 20
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-14 : Managed Network Setup to set up the range of the IP address which the DHCP Server leases to a client. Input Data
Scope Number 1~10
Item No. 01
Item
The range of the IP address to lease. When Maximum has not been entered, the maximum value equals the minimum value. When Single is selected in 10-13-04, only one scope range can be entered. When Divide Same Network is selected in 10-13-04, a maximum of ten scope ranges can be entered.
Input Data
Minimum: 1.0.0.1 ~ 126.255.255.254 128.1.0.1 ~ 191.254.255.254 192.0.1.1 ~ 223.255.254.254
Default
Scope 1: 172.16.0.100 Scope 2~10: 0.0.0.0
Conditions None
2 - 21
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-15 : Client Information Setup to set up the client information when the DHCP server needs to assign a fixed IP address to clients.
Input Data
Client Number 1-10
Item No. 01
Item
The IP address should be assigned out of the scope range set up in Program 10-14.
Input Data MAC: 00-00-00-00-00-00 FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF IP address 1.0.0.1 ~ 126.255.255.254 128.1.0.1 ~ 191.254.255.254 192.0.1.1 ~ 223.255.254.254
Default 00-00-00-00-00-00
0.0.0.0
Conditions None
2 - 22
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-16 : Option Information Setup to set up the option given from the DHCP server to each client.
Input Data
Item No. 01
Router
Item
Input Data Code number 0~255 IP address 1.0.0.1 ~ 126.255.255.254 128.1.0.1 ~ 191.254.255.254 192.0.1.1 ~ 223.255.254.254
02
DNS Server
Code number 0-255 IP address 1.0.0.1 ~ 126.255.255.254 128.1.0.1 ~ 191.254.255.254 192.0.1.1 ~ 223.255.254.254
6 (Fixed) 0.0.0.0
03 04 05
Code number 0-255 IP address 1.0.0.1 ~ 126.255.255.254 128.1.0.1 ~ 191.254.255.254 192.0.1.1 ~ 223.255.254.254
2 - 23
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 24
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-20 : LAN Setup for External Equipment to define the TCP port/ address/etc. for communicating to external equipment.
Input Data
Type of External Equipment
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 = = = = = = = = CTI Server ACD MIS Not Used Not Used SMDR Reserved Reserved Reserved
Item No. 01
Item
TCP Port
Default External Device 1 and 2 = 0 External Device 3 = 0 External Device 4 = 0 External Device 5 = 0
02 03
1~255 (sec)
30
Conditions None
2 - 25
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-21 : CPUII Hardware Setup to set up various hardware, such as the baud rate of COM port and the switch for control on CPUII.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 Item
--- Not Used --Baud rate for COM Port
Input Data
Default
Description
0 = 4800bps 1 = 9600bps 2 = 19200bps 3 = 38400bps 4 = 56000bps (set in PCPro only) 5 = 115200bps (set in PCPro only
03
Conditions None
2 - 26
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-24 : Daylight Savings Setup to set the options for daylight savings. As the telephone system is used globally, these settings define when the system should automatically adjust for daylight savings as it applies to the region in which the system is installed.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Daylight Savings Mode Enable (1) or disable (0) the systems ability to adjust the time for daylight savings/standard time.
Input Data
0 = Disable 1 = Enable
Default 1
Related Program
02
Time for Daylight Savings Enter the time of day the system should adjust for daylight savings time.
0000~2359
0200
03
Start of Month (Summer Time) Enter the month of system should adjust the time for daylight savings time (01~12).
1~12
04
Start of Week Enter the week of the month the system should adjust the time for daylight savings time (0 = last week of the month or 1~5).
05
Start of Week Day Enter the day of the week the system should adjust the time for daylight savings time (01 = Sunday, 02 = Monday, etc.).
06
End of Month Enter the month of system should adjust the time for standard time (01~12).
1~12
10
07
End of Week Enter the week of the month the system should adjust the time for standard time (0 = last week of the month or 1~5).
2 - 27
Document Revision 1
Item
Input Data
1~7 (Sun=1, Mon=2, etc.)
Default 1
Related Program
Conditions None
2 - 28
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 10-38 : BGM Resource Setup to configure the Background Music Source input.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
BGM Resource Type
Input Data
0 = CPUII (MOH/IN) 1 = ACI Port 0 ~ 96
Default 0
Related Program
02
ACI Port Number for BGM Source (only used if 10-38-01 is set to 1)
Conditions None
J J
2 - 29
Document Revision 1
2 - 30
Description
Use Program 11-01 : System Numbering to set the systems internal (Intercom) numbering plan. The numbering plan assigns the first and second digits dialed and affects the digits an extension user must dial to access other extensions and features, such as service codes and trunk codes. If the default numbering plan does not meet the site requirements, use this program to tailor the system numbering to the site.
Improperly programming this option can adversely affect system operation. Make sure you thoroughly understand the default numbering plan before proceeding. If you must change the standard numbering, use the chart for Table 2-2 System Numbering Default Settings on page 2-33 to keep careful and accurate records of your changes. Before changing your numbering plan, use the PC Program or Web PC Program to make a backup copy of your system data.
2 - 31
margorP
11
!NOITUAC
J J
Document Revision 1
the other codes are single digit. If you enter a two digit code between 0 and 9, be sure to make separate entries for all the other two digit codes within the range as well. This is because in the default program all the two digit codes between 0 and 9 are undefined.
Extension Number
3 4 5 6
Trunk Access Code Special Trunk Access Operator Access ARS/F-Route Access
Changing the Dial Type for a range of codes can have a dramatic affect on how your system operates. Assume, for example, the site is a hotel that has room numbers from 100-399. In order to make extension numbers correspond to room numbers, you should use Program 11-02 to reassign extension numbers on each floor from 100 to 399. (Other applications might also require you to change entries in Program 11-10 through 11-16.)
2 - 32
Related Program
11-10 : Service Code Setup (for System Administrator) 11-11 : Service Code Setup (for Registration) 11-12 : Service Code Setup (for Service Access) 11-13 : Service Code Setup (for ACD) 11-14 : Service Code Setup (for HOTEL) 11-15 : Service Code Setup (Special access) 11-16 : Service Code Setup (Single Digit) 11-02 : Extension Numbers 11-04 : Virtual Extension Numbers 11-06 : PGD(2)-U10 (ACI) Extension Numbers 11-07 : Department Calling Group Numbers 11-08 : PGD(2)-U10 (ACI) Group Pilot Numbers 11-09 : Trunk Access Code 11-09 : Trunk Access Code 20-17 : Operators Extension 44-xx
Document Revision 1
Default See the following tables for default settings. Table 2-2 System Numbering Default Settings
Dial Types: 1=Service Code, 2=Extension Number, 3=Trunk Access, 4=Special Trunk Access, 5=Operator Access, 6=Flexible Routing, 0=Not Used
Dialed
1X 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 10
3 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
1#
2X 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 20
2#
3 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
2 - 33
Document Revision 1
Dialed
3X 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 30
4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3#
4X 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 40
4#
2 - 34
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Document Revision 1
Dialed
5X 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 50
3 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
5#
6X 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 60
6#
3 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
2 - 35
Document Revision 1
Dialed
7X 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 70
3 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
7#
8X 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 80
8#
2 - 36
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Document Revision 1
Dialed
9X 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 90
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
9#
0X 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 00
0#
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
5 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
2 - 37
Document Revision 1
Dialed
X 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0
2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
2 - 38
, ,, , , , , , , , , , , ,
# #X #1 #2 #3 #4 #5 #6 #7 #8 #9 #0 ##
0 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 4 2
0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 39
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-02 : Extension Numbering to set the extension number. The extension number can be up to eight digits long. The first/second digit(s) of the number should be assigned in Program 11-01. This lets an employee move to a new location (port) and retain the same extension number.
Input Data
Extension Port Number 001 ~ 256
Item No. 01
Extension Number
Description
Set up extension numbers for Multiline telephones, single line telephones (Including SLTII Adapter, APR), and IP telephones. Extension number assignments cannot be duplicated in Programs 11-02, 11-06, 11-07, and 11-08.
Default
Extension Port Number 1 2 3 Extension Number 101 102 103
99 100
199 3101
256
3257
2 - 40
H H
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
J J J
2 - 41
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-04 : Virtual Extension Numbering to define the virtual extension numbers. The extension number can be up to eight digits long. The first/second digit(s) of the number should be assigned in Program 11-01.
Input Data
Virtual Extension Numbers 001~256
Item No. 01
Description Set up Virtual Extension Numbers. The extension number cannot be duplicated in Programs 11-02, 11-06, 11-07 and 11-08.
Default
Virtual Port Number 1 2 3 Extension Number 201 202 203
99 100
299 3301
256
3457
2 - 42
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
J J
2 - 43
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-06 : ACI Extension Numbering to define the virtual extension number to be used for the ACI. The extension number can be up to eight digits long. The first/ second digit(s) of the number should be assigned in Program 11-01.
Input Data
ACI Port Number 01~96
Item No. 01
Description The extension number cannot be duplicated in Programs 11-02, 11-04, 11-07 and 11-08.
Default
Conditions None
2 - 44
J J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-07 : Department Group Pilot Numbers to assign pilot numbers to each Department Group set up in Program 16-02. The pilot number is the number users dial for Department Calling and Department Step Calling. The pilot number can be up to eight digits long. The first/second digit(s) of the number should be assigned in Program 11-01 as type 2.
Input Data
Department (Extension) Group Number 01~64
Item No. 01
Description
Use this program to assign department group pilot numbers. The number set up by Program 11-02 (Extension Numbering) cannot be used. The extension number cannot be duplicated in Programs 11-02, 11-04, 11-06 and 11-08.
Related Program
16-01 : Department (Extension) Group Basic Data Setup 16-02 : Department Group Assignment for Extensions 16-03 : Secondary Department Group
Default
No Setting
Conditions None
H H H
J J
2 - 45
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-08 : ACI Group Pilot Number to assign the pilot number to the ACI Groups set in Program 33-02. The pilot number can be up to four digits long. The first/second digit(s) of the number should be assigned in Program 11-01 as type 2.
Input Data
ACI Group Number 01~16
Item No. 01
Description
The extension number cannot be duplicated in Programs 11-02, 11-04, 11-06 and 11-07.
Default
No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 46
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-09 : Trunk Access Code to assign the trunk access code (normally 9). The trunk access code can be set from 1 to 8 digits which is defined to type 3 and 4 in Program 11-01. This is the code extension users dial to access Automatic Route Selection. The Individual Trunk Access Code is used when Trunk Group Routing is desired for an outgoing line.
Caution!
The digit 9 is defined in Program 11-01 as Dial Type 3 with the Number of Digits Required set to 1. If you change the trunk access code in Program 11-09, you must make the corresponding changes in Program 11-01.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Trunk Access Code
Default 9
Description
Related Program
11-01 : System Numbering 14-01 : Trunk Basic Data Setup 14-05 : Trunk Group 14-06 : Trunk Group Routing
H H H H
Use this program to assign the trunk access code (normally 9). This is the code extension users dial to access Automatic Route Selection.
2 - 47
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 02 Item
2nd Trunk Route Access Code
Default No Setting
Description
Related Program
11-01 : System Numbering 14-01 : Trunk Basic Data Setup 14-05 : Trunk Group 14-06 : Trunk Group Routing 21-02 : Trunk Group Routing for Extensions 21-15 : Alternate Trunk Group Routing for Extensions
Conditions None
2 - 48
H H
When a user dials the Alternate Trunk Route Access Code, the system routes their call to the Alternate Trunk Route.
H H H
J J J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-10 : Service Code Setup (for System Administrator) to customize the Service Codes for the System Administrator. You can customize additional Service Codes in Programs 11-11 ~ 11-16. The following chart shows:
The number of each code (01~27). The function of the Service Code. The type of telephones that can use the Service Code. The default entry. For example, dialing (item 26) allows users to force a trunk line to disconnect.
J J J J
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 Item
Night Mode Switching
Default 718
--- Not Used --Setting the System Time Storing Common Speed Dialing Numbers Storing Group Speed Dialing Numbers Setting the Automatic Transfer for Each Trunk Line Canceling the Automatic Transfer for Each Trunk Line Setting the Destination for Automatic Trunk Transfer --- Not Used ----- Not Used ----- Not Used --Night Mode Switching for Other Group
MLT
618
12-xx 20-07-01
2 - 49
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
--- Not Used ----- Not Used ----- Not Used --Leaving Message Waiting Dial Block by Supervisor Off-Premise Call Forward by Door Box --- Not Used --VRS - Record/Erase Message VRS - General Message Playback VRS - Record or Erase General Message SMDR - Extension Accumulated Printout Code SMDR - Group Accumulated Printout Code Account Code Accumulated Printout Code Forced Trunk Disconnect Trunk Port Disable for Outgoing Calls --- Not Used ----- Not Used --Register DECTPP Delete DECTPP Set Private Call Refuse Entry Caller ID Refuse Set Caller ID Refuse Dial In Mode Switching Change the Guidance Message Number on Voice Mail Auto Attendant
Item
Terminals
Default
Related Program
Not Set Not Set Not Set Not Set Not Set Not Set Not Set
2 - 50
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 51
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-11 : Service Code Setup (for Setup/Entry Operation) to customize the Service Codes which are used for registration and setup. You can customize additional Service Codes in Programs 11-10, and 11-12 ~ 11-16. The following chart shows:
The number of each code (01~58). The function of the Service Code. What type of telephones can use the Service Code. The default entry. For example, dialing 725 (item 18) allows users to turn on or turn off Background Music.
2 - 52
J J J J
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13
Input Data
Item
Call Forward - All Call Forward - Busy Call Forward - No Answer Call Forward - Busy/No Answer Call Forward - Both Ring --- Not Used --Call Forwarding - Follow-Me Do Not Disturb Answer Message Waiting Cancel All Messages Waiting Cancel Message Waiting Alarm Clock Display Language Selection for Keyset
Terminals MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT
Related Program
MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Text Message Setting Enable Handsfree Incoming Intercom Calls
Item
Terminals MLT MLT MLT MLT MLT MLT MLT MLT MLT MLT MLT
Default
Related Program
721 723 751 725 724 720 711 700 679 677
Programmable Function Key Programming (Dialing 851 Service Code) BGM On/Off Key Touch Tone On/Off Change Incoming CO and ICM Ring Tones Check Incoming Ring Tones Extension Name Programming Second Call for DID/DISA/DIL Change Station Class of Service Allows an extension user to change the COS of another extension. Must be allowed in Program 2013-28.
15-02
15-01
20-13-28
25 26 27 28
Automatic Transfer Setup for Each Extension Group Automatic Transfer Cancellation for Each Extension Group Destination of Automatic Transfer Each Extension Group Delayed Transfer for Every Extension Group
20-11-17 24-05
29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
Delayed Transfer Cancellation for Each Extension Group DND Setup for Each Extension Group DND Cancellation for Each Extension Group --- Not Used --Dial Block Temporary Toll Restriction Override Pilot Group Withdrawing Toll Restriction Override
2 - 53
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 37 38 39 40 41 42
Ring Volume Set Programmable Function Key Programming (Dialing 852 Service Code) One-Touch Dial Number Entry --- Not Used --Tandem Ringing
Item
Related Program
15-07 11-11-17
15-07 30-03
Electra Elite IPK II Wireless Transferring When Out of Range Customize the service code to be used when setting a Electra Elite IPK II Wireless telephone to transfer calls when out of range.
43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58
Headset Mode Switching Auto Attendant Set/Cancel Call Forward All (Split) Set/Cancel Call Forward Busy (Split) Set/Cancel Call Forward No Answer (Split) Set/Cancel Call Forward Busy No Answer (Split) Set/Cancel Call Forward Both Ring (Split) --- Not Used ----- Not Used --Set/Cancel Call Forward All Destination (No Split) Set/Cancel Call Forward Busy Destination (No Split) Set/Cancel Call Forward No Answer Destination (No Split) Call Forward Busy No Answer Destination (No Split) --- Not Used --Set Do Not Call Table
MLT, SLT MLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT
688
2 - 54
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 55
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-12 : Service Code Setup (for Service Access) to customize the Service Codes which are used for service access. You can customize additional Service Codes in Programs 11-10, 11-11, and 11-13 through 11-16. The following chart shows:
The number of each code (01~59). The function of the Service Code. The type of telephones that can use the Service Code. The default entry. For example, dialing 705 (code 05) will cancel a previously set Camp-On. Programs that may be affected with the changing the code.
If you change a Service Code, be sure to record your entry in the New column.
Input Data
Item No. 01
Bypass Call Activating Call Forwarding/Do Not Disturb Override. This code is only available if you disable the voice mail Single Digit dialing code in Program 11-16-09.
02 03 04 05 06 07 08
2 - 56
J J J J J
Item
Default 707
New
Conference Override (Off-Hook Signaling) Set Camp-On Cancel Camp-On Switching of Voice Call and Signal Call Step Call Barge-In
MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT
Document Revision 1
Terminals MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT
Default #2 #4 #5 715 704 #9 776 785 701 703 764 765 763 *1 756 768 *# 769 ** 672 #6 *6 732 762 757 702
New
31-01-01
31-07
24-03 24-03
2 - 57
Document Revision 1
New
Related Program
#7 690 #3 #0 799 749 759 794 15-03-07 15-03-08 11-12-03 14-05 14-06 11-16-08
48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Account Code --- Not Used --General Purpose Relay VM Access (In-Mail and VMS) Live Monitoring (In-Mail) Live Recording at SLT VRS Routing for ANI/DNIS Use when setting up ANI/DNIS Routing to the VRS Automated Attendant. Using the Transfer feature, this also allows a call to be transferred to the VRS.
SLT
##
780 *8
654 782
55 56
--- Not Used --E911 Alarm Shut Off Enter the Service Code that an extension user can dial to shut off the E911 Alarm Ring.
MLT, SLT
786
20-08-16 21-01-13
57 58
Tandem Trunking Transfer Into Conference Assign the Service Code users dial to Transfer a call into a Conference call.
59
SLT
2 - 58
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 59
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-13 : Service Code Setup (for ACD) to customize the Service Codes which are used with the Automatic Call Distribution (ACD) feature. You can customize additional Service Codes in Programs 11-10 through 11-12 and 11-14 ~ 11-16. The following chart shows:
The number of each code (01~13). The function of the Service Code. The type of telephones that can use the Service Code. The default entry.
If you change a Service Code, be sure to record your entry in the New column.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 Item
ACD Log In / Log Out (for KTS) ACD Log Out (for SLT) Set ACD Wrap-Up Time (for SLT) Cancel ACD Wrap-Up Time (for SLT) Set ACD Off Duty (for SLT) Cancel ACD Off Duty (for SLT) --- Not Used ---
2 - 60
J J J J
Terminals
Default 5
New
MLT, SLT
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 11 Item
ACD Agent Logout by Supervisor
Allows an ACD Supervisor to log out of a group.
Terminals
Default 668
New
MLT
12
MLT
669
13
MLT
670
Conditions None
2 - 61
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-14 : Service Code Setup (for Hotel) to customize the Service Codes which are used with the Hotel/Motel feature. You can customize additional Service Codes in Programs 11-10 through 11-13, 11-15 and 11-16. The Service Codes can only be used at telephones registered as hotel terminals in Program 42-02. The following chart shows:
The number of each code (01~18). The function of the Service Code. The type of telephones that can use the Service Code. The default entry.
If you change a Service Code, be sure to record your entry in the New column.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 Item
Set DND for Own Extension Cancel DND for Own Extension Set DND for Other Extension Cancel DND for Other Extension Set Wake Up Call for Own Extension Cancel Wake Up Call for Own Extension Set Wake Up Call for Other Extension Cancel Wake Up Call for Other Extension Set Room to Room Call Restriction Cancel Room to Room Call Restriction (Hotel) Change Toll Restriction Class for Other Extension Check-In
2 - 62
J J J J
Terminals MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT MLT, SLT
Default 627 628 629 630 631 632 633 634 635 636 637 638
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 13 14 15 16 17 18
Check-Out --- Not Used --Room Status Change for Other Extension Room Status Output Hotel Room Monitor ---Not Used ---
Item
Default 639
Conditions None
2 - 63
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-15 : Service Code Setup, Administrative (for Special Access) to customize the special access Service Codes which are used by the administrator in the Hotel/Motel feature. You can customize additional Service Codes in Programs 11-10 ~ 11-14 and 11-16. The following chart shows:
The number of each code (01~11) The function of the Service Code. What type of telephones can use the Service Code. The default entry. Programs that may be affected when changing the code.
If you change a Service Code, be sure to record your entry in the New column.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 Item
Remote Maintenance ACD Access in Dial-In Conversion Table Backup Data Save This option will save the users soft key settings (extensions programmed Call Forwards, DND, etc.). It is recommended to use this feature before upgrading the system software.
04 05 06 07
2 - 64
J J J J J
Terminals
New
Related Program
22-04 22-11
MLT
#*#9
--- Not Used --System Programming Mode, Log-On Wake on LAN to APSU Unit
MLT MLT
#*#* No Setting
11-01 10-22
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 Item
Network Message Lamp Control Transfer to Incoming Ring Group
Terminals
New
Related Program
--- Not Used --Ethernet Port Reset Extension Data Swap --- Not Used --Modem Access
MLT, SLT
740
Conditions None
2 - 65
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-16 : Single Digit Service Code Setup to customize the one-digit Service Codes used when a busy or ring back signal is heard. You can customize additional Service Codes in Programs 11-10 through 11-15. The following chart shows:
The number of each code (01~11). The function of the Service Code. The type of telephones that can use the Service Code. The default entry. For example, dialing 1 (code 03) when calling an extension will switch the call from either a voice or signal call (depending on how it is currently defined). Programs that may be affected by changing these codes.
If you change a Service Code, be sure to record your entry in the New column.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11
Step Call Barge In Switching of Voice/Signal Call Intercom Off-Hook Signaling Camp-On DND/Call Forward Override Bypass Message Waiting Voice Over Access to Voice Mail (Department) STG All Ring Mode
2 - 66
J J J J J
Item
Default 2 No Setting 1
New
Related Program 11-12-07 11-12-08 11-12-06 11-12-03 11-12-04 11-12-01 11-12-09 11-12-41 11-12-51 11-12-09 16-01-05 11-12-35
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 67
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 11-17 : ACD Group Pilot Number to assign the ACD Master Number for each ACD Group. This is the number users dial to transfer calls to the ACD Group. Normally, you should use unassigned extension numbers (e.g., 500) for the master number. If you want to use an extension number which, by default, has a port number assigned (for example: in the 101~199, 3101~3257), first remove the default assignment. For example, to use extension number 125 as an ACD Master Number, first give extension port 025 a different extension assignment.
Input Data
ACD Group Number 01~64
Item No. 01
Default
Conditions None
2 - 68
J J
Description
Use Program 12-01 : Night Mode Function Setup to set up the Night Mode options. Refer to the following chart for a description of each option, its range and default setting.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Manual Night Mode Switching
Default 1
Description
Allows/prevents users from activating Night Service by dialing a service code. According to a preset schedule, enable or disable Automatic Night Service for the system.
02
0 = Off 1 = On
03
Even if the operation mode is changed manually, the operation mode changes according to the schedule set up.
Conditions None
2 - 69
margorP
12
J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 12-02 : Automatic Night Service Patterns to define the daily pattern of the Automatic Mode Switching. Each Mode Group has 10 patterns. These patterns are used in Programs 12-03 and 12-04. The daily pattern consists of 20 timer settings.
Input Data
Night Mode Service Group Number Time Pattern Number Set Time Number 01~32 01~10 01~20
Item 01 02 03
Example:
Time Pattern 1
0:00 Mode 3 (midnight) 9:00 Mode 1 (day) 12:00 Mode 4 (rest) 13:00 Mode 1 (day) 17:00 Mode 4 (rest) 18:00 Mode 2 (night) 22:00 Mode 3 (midnight) 0:00
2 - 70
Document Revision 1
Time Pattern 2
0:00
00:00 to 00:00
Mode 2 (night)
Mode 2 1 2 1 : 1
Mode 2 1 : 1
Mode 1 : 1
Conditions None
2 - 71
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 12-03 : Weekly Night Service Switching to define a weekly schedule of night-switch settings.
Input Data
Night Mode Service Group Number 01~32
Item No. 01
2 - 72
Document Revision 1
Default
Time Schedule Pattern Number 2 1 1 1 1 1 2
Conditions None
2 - 73
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 12-04 : Holiday Night Service Switching to define a yearly schedule of holiday night-switch settings. This schedule is used for the setting of special days which the company is expected to be closed, such as a national holiday.
Input Data
Night Mode Service Group Number 01~32
Item No. 01
Days and Months 0101~1231 (ex: 0101 = Jan. 1; 1231 = Dec. 31)
Default
No setting
Conditions None
2 - 74
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 12-05 : Night Mode Group Assignment for Extensions to a assign Day/Night Mode Group for each extension.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum: 8 Digits
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions None
2 - 75
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 12-06 : Night Mode Group Assignment for Trunks to assign a Day/ Night Mode Group for each trunk port.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions None
2 - 76
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 12-07 : Text Data for Night Mode to make an original text message which is displayed on an LCD of Multiline telephone in each Mode.
Input Data
Night Mode Service Group Number Day/Night Mode 01~32 1~8
Item No. 01
Default
Mode 1 = No setting Mode 2 = <Night> Mode 3 = <Midnight> Mode 4 = <Rest> Mode 5 = <Day2> Mode 6 = <Night2> Mode 7 = <Midnight2> Mode 8 = <Rest2>
Conditions None
H H H H H H H H
2 - 77
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 12-08 : Night Mode Service Range to define the changing range of toggle key for each Day/Night Mode.
Input Data
Night Mode Service Group Number 01~32
Item No. 01
Example: When Program 12-08 is set to 3 and the Mode Key is pressed (SC 751, 09 +0), the following modes are switched:
Press once = Night Press twice = Mid-night Press third = Day Default = 2
2 - 78
J J J J J
Conditions None
Description
Use Program 13-01 : Speed Dialing Function Setup to define the Speed Dialing functions.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Speed Dialing Auto Outgoing Call Mode
0
Input Data
= Trunk Outgoing Mode = Intercom Outgoing Mode
Default 0
02 03
--- Not Used --Number of Common Speed Dialing Bins 0~2000 0 = No Common Speed Dialing 100 bins per 1 unit
1000
13-04
Conditions None
2 - 79
margorP
13
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 13-02 : Group Speed Dialing Bins to define the range of bin numbers to be used by each Speed Dialing group. (Refer to 13-03 : Speed Dialing Group Assignment for Extensions).
Input Data
Item No. 01 Speed Dialing Group Number
01~64
Default
No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 80
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 13-03 : Speed Dialing Group Assignment for Extensions to assign Speed Dialing Group for each extension. There are 64 Speed Dialing groups that are available.
Input Data
Extension Number Up to 8 digits
Item No. 01
Default Value 1
Conditions None
2 - 81
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 13-04 : Speed Dialing Number and Name to store Speed Dialing data into the Speed Dialing areas. This program is also used to define the names assigned to the Speed Dialing numbers.
Input Data
Speed Dialing Bin Number 0~1999
Item No. 01
Item
Speed Dialing Data
Input Data 1~9, 0, , #, Pause (Press line key 1), Recall/Flash (Press line key 2), @ = Additional Digit for ISDN Functionality (Press line key 3) (max. 24 digits)
Maximum 12 Characters (Use dial pad to enter name) 0 1 2 = Not Used = Internal Dial = Incoming Ring Group (IRG)
Default No Setting
Related Program
02 03
Name
Transfer Mode
04
If Transfer mode is (Refer to 13-03-03): 1: Internal Dial Mode 1~9, 0, , #, P,R,@ (Maximum 24 Characters) 2: Incoming Ring Group 0 ~ 100 (IRG Number) P=Pause R=Recall @= Additional Digits when using ISDN functionality
2 - 82
, ,
No Setting 0
No Setting
13-04-03
Document Revision 1
Item No. 05
Item
Incoming Ring Pattern
Input Data
Incoming Ring Pattern 0 = Normal Pattern 1 ~ 4 = Tone Pattern (1~4) 5 ~ 9 = Scale Pattern (1~5)
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 83
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 13-05 : Speed Dialing Trunk Group to define the trunk group to be seized for each Speed Dialing number. If this program has an entry of 0 (no setting), then seizing a line follows the trunk access group routing of the callers extension (refer to Program 14-06). This setting is only available in External Speed Dialing Mode (Program 13-01-01).
Input Data
Speed Dialing Bin Number 0~1999
Item No. 01
Default
No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 84
Description
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Item
Trunk Name Set the names for trunks. The trunk name displays at the display of a multiline terminal for incoming and outgoing calls.
Input Data
Up to 12 Characters
Default
Line 001 Line 002 Line 003 : Line 200
Related Program
02
Transmit Level Use this option to select the CODEC gain for the trunk. The option sets the amount of gain (signal amplification) for the trunk you are programming.
32 (0dB)
03
Receive Level Use this option to select the CODEC gain for the trunk. The option sets the amount of gain (signal amplification) for the trunk you are programming.
32 (0dB)
2 - 85
margorP
Use Program 14-01 : Basic Trunk Data Setup to set the basic options for each trunk port. Refer to the chart below for a description of each option, its range and default setting.
14
Document Revision 1
Item No. 04
Item
Transmit Gain Level for Conference and Transfer Calls Use this option to select the CODEC gain type used by the trunk when it is part of an Unsupervised Conference.
Input Data
1~63 (-15.5 ~ +15.5dB in 0.5dB intervals)
Default
22 (-5dB)
Related Program
05
Receive Gain Level for Conference and Transfer Calls Use this option to select the CODEC gain type used by the trunk when it is part of an Unsupervised Conference.
22 (-5dB)
06
SMDR Print Out Use this option to have the system include/exclude the trunk you are programming from the SMDR printout. See Program 35-01 and 35-02 for SMDR printout options.
0 1
35-01 35-02
07
Outgoing Calls Use this option to allow/prevent outgoing calls on the trunk you are programming.
0 1
08
Toll Restriction Use this option to enable/disabled Toll Restriction for the trunk. If enabled, the trunk follows Toll Restriction programming (ex: Programs 21-05, 21-06). If disabled, the trunk is a toll free line.
2 - 86
Document Revision 1
Item No. 09
Item
Private Line
0
Input Data
= Disable Private Line (Normal) = Enable Private Line (Private Line) = Disable (No) = Enable (Yes)
Default
0
Related Program
10
DTMF Tones for Outgoing Calls Use this option to enable (1) or disable (0) DTMF tones for outgoing trunk calls.
0 1
11
0 1
12 13
-- Not Used -Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer Use this option to enable (1) or disable (0) loop supervision for the trunk. This option is required for Call Forwarding Off-Premise and Tandem Trunking only.
0 1 = Disable (No) = Enable (Yes)
14
Long Conversation Cutoff Use this option to enable or disable the Long Conversation Cutoff feature for each trunk.
0 1
20-21-03 20-21-04
15
Long Conversation Alarm Before Cutoff Use this option to enable or disable the Long Conversation Alarm for each trunk.
0 1
20-21-01 20-21-02
2 - 87
Document Revision 1
Item No. 16
Item
Forced Release of Held Call Use this option to enable/disable forced release for calls on Hold. If enabled, the system disconnects a call if it is on Hold longer than a programmed interval (Program 24-01-05). If disabled, forced disconnection does not occur. Program 24-01-01 also affects this option.
0 1
Input Data
= Disable (No) = Enable (Yes)
Default
0
17
Trunk to Trunk Warning Tone for Long Conversation Alarm Use this option to enable or disable the Warning Tone for Long Conversation feature for DISA callers.
0 1
18
0 1
19
Privacy Mode Toggle Option Use this option to enable or disable a trunks ability to be switched from private to non-private mode by pressing the line key or Privacy Release function key.
0 1
2 - 88
Document Revision 1
Item No. 20
Item
Block Outgoing Caller ID Allow (1) or prevent (0) the system from automatically blocking outgoing Caller ID information when a user places a call. If allowed (i.e. block, enabled), the system automatically inserts the Caller ID block code (defined in 14-01-21) before the user dialed digits.
0 1
Input Data
= Disable (No) = Enable (Yes)
Default
0
Enter the code, up to 8 digits, that should be used as the Caller ID Block Code. This code is automatically inserted before dialed digits if Program 14-01-20 is set to 1.
22
Caller ID to Voice Mail Enable or disable the systems ability to send the Caller ID digits (Remote Log-On Protocol) to voice mail.
0 1
23
0 = LCR Off (Service Off) 1 = LCR On (Service On) 2 = Cost Center Only
24
0 1
25
0 1
26
21
67
14-01-20
2 - 89
Document Revision 1
Item No. 27
Item
Caller ID Refuse Setup
0 1
Input Data
= Disable (No) = Enable (Yes)
Default
0
Related Program
28
Default
Trunk Port Number 001 002 : 200 Name LINE 001 LINE 002 : LINE 200
Conditions None
2 - 90
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 14-02 : Analog Trunk Data Setup to set the basic options for each analog trunk port. Refer to the chart below for a description of each option, its range and default setting.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Item
Signaling Type (DP/DTMF) This option sets the signaling type for the trunk.
0 1 2 0 1
Input Data
= Dial Pulse (10 PPS) = Dial Pulse (20 PPS) = DTMF = Normal/delayed = Immediate Ringing
Default 2
Related Program
02
Ring Detect Type This option sets Extended Ring Detect or Immediate Ring Detect for the trunk. For T1 loop/ground start trunks, this option must be set to 1 in order for the trunks to ring and lamp correctly.
03
Flash Type This option to select the flash type (open loop flash or ground). Always set this option for open loop flash.
0 1
04
Hooking Type This option lets you use Flash for Timed Flash (Program 81-01-14) or Disconnect (Program 81-01-15). (A user implements Flash by pressing the FLASH key while on a trunk call.)
0 1
81-10-07 81-10-08
05
Dial Tone Detection for Manual Accessed Trunks Use this option enable/disable dial tone detection for directly accessed trunks. If disabled, the system outdials on the trunks without monitoring for dial tone.
0 1
21-01-04
06
0 1
21-01-06
2 - 91
Document Revision 1
Item No. 07
Item
DP to DTMF Conversion Options Determine how a user can convert a Dial Pulse (DP) call to a DTMF call. For each trunk, set the type of DP to DTMF conversion required. There are three conversion options: Automatic (0), Automatic and Manual (1), or Manual (2). Automatic: DP to DTMF conversion occurs automatically if the extension user waits more than 10 seconds before dialing the next digit. Automatic and Manual: DP to DTMF conversion occurs automatically if the extension user waits more than 10 seconds before dialing the next digit. In addition, the user can dial # to switch a DP trunk to DTMF dialing. Manual: User can dial # to switch a DP trunk to DTMF dialing
Input Data
0 = Automatic 1 = Automatic and Manual 2 = Manual
Default 2
08
Answering Condition
21-01-03
09 10
Busy Tone Detection Caller ID Enable or disable a trunk to receive Caller ID information.
0 1 0 1
0 0
11
Next Trunk in Rotary if No Dial Tone Use this option to enable/disable the systems ability to skip over a trunk if dial tone is not detected. This option pertains to calls placed using Speed Dial, ARS, Last Number Redial or Save Number dialed. It does not pertain to line key or Direct Trunk Access calls.
0 1
12 13
0 1 0 1
1 0
2 - 92
Document Revision 1
Item No. 14
Item
Loop Start/Ground Start
0 1
Input Data
= Loop Start (Loop) = Ground Start (Ground)
Default 0
Related Program
15 16 17
--- Not Used --Caller ID Type Sync. Ringing Use this to specify whether or not CO/ PBX calls follow Synchronous Ringing.
0 = FSK 1 = DTMF 0 = Disable 1 = Enable
0 1
Synchronous Ringing does not apply to incoming DID calls, off-hook ringing calls, or CO/ PBX ring transfer calls.
Conditions None
2 - 93
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 14-04 : Behind PBX Setup to indicate if the trunk is installed behind a PBX. There is one item for each of the modes.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1~200
Item No. 01
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 94
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 14-05 : Trunk Groups to assign trunks to Trunk Groups. You can also assign the outbound priority for trunks within the group. When users dial up the trunk group, they seize the trunks in the order you specify in the outbound priority entry.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Default
Trunk Port 1 : 200 Group 1 : 1 Priority 1 : 200
Conditions None
2 - 95
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 14-06 : Trunk Group Routing to set up an outbound routing table for the trunk groups you assigned in Program 14-05. When users dial 9, the system routes their calls in the order (priority) specified. For example, if a user dials 9 and all calls in the first group are busy, the system may route the call to another group. Trunk Access Map programming (Programs 14-07) may limit this option. The system contains 100 routing tables for trunk access. Each table has four priority orders for trunk access. There are 100 Trunk Group Numbers that are available.
Example for setting: With less than 4 trunk groups, Route Number 1 : Order 1 Trunk Group 1 : Order 2 Trunk Group 2 For the above setting, if all the lines in trunk group 1 are busy, the system searches for an idle line in trunk group 2. With more than 4 trunk groups, Route Number 1 : Order 1 Trunk Group 1 : Order 2 Trunk Group 2 : Order 3 Trunk Group 3 : Order 4 1002 (Jump To Route Number 2) Route Number 2 : Order 1 Trunk Group 4 : Order 2 Trunk Group 5 For the above setting, if all the lines in the trunk group 1, 2 and 3 are busy, the system searches for an idle line in trunk group 4 and 5.
2 - 96
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Route Table Number 001~100
Item No. 01
Input Data 0 = Not Specify 1-8 or 001~100 : (Trunk Group Number) 1001~1100 : (1000 + Route Table Number)
Default
Route 1, Order Number 1 = 1 (Trunk Group 1). Order Numbers 2, 3, 4 = 0 (Not Specified). All Other Routes (2~100) and Order Numbers (1-4) = 0 (Not Specified).
Conditions None
H H H
2 - 97
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 14-07 : Trunk Access Map Setup to set up the Trunk Access Maps. This sets an extensions access options for trunks. For example, an extension can only place outgoing calls on trunks to which it has outgoing access. There are 200 Access Maps with all 200 trunk ports programmed in Map 1 with full access. An extension can use one of the maps you set up in this program. Use Program 15-06 to assign Trunk Access Maps to extensions. Each trunk can have one of eight access options for each Access Map.
Input Data
Access Map Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Input Data No access Outgoing access only Incoming access only Access only when trunk on Hold Outgoing access and access when trunk on Hold Incoming access and access when trunk on Hold Incoming and Outgoing access Incoming access, outgoing access and access when trunk on Hold
Default
Access Map 1 = Trunk Ports 1~200 assigned with option 7 access (incoming and outgoing access and access when trunk is on Hold). Access Maps 2~200 - Trunk Ports 1~200 assigned with option 0 access (no access).
2 - 98
H H
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
J J
2 - 99
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 14-08 : Music on Hold Source for Trunks to define a Music on Hold source for a trunk as either the ACI or COI port.
2 - 100
01 02
If ACI is selected as the source in Item 1, the port number for the source must be selected in Item 2.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number Item No.
MOH Type Select a Music on Hold source for the trunk.
001~200
Item
0 1 2
Input Data
= Internal synthesized/external MOH = A customer-provided source connected to BGM port = A customer-provided source connected to ACI port
Default 0
Conditions None
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 14-09 : Conversation Recording Destination for Trunks to set the ACI Conversation Recording destination for each trunk.
Item No. 01 02 03 04
If both Programs 14-09 and 15-12 define a destination, the destination in Program 15-12 will be followed.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item
ACI Recording Destination Extension Number Enter the ACI extension number to which the trunk calls should be recorded. ACI Automatic Recording for Incoming Calls Determine if incoming trunk calls should be automatically recorded to the ACI. --- Not Used ----- Not Used ---
Default No Setting
0 = Off 1 = On
Conditions None
2 - 101
Document Revision 1
Description
This program defines the CCIS route ID to the trunk group used for K-CCIS.
Input Data
Trunk Group Number Item No. 01 001~100
Input Data
0 = Not Assigned 1 ~ 8 = CCIS Route IDs
CCIS Route IDs 5~ 8 are used for future and should not be used.
Default Settings
Not Assigned
Conditions None
2 - 102
H
Document Revision 1
Description
This program defines the CIC (Circuit Identifier Code) to each voice channel (trunk port) used for K-CCIS.
Input Data
Trunk Group Number Item No. 01 001 ~ 200
Input Data
0 = Not Assigned 1 ~ 127 CIC Numbers
Default 14-05-01
Default Settings
Not Assigned
Conditions
H H H
CIC Numbers must be assigned consecutively for K-CCIS to operate correctly. The D-Channel trunk port should not have a CIC assignment.
2 - 103
Document Revision 1
2 - 104
Description
Use Program 15-01 : Basic Extension Data Setup to define the basic settings for each extension.
The item numbers indicated below are different when using PCPro/WebPro. Refer to the program within the PCPro/WebPro application to determine the correct item number.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Item
Extension Name Define the extension/virtual extension name.
Default
Related Program
02
Outgoing Trunk Line Preference Use this option to set the extensions outgoing Trunk Line Preference. If enabled, the extension user trunk dial tone when they lift the handset. The user hears trunk dial tone only if allowed by Trunk Access Map programming (Programs 14-07 and 15-06). Refer to the Line Preference feature for more details.
0 1
= Off = On
14-06 21-02
03
SMDR Printout Use this option to include or exclude the extension in the SMDR report.
0 1
2 - 105
margorP
15
Document Revision 1
Item No. 04
Item
ISDN Caller ID If both Program 15-01-04 and 10-03-05 are enabled, the system includes Caller ID in the Setup message as Presentation Allowed. If these options are disabled, it will be Presentation Restricted.
Default 1
05
Restriction for Outgoing Disable on Incoming Line Enable or disable supervised dial detection for an extension.
0 = No 1 = Yes
06 07
0 = Off 1 = On
21-01-19
Conditions None
2 - 106
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-02 : Multiline Telephone Basic Data Setup to set up various Multiline telephone options. Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Item
Display Language Selection (To select options 8-10, press either 8 or Recall, then press line keys 1-3. Key 1 is option 8, Key 2 is option 9, and Key 3 is option 10.)
Input Data
0 = 1 = 2 = 3 = 4 = 5 = 6 = 7 = 8 = 9 = 10 = 11 = 12 = 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 = = = = = = = = Japanese English German French Italian Spanish Dutch Portuguese Norwegian Danish Swedish Turkish Latin American Spanish High Medium Low Ring Tone 1 Ring Tone 2 Ring Tone 3 Ring Tone 4 Ring Tone 5
Default 1
02
Trunk Ring Tone Use this option to set the tone (pitch) of the incoming trunk ring for the extension port you are programming.
22-03
2 - 107
Document Revision 1
Item No. 03
Item
Extension Ring Tone Use this option to set the tone (pitch) of the incoming extension call ring for the extension port you are programming. Also see program 15-08.
Input Data
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0 = = = = = = = = High Medium Low Ring Tone 1 Ring Tone 2 Ring Tone 3 Ring Tone 4 Ring Tone 5
Default 8
Related Program
04
Redial (Speed Dial) Control Use this option to control the function of the extensions Redial key when used with Speed Dialing. The Redial key can access either the Common or Group Speed Dialing numbers.
05
Transfer Key Operation Mode Use this option to set the operating mode of the extensions CONF key. The keys can be for Call Transfer, Serial Calling or Flash. When selecting the Flash option (selection 2), refer also to Program 81-01-14.
0 1 2
06
Hold Key Operating Mode Use this option to set the function of the Multiline Hold key. The Hold key can activate normal Hold or Exclusive Hold.
0 1
07 08
0 1 0 1
1 1
Automatic Handsfree Use this option to set whether pressing a key access a One-Touch Key or if it pre-selects the key.
09 10
--- Not Used --Ringing Line Preference for Trunk Calls Use this option to select between Idle and Ringing Line Preference for trunk calls.
0 1
11
Callback Automatic Answer Use this option to enable or disable automatic answer for Callback. If enabled, extension automatically answers Callback ring when user lifts the handset. If disabled, use must press line appearance key to answer Callback.
0 1
= Off = On
2 - 108
Document Revision 1
Item No. 12
Item
Off-Hook Ringing Use this option to set the keysets OffHook signaling. Off-hook signaling occurs when a keyset user receives a second call while busy on a handset call. To enable/disable Off-Hook Signaling for an extensions Class of Service, use Program 20-13-06.
Input Data
0 1 2 3 4 5 0 = Muted Off-Hook Ringing = No Off-Hook Ringing = Not Used = Beep in Speaker (SP) = Beep in Handset (HS) = SPHS Beep = ICM/Trunk (Extension/Trunk Mode) = Trunk Mode
Default 5
Related Program
13
Redial List Mode Select whether the Redial List feature should store internal and external numbers (0), or only external numbers (1).
14 15 16
1 1
Handsfree Operation Enable or disable an extensions ability to use the speakerphone on outside calls. When disabled, users can hear the conversation, but cannot respond handsfree.
17 18
0 1 0 1 = Normal mode = Power-Saving Mode (Eco-Mode) = CTI Mode = Non Procedural Mode (Non-SCS)
19
CTA Data Communication Mode Select 0 if the dip switch settings on the CTA Adapter are set to PC connection (1=on, 2~8=off) or select 1 if the dip switches are set to printer connection (1~2=on, 3~8=off).
15-02-20
20
Baud Rate for CTA Port Select the baud rate to be used by the CTA Adapter.
0 1 2
15-02-19
2 - 109
Document Revision 1
Item No. 21
Item
Virtual Extension Access Mode (when idle Virtual Extension key pressed) Determine whether a Virtual Extension/ Call Arrival Key(CAR) should function as a DSS key, a Virtual Extension, or a CAR key. When DSS (0) is selected, the key functions as a DSS key to the extension and for incoming calls to that extension. When Outgoing (1) is selected, the key functions as a virtual extension and can be used for incoming and outgoing calls. When Ignore (2) is selected, the key functions as a CAR key and can receive incoming calls only.
Input Data
0 1 2 = DSS = Outgoing (OTG) = Ignore
Default 2
Related Program
22
Multiple Incoming From Intercom and Trunk If enabled, this affects how a Hotline key lamps, based on the setting in Program 22-01-01. If 22-01-01 is set to 1 for trunk priority, the Hotline key will lamp solid when a trunk call rings in. If 22-01-01 is set to 0 for intercom priority, the Hotline key will not lamp for incoming trunk calls, but will lamp solid for intercom calls. If 15-02-22 is disabled, Hotline keys will lamp solid for any incoming calls regardless of the setting in Program 22-01-01.
0 1
= Disable = Enable
22-01-01
23
Speed Dial Preview Mode This option defines how a speed dial key functions when pressed. If set to Preview (0), the speed dial number can be previewed before dialing. If set to Outgoing Immediate (1), the number is dialed immediately.
0 1
24
Conference Key Mode This option allows an extensions CONF key to be programmed for Conference or for Transfer. When set for Transfer (1), the user places a call on hold, dials the extension to which it should be transferred, the presses the CONF key. The call is then transferred. When set for Conference (0), with an active call, the user presses the CONF key, places a second call, then presses the CONF key twice. All the calls are then connected.
0 1
= Conference = Transfer
2 - 110
Document Revision 1
Item No. 26
Item
Multiline Telephone Basic Data Setup, MSG Key Operation Mode Determine whether an extensions MSG key should function as a Message key or Voice Mail key. If set as a Message key, the user will be able to press the key to call the voice mail only when they have new messages.
Input Data
0 1 = Message Key = Voice Mail Key
Default 0
Related Program
27
Handset Volume Determine how an extensions handset volume will be set after it is adjusted during a call.
0 1 0 1
28
Message Waiting Lamp Color Determine whether an extensions Message Waiting Lamp lights Green (0) or Red (1) when a message is received.
29
PB Back Tone Level This program allows adjustment of the PB Back Tone Level when you are calling an ISDN Line.
32
30
Toll Restriction Class Select the Toll Restriction Class to be used when placing a call from a virtual extension.
= Vir. Ext Vir. Ext (Virtual Extensions Class) = Real Ext (Real Extensions Class)
2 - 111
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 112
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-03 : Single Line Telephone Basic Data Setup to set up various single line telephone options.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No 01
SLT Signaling Type
Item
0 1
Input Data
= DP = DTMF
Default 1
Related Program
Use this option to tell the system the type of dialing the connected telephone uses. In order for the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless telephones to function correctly, this must be set to 0 (dial pulse). If this option is set for DTMF, after an outside call is placed, the system will not dial any additional digits. This program change is automatically performed when the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless telephone is registered when using system software 1.13+. When upgrading software from prior versions, the previous default of 1 will be saved from the prior database so this option must be changed manually.
02 03
--- Not Used --Terminal Type Enter 1 for this option to allow a single line port to receive DTMF tones after the initial call setup. Enter 0 to have the port ignore DTMF tones after the initial call setup. For Voice Mail, always enter 1 (e.g., receive DTMF tones).
0 1
= Normal = Special
04
0 1 0 1
= No = Yes = Off = On
05
Trunk Polarity Reverse Not Used in U.S. - Do Not Change Default Entry as DTMF issues may arise with voice mail.
2 - 113
Document Revision 1
Item No 06
Item
Extension Polarity Reverse
Input Data
0 1 = Disable (Off) = Enable (On) = No = Yes = Disable (No) = Yes (Enable) = Disable (Off) = Enable (On)
Default 0
Related Program
-- Not Used in U.S. -Do Not Change Default Entry as DTMF issues may arise with voice mail.
07 08
0 1 0 1
1 1
11-12-45 11-12-46
09
Caller ID Function - For External Module Enable (1) or disable (0) the Caller ID FSK signal for an external Caller ID module or a 3rd party vendor telephone with Caller ID display. Important: If voice mail is used, this setting must be disabled or the system integration codes for disconnect will be incorrect.
0 1
With some earlier software, if a 2500 set (no Caller ID) is installed, this must be set to 0 or else incoming callers will not have a talk path.
10
11
12 13 14
15
2 - 114
Caller ID Name Determine if an extension users telephone should display the Caller ID name. Caller ID Type Determine whether the Caller ID type is FSK or DTMF. --- Not Used ----- Not Used --Forwarded Caller ID Display Mode Determine what the display shows when a multiline terminal receives a forwarded outside call.
0 1 0 1
15-03-09
Disconnect without dial after hooking hold Determine whether or not to disconnect a held call when on-hook without any dialing after hooking-hold.
0 1
Document Revision 1
(1)
Normal Outgoing Call Idle Reverse
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Normal
Incoming Call
Idle Reverse
Normal
Call Pickup
Idle Reverse
(1) = Off-Hook (2) = Calling/Ringing (3) = Answer (4) = Detect Hang Up (5) = On-Hook
Conditions None
J J
2 - 115
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-05 : IP Telephone Terminal Basic Data Setup to set up the basic settings for an IP telephone.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01 02
Item
Terminal Type
Input Data
3 = MEGACO
Default 0 00-00-00-00-00-00
Description
Viewing Only - No changes permitted For any IP telephone, the MAC Address as indicated on the telephone/adapters label to assign a specific extension number.
Related Program
15-05-01
06
1 = IP70 2 = IP80 3 = Smart Phone 0.0.0.0 ~ 255.255.255.255 1-Type 1 2-Type 2 3-Type 3 4-Type 4 5-Type 5
07 15
Using IP Address
0.0.0.0 1
15-05-01
CODEC Type
Conditions None
2 - 116
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-06 : Trunk Access Map for Extensions to define the trunk access map for each extension. An extension can only place outgoing calls on trunks to which it has outgoing access. Use Program 14-07 to define the available access maps.
Input Data
Extension Number Day/Night Mode Maximum 8 digits 1~8
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions None
J J
2 - 117
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-07 : Programmable Function Keys to assign functions to a multiline terminal's line keys. For certain functions, you can append data to the keys basic function. For example, the function 26 appended by data 1 makes a Group Call Pickup key for Pickup Group 1. You can also program Function Keys using Service Codes. In order to clear any previously programmed key, press 000 to erase any displayed code.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Function Number 0~99 (Normal Function Code) (Service Code 751 by default) * 00-* 99 (Appearance Function Code) (Service Code 752 by default)
2 - 118
Document Revision 1
Default Programmable keys 1~8 are Trunk Line keys (key 1 = Trunk Line 1, key 2 = Trunk Line 2, etc.). All other programmable keys are undefined. Function Number List [1] Normal Function Code (00 99) (Service Code 751) Function Number List [1] Normal Function Code (00 99) (Service Code 751)
Function Number 00 01 Function Not Defined DSS / One-Touch Extension number or any numbers (up to 24 digits) Additional Data LED Indication
Red On: Extension Busy Off: Extension Idle Rapid Blink (Red): DND or Call
Forward
02
Red On: Mic Off Off: Mic On Red On: DND Red On: BGM On Off: BGM Off Red On: Headset in use
None
03 04
05 06 07 08
Rapid Blink (Red): New call log Red On: Call log Off: No call log
Mode number (1~8)
09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
Day/Night Mode Switch Call Forward - Immediate Call Forward - Busy Call Forward - No Answer Call Forward - Busy/No Answer Call Forward Both Ring Follow Me --- Not Used ----- Not Used ---
Red On: Mode active Slow Blink (Red): Forwarded Slow Blink (Red): Forwarded Slow Blink (Red): Forwarded Slow Blink (Red): Forwarded Slow Blink (Red): Forwarded Rapid Blink (Red): Forwarded
2 - 119
Document Revision 1
Function Number List (Continued) [1] Normal Function Code (00 99) (Service Code 751)
Function Number 18 19 Function Text Message Setup External Group Paging Additional Data Message Numbers (01~20) External Paging Number (1~8) LED Indication
20 21
External All Call Paging Internal Group Paging Internal Paging Number (01~64)
22 23 24 25 26 27
Internal All Call Paging Meet-Me Answer to Internal Paging Call Pickup Call Pickup for Another Group Call Pickup for Specified Group Speed Dial Common/ Private Speed Dial - Group Repeat Redial Saved Number Redial Memo Dial Meet Me Conference Override (Off-Hook Signaling) Break - In Camp On Step Call DND / FWD Override Call Message Waiting Room Monitoring Call Pickup Group Number Speed Dial Number (Common / Private) Speed Dial number (Group)
None None
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
None
2 - 120
Document Revision 1
Function Number List (Continued) [1] Normal Function Code (00 99) (Service Code 751)
Function Number 40 41 Function Handset Transmission Cutoff Buzzer Extension Number Additional Data LED Indication
Red On: Transmission cut-off Red On: Transmission Side Rapid Blink (Red): Receiver Side Red On: Boss Secretary mode
None None None
42 43 44 45 46 47
Boss Secretary Call Series Call Common Hold Exclusive Department Group Log Out Reverse Voice Over
Extension Number
Red On: extension busy Off: extension idle Rapid Blink (Red): DND or Call
Forward
Red On: Relay On Red On: Under setting Red On: Active Red On: Active
None
2 - 121
Document Revision 1
Function Number List (Continued) [1] Normal Function Code (00 99) (Service Code 751)
Function Number 59 60 61 63 64 65 66 67 Function Delayed Transfer at Department Group Call DND at Department Group Call -- Not Used -Outgoing Call Without Caller ID (ISDN) --- Not Used ----- Not Used --CTI Mail Box Extension Number or Department Group Number Additional Data Extension Group Number (1~8 or 01~64) Extension Group Number (1~8 or 01~64) LED Indication
69
70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77
Automated Attendant for Extension Message Change for Voice Attendant Keypad Facility Key Keypad HOLD Key Keypad RETRIEVE Key Keypad Conference Key Toll Restriction in Credit -Extension Number Voice Mail (In-Skin)
None None
Red On: Access to Voice Mail Rapid Blink (Green): New Message
2 - 122
Document Revision 1
Function Number List (Continued) [1] Normal Function Code (00 99) (Service Code 751)
Function Number 78 79 Function Conversation Recording Voice Mail Automated Attendant (In-Skin) Extension Number or Pilot Number Additional Data LED Indication
Rapid Blink (Red): Recording Red On: Set Up for All Calls Fast Blink (Red): Set Up for No
Answer Calls
81 82 83
Automatic Transfer to Transfer Key Dterm IP Call Log Conversation Recording Function (VMSU)
84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 . . 99
Drop Key Directory Dialing Private Call Refuse Caller ID Refuse Dial-In Mode Switching Do-Not-Call Setup Do-Not-Call Data Registration Live Recording Key In-Mail 22-17
2 - 123
Document Revision 1
Function Number List [2] Appearance Function Level (*00 - *99) (Service Code 752)
Function Number 00 01 Function --- Not Used --Trunk Key Trunk Number (1~8 or 001~200) Trunk Group Number (1~8 or 001~100) Extension Number or Department Group Number Park Number (01 64) Additional Data LED Indication
09 10
11
12
13
14 15 16
2 - 124
, , , , , , , , , , , , , , , ,
Red On: Trunk Busy by Another User Green On: Trunk Busy by Extension Red On: Trunk Busy by Another User Green On: Trunk Busy by Extension Red On: Trunk busy by another user Slow Blink (Red): Incoming Call Slow Blink (Red): Call Placed in Park by Another User Fast Blink (Green): Extension Placed Call in Park
02
Trunk Group
03
04
Park Key
05 06 07 08
--- Not Used --Trunk Access Via Networking Station Park Hold None CAP Key CAP Orbit No. (01~64)
If CAP Orbit No.000 is used, the next available orbit is automatically selected.
Red On: Under Off Duty Slow Blink (Red): Under Reservation Red On: ACD Operation End Red On: Under Monitor Red On: Standby
Document Revision 1
Function Number List (Continued) [2] Appearance Function Level (*00 - *99) (Service Code 752)
17 ACD Work Wrap Up Time
Red On: Under Work Time Slow Blink (Red): Under Reservation
ACD Group Number
, , , , ,
18
19 20 . . . 99
2 - 125
Document Revision 1
2 - 126
Document Revision 1
Conditions
When a key is programmed using service code 752, that key cannot be programmed with a function using the 751 code until the key is undefined (000). For example with a Park Key programmed by dialing 752 + 04 must be undefined by dialing 752 + 000 before it can be programmed as a Voice Over key by dialing 751 + 48. When assigning a CAP key, 08, an orbit number must be used. If orbit 000 is used, it will automatically assign the next available orbit.
H H
2 - 127
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-08 : Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Setup to assign a ring tone range (0~4) to incoming virtual extensions assigned to a Virtual Extension key (Program 15-07). If you enable ringing for the key in Program 15-09, the key rings with the tone you set in this program. Also see Program 22-03. The chart below shows the available tones. There are 256 available extension ports.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Description When an extension or a virtual extension is assigned to the function key on the key telephone, select the ring tone when receiving a call on that key. For ACD CAR keys, only tone pattern 1 (entry 0) can be used. The remaining patterns are not checked with this feature.
2 - 128
Document Revision 1
Pattern 2
Pattern 3
Pattern 4
Conditions None
2 - 129
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-09 : Virtual Extension Ring Assignment to assign the ringing options for an extensions Virtual Extension Key or Virtual Extension Group Answer Key which is defined in Program 15-07. You make an assignment for each Night Service Mode. Assign extension numbers and names to virtual extension ports in Program 15-01. Program Virtual Extension keys in Program 15-07 (code 03). There are 256 Virtual Extension Ports.
Input Data
Extension Number Key Number Up to 8 digits 01~48
Item No. 01
Ringing
= No Ringing = Ring
Conditions
Program the Multiple Directory Number function keys NOT to ring before removing the key from keyset programming.
2 - 130
Default 0
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-10 : Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Order Setup to set the priority (1-4) for the Virtual Extension Ring Tones set in Program 15-08. When Virtual Extension calls ring an extension simultaneously, the tone with the highest order number (e.g., 1) rings. The other keys just flash. There are 256 Virtual Extension ports.
Input Data
Extension Number Up to 8 digits
Item No. 01
Order 1~4
0 1 2 3 4 = = = = =
Data
Tone Pattern 1 Tone Pattern 2 Tone Pattern 3 Tone Pattern 4 Incoming Extension Ring Tone
Description In the case of that two or more virtual extensions are set on a function key on the keyset, and the tone pattern by which the sound of each extension differs, the priority of ring sound is set up.
Default
2 - 131
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 132
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-11 : Virtual Extension Delayed Ring Assignment to assign the delayed ringing options for an extensions Virtual Extension or Virtual Extension Group Answer keys (defined in Program 15-09). You make an assignment for each Night Service Mode. There are 256 Virtual Extension Ports. Assign extension numbers (Program 11-04) and names (Program 15-01) to virtual extension ports. Program Multiple Directory Number (virtual extension) keys in Program 15-07 (code 03).
Input Data
Extension Number Key Number Maximum 8 digits 01~48
Item No. 01
Conditions
Program the Virtual Extension keys NOT to ring before removing the key from a keysets programming.
Ringing
= Immediate Ring = Delayed Ring
Default 0
2 - 133
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-12 : Conversation Recording Destination for Extensions to set the ACI Conversation Recording destination for each extension.
2 - 134
J
If both Programs 14-09 and 15-12 define a destination, the destination in Program 15-12 will be followed.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item Number 01
Item
ACI Recording Destination Extension Number
Default No Setting
Enter the ACIs extension number to which the trunk calls should be recorded. 02
ACI Automatic Recording for Incoming Calls
0 1
= Off = On
Conditions None
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-14 : Programmable One-Touch Keys to define the One-Touch key data for each multiline terminal. For each Electra Elite IPK II Wireless telephone to use the Transfer When Out of Range feature, enter the destination number (up to 24 digits) and name (up to 12 characters) into One-Touch bin 10. Make sure to add any required trunk access codes for outside numbers. If this bin information is changed either through 15-14-01 or through user programming, the destination for the transferred calls is also changed.
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Key Number
01~10
Item No.
Name Up to 24 Digits
Default No Setting
02
Default
Conditions None
01
Name
Up to 12 Digits
No Setting
2 - 135
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-15 : Wireless DECT Terminal Basic Data Setup to define the options for the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless telephones.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No.
Item
Input Data
Default
Related Program
01
IPEI The IPEI (International Portable Equipment Identity) is a unique number embedded into each Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT telephone. The IPEI number is the 13-digit serial number which is located on the label in the telephone telephones battery compartment. Use this program to display the IPEI number assigned to an Electra Elite IPK II Wireless telephone during the telephone subscription. This program is read only.
02
Authentication Code This program displays the 4-digit AC (Authentication Code) assigned to the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT telephone during the telephone subscription. This program is read only.
2 - 136
Document Revision 1
Item No.
Item
Input Data
Default
Related Program
03
Terminal Capability This program displays the capability of the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT telephone displaying the options below. This program is read only. Display Capabilities ISDN Support Tone Capabilities Data Services Profile E Class 2 Echo Parameters Data Services Profile A/B Class 2 Portable Part Ambient Noise Rejection (N-REJ) Multi-Bearers Support for Data Services Profile Adaptive Volume Control Provision (A-Vol) Data Services Profile C Class 2 Slot Type Capability Data Services Profile D Class 2 Number of Stored Display Characters Data Services Profile F Class 2 Number of Lines in Display DECT/GSM Interworking - GSM Bearer Service Number of Characters Per Line DECT/GSM Interworking - GSM SMS Service Scrolling Behavior Field DECT/GSM Interworking - GSM Facsimile Service GAP/PAP Support Control Codes DECT/GSM Interworking Profile Supported ISO8859-1 Support
H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H
2 - 137
Document Revision 1
Item No. 04
Model Identifier
Item
Input Data
This program is read only.
Default -
Related Program
This program shows the model identifier that the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT terminal uses. The model identifier contains the following items: Manufacturer Identification Code (MANIC) and Model Identification Code (MODIC). This program is read only.
05
Voice Mail Answering When Out of Range This program enables (1) or disables (0) the ability for calls to be transferred to voice mail if the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT telephone is out of range. If Program 15-15-05 and 15-15-06 are both enabled, Program 1515-05 takes priority. If both programs are disabled, the caller hears a lock-out tone and the may see Out of Range on their display.
0 1
= No = Yes
15-15-05 15-15-06
06
Call Transferring When Out of Range This program enables (1) or disables (0) the ability for calls to be transferred to another extension if the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT telephone is out of range. If Program 15-15-05 and 15-15-06 are both enabled, Program 15-15-05 takes priority. If both programs are disabled, the caller hears a lockout tone and the may see Out of Range on their display.
0
1
= No = Yes
15-15-05 15-15-06
07 08
32 32
Conditions None
2 - 138
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-17 : CO Message Indication to set the message waiting LED Flash assignment on each CO line.
Input Data
Extension Number including Virtual Extensions Trunk Port Number Up to 8 digits 001~200
Item No. 01
LED Flash Assignment
Item
Input Data
0 = LED Off 1 = LED On
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 139
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-18 : Virtual Extension Key Enhanced Options to define the operation when a Virtual Extension Key is pressed.
Input Data
Extension Number including Virtual Extensions Up to 8 digits
Item No. 01 02
Item
Virtual Extension Key Operation Mode
Input Data
0 = Release 1 = Land on the key
Default 0 0
Default Settings
If a DIL rings a Virtual Extension, the Virtual Extension Key Operation Mode must be set to Land On, or the multiline terminal must have a CAP Key.
Conditions None
2 - 140
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 15-20 : LCD Line Key Name Assignment to assign a name to each LCD Line Key of the DTH/DTR-16LD-1 and 16LD-R ADM. Up to eight characters can be assigned.
Input Data
Extension Number Key Number Up to 8 digits 01~16 (for 16LD TEL) 17~32 (for 16LD ADM)
Default Settings
Line Key LK01 : LK08 LK09 : LK32 Name CO001 : CO008 All Blank : All Blank
Conditions None
2 - 141
Document Revision 1
2 - 142
Description
Input Data
Department Group Number 0~64
Item No. 01 02
Item
Department Name
Default No setting 0
Department Calling Cycle Use this option to set the call routing for Department Calling. Routing can be either circular (cycles to all phones in group) or priority (cycles to highest priority extensions first).
03
Department Routing when Busy (Auto Step Call) Use this option to set how the system routes an Intercom call to a busy Department Group member. Intercom callers to the extension can either hear busy or route to the first available department number. This only occurs for calls to the extension directly, not the department number assigned in Program 11-07.
= Normal (Intercom caller to busy department member hears busy) = Circular (Intercom callers to busy department member routes to idle member)
16-02
2 - 143
margorP
Use Program 16-01 : Department Group Basic Data Setup to set the function mode for each department group. There are 64 Department Groups available.
16
Document Revision 1
Item No. 04
Item
Hunting Mode Use this option to set the action taken when a call reaches the last extension in the Department Group (0=hunting stopped, 1 =hunting repeats with circular routing through the Department Group.
Input Data
0 = Last extension is called and hunting is stopped = Circular
Default 0
Related Program
05
Extension Group All Ring Mode Operation Determine whether calls ringing a Department Group should ring all extensions in the group simultaneously automatically or manually when using the service code defined in Program 11-12-09.
0 1
= Manual = Automatic
11-16-10
06
0 = Disable (Camp On) 1 = Enable (Overflow Mode) 0 1 = Disable (Recall) = Enable (No Recall)
07
Call Recall Restriction for STG Determine whether a or not an unanswered call transferred to a Department Group should recall the extension from which it was transferred.
08
Queuing for Extension Group Call To have Department Group calls queue when busy, set this entry to 1 for an extension or voice mail group.
0 1
= No Queuing = Queuing
(This program allows entries of 1-32, however, the system accepts any entry other than 0 to allow queuing.)
09
Department Hunting No Answer Time Set how long a call will ring a Department group extension before hunting occurs.
0~64800 seconds
15
10
Enhanced Hunt Type Set the type of hunting for each Extension (Department) Group.
0 1 2 3
= No queuing = Hunting When Busy = Hunting When Not Answered = Hunting When Busy or No Answer
2 - 144
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 145
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 16-02 : Department Group Assignment for Extensions to set the Department Groups. The system uses these groups (64 Department Groups) for Department Calling. Assign pilot numbers to Department Groups you set up in Program 11-07. This lets system users place calls to the departments. Use Program 16-01 to set the priority of each extension within each Department Group. When a call comes into the group, it may ring the extensions in order of their priority.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Priority 1~999
Description Set up the Department Group called by the pilot number and the extension priority when a group is called. Call Pickup Groups are set up in 2302.
The initial value of a priority becomes the ports numerical order assigned in Program 11-02 and 11-04. (Extension ports are 1~ 256. Virtual extension ports are 1-256.)
2 - 146
J
Conditions None
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 16-03 : Secondary Department Group to set a second Department Group for extensions. Up to 16 extensions can be assigned per a Department Group. There are 64 Department Groups available.
Input Data
Department (Extension) Group Number 01~64
Item No. 01
Description This program is set up when placing telephones into two or more groups.
Default
Conditions None
2 - 147
Document Revision 1
2 - 148
Description
Use Program 20-01 : System Options to set various system options.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Operator Access Mode Text Message Mode
Input Data
0 1 0 1 = Step = Circular = Call mode = No Answer/ Busy mode
Default 0
Description
Use this program to set up priority of a call when calling an operator telephone. Use this program to select the mode when calling the telephone which set up the text message.
02
11-11-14 15-07-08
03 04
Used to determine how often the system updates the DSS key BLF indications. For Networking, the entry should be 30.
30-05
05
0~64800 seconds
10
For OPXs, analog telephones and certain analog trunks (like DISA), the system attaches a DTMF receiver to the port for this interval. The system releases the receiver after the interval expires. This interval sets the duration of the alarm signal. Callback rings an extension for this interval. Trunk Queuing callback rings an extension for this interval. The system cancels an extensions Callback or Trunk Queueing request after this interval.
25-07-01
06 07 08 09
Alarm Duration Callback Ring Duration Time Trunk Queuing Callback Time Callback/Trunk Queuing Cancel Time Trunk Guard Timer Web Logout Time
30 15 15 64800
10 12
1 900
The system automatically logs out a Web Pro session after inactivity lasting this interval.
2 - 149
margorP
20
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 150
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-02 : System Options for Multiline Telephones to set various system options for multiline telephones.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02
--- Not Used --Trunk Group Access Key Operating Mode Use this option to set the operating mode of the extensions trunk group keys. The keys can be for incoming access, outgoing access or both.
Item
Input Data
Default
Related Programming
0 1 2
03
BLF Control (DSS Busy Mark) Set the conditions under which a Hotline, Reverse Voice Over or DSS Console key indicates that an extension is busy. Refer to the Reverse Voice Over feature for more information.
0 1
04
Retrieve the Line After Transfer Enable (1) or disable (0) an extensions ability to answer a call after its been transferred, but before its answered.
0 1
05
Headset Busy Mode Set the conditions under which a headset extension is busy to incoming callers.
0 1
= No = Yes
06
Preselection Time When a multiline terminal user preselects a line key, the system remembers the preselection for this interval.
0~64800 seconds
2 - 151
Document Revision 1
Input Data
1~8 Type 1: (12 hour) Type 2: (12 hour) Type 3: (12 hour) Type 4: (12 hour) Type 5: (24 hour) Type 6: (24 hour) Type 7: (24 hour) Type 8: (24 hour) 10 MAR TUE 3:15PM 3:15PM MAR 10 TUE 3-10 TUE 3:15 PM 3:15PM TUE 10 MAR 10 MAR TUE 15:15 15:15 MAR 10 TUE 3-10 TUE 15:15 15:15 TUE 10 MAR
Default 3
Related Programming
08 09
LCD Display Holding Time Disconnect Supervision Use this option to enable or disable disconnect supervision for the system trunks.
5 1
10
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1
= = = = = = = =
15-02-18
11
Handsfree Microphone Control Use this option to control the setting for Multiline Terminals Handsfree microphone after being disconnected and reconnected. If set to 0, the microphone will always be off when the terminal is reconnected. If set to 1, the microphone will remain in the same state it was in when the terminal is reconnected.
= Off = On
12
Forced Intercom RIng (ICM Call Type) Use this option to enable or disable Forced Intercom Ringing. If enabled, incoming Intercom calls normally ring. If disabled, Intercom calls voiceannounce.
0 1
13 14
0~64800 seconds
30 sec.
2 - 152
Document Revision 1
Input Data
0= Name and Number (Both) 1= Name 2= Number
Default 0
Related Programming
Conditions None
2 - 153
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-03 : System Options for Single Line Telephones to set up various options for single line telephones.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
SLT Call Waiting Answer Mode For a busy single line (500/2500 type) telephone, set the mode used to answer a camped-on trunk call. For ESL sets, enabling this option (1) allows the user to dial Service Code for Voice Mail Conversation Record.
Input Data
0 1 = Hookflash (Hooking) = Hookflash + Service Code 654
Default 0
02
Ignore Received DP Dial on DTMF SLT Port Use this option to define whether the system should receive dial pulse and DTMF signals (0) or ignore dial pulse and only accept DTMF signals (1).
0 1
15-03-01
03
SLT DTMF Dial to Trunk Lines Type 0: The system keeps the digits dialed by the single line telephone on a trunk in a buffer. After all the digits have been received, the system sends all the digits to the trunk. If the time space between digits is longer than the timer in Item 4, the system considers all digits received. Type 1: The system passes the received digits from the single line telephone to the trunk immediately. If the single line telephone has a Last Number Dial key without a pause, this key may not be able to use the Last Number Dial key with the Type 1 setting. When using a third-party external paging device, set this option to 1. In addition, set Program 20-03-04 to 1. These programs must be set in order for DECT Wireless users to be able to break dial tone on an analog trunk that is used for paging.
= Receive all dialed data, before sending (All) = Direct through out (Direct)
20-03-04
2 - 154
H H
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 04 Item
Dial Sending Start Time for SLT or ARS When ARS or an analog extension user accesses a trunk and dials an outside call, the system waits this interval before outdialing the first digit. When using a third-party external paging device, set this option to 1. In addition, set Program 20-03-03 to 1.
Default 3
05
0 1 2
06
Headset Ringing Start Time Define the headset ringing start time. After this timer expires from the time when a single line telephone is off-hook, the system will set the single line telephone to headset ringing mode.
0~64800 seconds
20-13-38
07
0~64800 seconds
20-03-03 20-03-04
Conditions None
J J
2 - 155
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-04 : System Options for Virtual Extensions to set up various system options for Virtual Extensions. There are 256 available virtual extension ports.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03
--- Not Used ----- Not Used --CAR/SIE/Virtual Extension Delay Interval CAR Keys/SIE Keys/Virtual Extensions set for Delayed Ringing (see Program 15-11) ring the extension after this interval.
Item
Input Data
Default
0~64800 seconds 10
Conditions None
2 - 156
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-06 : Class of Service for Extensions to assign a Class of Service (COS) to an extension. There are15 Classes of Service that can be assigned. To specify the options in each Class of Service, refer to Programs 20-07 through 20-13. You make eight entries for Program 20-06, one for each Night Service Mode.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Default
Extension number 101 as Class 15. All other extension numbers are set as Class 1.
Conditions None
H H
2 - 157
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-07 : Class of Service Options (Administrator Level) to define the administrator service availability for each extensions Class of Service (COS).
Input Data
Class of Service Number 01~15
Default Item No. Item Input Data COS 1~14 COS 15 Related Program
01
Manual Night Service Enabled Turns off or on an extension for manual Night Service Switching.
11-10-01
02
Changing the Music on Hold Tone Turns off or on an extension to change the Music on Hold tone.
11-10-02
03
Time Setting Turns off or on an extension to set the Time via Service Code 728.
11-10-03
04
Storing Speed Dialing Entries Turns off or on an extension to store System or Group Speed Dialing numbers.
11-10-04
05
Set/Cancel Automatic Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer Turns off or on an extensions ability to use the Trunk-to-Trunk Forwarding service codes.
0 = Off 1 = On
06 07 08 09
--- Not Used ----- Not Used ----- Not Used ----- Not Used ---
2 - 158
Document Revision 1
Default Item No. Item Input Data COS 1~14 COS 15 Related Program
10
Programmable Function Key Programming (Appearance Level) Turns off or on an extension for programming the Appearance function keys using Service Code 752 (by default).
0 = Off 1 = On
11-11-38 20-13-18
11
Forced Trunk Disconnect (analog trunk only) Turns off or on an extension to use Forced Trunk Disconnect.
11-10-26
12 13
11-10-27
VRS Record (VRS Msg Operation) Turns off or on an extensions ability to record, erase and listen to VRS messages.
11-10-19
14
VRS General Message Play Turns off or on an extension to dial 4 or Service Code 611 listen to the General Message.
0 = Off 1 = On
11-10-21
15
VRS General Message Record/Delete Turns off or on an extension for dialing Service Code 612 and record, listen to or erase the General Message.
0 = Off 1 = On
11-10-22
16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
--- Not Used ----- Not Used --SMDR Printout Accumulated Extension Data SMDR Printout Department Group (STG) Data SMDR Printout Accumulated Account Code Data Register/Delete DECT
0 0 0 0
1 1 1 0
--- Not Used --CO MSG Waiting Indication Callback Number Programming Enable or Disable an extensions ability to receive CO Message Waiting Indication.
0 = Off 1 = On
2 - 159
Document Revision 1
Default Item No. Item Input Data COS 1~14 COS 15 Related Program
24
Set/Cancel Private Call Refuse Enable or Disable an extensions ability to set or cancel Private Call Refuse.
11-10-32
25
Set / Cancel Caller ID Refuse Enable or Disable an extensions ability to set or cancel Caller ID Refuse.
11-10-33 11-10-34
26 27
Do-Not-Call Administrator
28
Conditions None
2 - 160
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-08 : Class of Service Options (Outgoing Call Service) to define the outgoing call feature availability for each extensions Class of Service (COS).
Input Data
Class of Service Number 01~15
Default Item No. Item Input Data COS 01-14 1 COS 15 1 Related Program
01
0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On
02
Trunk Outgoing Calls Turns off or on outgoing trunk calling for the extension.
03
System Speed Dialing Turns off or on an extension's ability to make outbound calls using system speed dial numbers.
0 = Off 1 = On
04
Group Speed Dialing Turns off or on an extension's ability to make outbound calls using group speed dial numbers.
0 = Off 1 = On
05
Dial Number Preview (Preset Dial) Turns off or on an extension for using Dial Number Preview.
0 = Off 1 = On
06
Toll Restriction Override Turns off or on Toll Restricting Override (Service Code 663).
0 = Off 1 = On
07
0 = Off 1 = On
08
Toll Restriction Dial Block Turns off or on an extension to use Dial Block.
0 = Off 1 = On
2 - 161
Document Revision 1
Default Item No. Item Input Data COS 01-14 0 COS 15 0 Related Program
09
Hotline/Extension Ringdown Turns off or on Ringdown Extension for extensions with this COS.
0 = Off 1 = On
10
Signal/Voice Call Turns off or on an extension allowing it to force Handsfree Answerback or Forced Intercom Ringing for outgoing Intercom calls.
0 = Off 1 = On
11
Protect for the Call Mode Switching from Caller (Internal Call)
0 = Off 1 = On
12
Department Group Step Calling Turns off or on an extension to use Department Group Step Calling.
0 = Off 1 = On
13
ISDN CLIP Determines if the ISDN calling line identity presentation and screening indicators are allowed.
0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On
10-03-05
14 15
Block Outgoing Caller ID Turns off or on the system to automatically block outgoing Caller ID information when a user places a call. If this option is on, the system automatically inserts the Caller ID block code (defined in Program 14-01-21) before the users dialed digits.
0 = Off 1 = On
14-01-20 14-01-21
16
Display E911 Dialed Extension Name and Number Turns off or on an extension to display the name and number of the extension that dialed 911.
0 = Off 1 = On
17
ARS Override of Trunk Access Map Turns off or on an extensions ability to override the trunk access map programming for outgoing calls.
0 = Off 1 = On
18 19
0 = Off 1 = On
20-08-09
2 - 162
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 163
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-09 : Class of Service Options (Incoming Call Service) to define the incoming call feature availability for each extension Class of Service (COS).
Input Data
Class of Service Number 01~15
Default Item No. Item Input Data COS 01~14 COS 15 Related Program
01
Second Call for DID/ DISA/ DIL/ E&M Override Turns off or on the extensions ability to receive a second call from a DID, DISA, DIL, or tie line caller.
With this option set to 1, the destination extension must be busy in order for a second DNIS caller to ring through. If the destination extension does not have a trunk or CAP key available for the second call and a previous call is ringing the extension but has not yet been answered, the second caller will hear busy regardless of this programs setting.
02
03
04
2 - 164
0 = Off 1 = On
Caller ID Display Turns off or on the Caller ID display at an extension. Sub Address Identification Defines whether an extension displays the Caller Sub-Address. Notification for Incoming Call List Existence Determines whether an extension display shows Check List when an incoming call is missed by a user.
0 = Off 1 = On
15-02-08
0 = Off 1 = On
0 = Off 1 = On
20-09-02
Document Revision 1
Default Item No. Item Input Data COS 01~14 COS 15 Related Program
05
Signal/Voice Call Turn off or on an extensions ability to enable Handsfree Answerback or Forced Intercom Ringing for their incoming Intercom calls.
11-11-15, 11-11-16
06 07
Call Queuing Turn off or on an extension's ability to have calls queued if a call rings the extension when it is busy.
20-13-06
08
Calling Party Information Turn off or on an extensions ability to display calling party information on CCIS calls.
0 = Off 1 = On
50-02-05
Conditions None
2 - 165
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-10 : Class of Service Options (Answer Service) to define the answer feature availability for each extension Class of Service (COS).
Class of Service Number 01~15
01
Group Call Pickup (Within Group) Turns off or on Group Call Pickup for calls ringing an extension Pickup Group as well as ring group calls (Service Code 756).
0 = Off 1 = On
02
Group Call Pickup (Another Group) Turns off or on Group Call Pickup for calls ringing outside a group (Service Code 769).
0 = Off 1 = On
03
Group Call Pickup for Specific Group Turns off or on Group Call Pickup for a specific group (Service Code 768).
0 = Off 1 = On
04
Telephone Call Pickup Turns off or on an extension to pick up a call ringing into a Pickup Group (Service Code #).
0 = Off 1 = On
05
Directed Call Pickup for Own Group Turns off or on Directed Call Pickup for calls ringing an extension Pickup Group (Service Code 756).
06
Meet-Me Conference and Paging Turns off or on an extension to use Meet-Me Conference and Paging.
07
Automatic Off-Hook Answer Turns off or on an extension to use Universal Auto Answer (no service code required).
2 - 166
0 = Off 1 = On
0 = Off 1 = On
0 = Off 1 = On
Document Revision 1
08
Virtual Extension Off-Hook Answer Turns off or on an extension to answer an incoming call on a Call Arrival (CAR) / Secondary Incoming Extension (SIE) / Virtual Extension simply by lifting the handset.
0 = Off 1 = On
09
Call Pickup Callback Turn off or on an extensions ability to use Call Pickup to pick up Callback calls.
0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On
10
Answer Preset
Conditions None
2 - 167
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-11 : Class of Service Options (Hold/Transfer Service) to define the Hold and Transfer feature availability for each extension Class of Service (COS).
Input Data
Class of Service Number 01~15
01
Call Forward All Turns off or on an extensions ability to initiate Call Forwarding All.
0 = Off 1 = On
02
Call Forward When Busy Turns off or on an extensions ability to use Call Forward when Busy.
0 = Off 1 = On
03
Call Forwarding When Unanswered Turns off or on an extensions ability to use Call Forward when Unanswered.
0 = Off 1 = On
04
Call Forwarding (Both Ringing) Turns off or on an extensions ability to activate Call Forwarding with Both Ringing.
0 = Off 1 = On
05
Call Forwardings with Follow Me Turns off or on an extensions ability to initiate Call Forwarding with Follow Me.
0 = Off 1 = On
06
Unscreened Transfer (Ring Inward Transfer) Turns off or on an extensions ability to use Unscreened Transfer.
0 = Off 1 = On
07
Transfer Without Holding Turns off or on an extensions ability to use Transfer Without Holding.
0 = Off 1 = On
2 - 168
Document Revision 1
08
Transfer Information Display Turns off or on an extensions ability for incoming Transfer pre-answer display.
0 = Off 1 = On
09
Group Hold Initiate Turns off or on an extensions ability to initiate a Group Hold.
0 = Off 1 = On
10
Group Hold Answer Turns off or on an extensions ability to pick up a call on Group Hold.
0 = Off 1 = On
11
Automatic On-Hook Transfer Turns off or on an extensions ability to use Automatic On Hook Transfer.
0 = Off 1 = On
12
Call Forwarding Off Premise (External Call Forwarding) Turns off or on an extensions ability to set up Call Forwarding Off-Premise for their telephone.
0 = Off 1 = On
13
Operator Transfer After Hold Callback Turns off or on an extensions ability to have a call which recalls from hold transfer to the operator.
0 = Off 1 = On
14
Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer Restriction Turns off or on the Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer Restriction. If enabled, Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer is not possible.
0 = Off 1 = On
15
VRS Personal Greeting (Message Greeting) Turns off or on an Service Code 7 to record, listen to, or erase the Personal Greeting Message.
0 = Off 1 = On
16
Call Redirect Turns off or on a multiline terminal users ability to transfer a call to a pre-defined destination (such as an operator, voice mail, or another extension) without answering the call.
0 = Off 1 = On
17
Department Group Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer (Each Telephone Group Transfer) Turns off or on an extension users ability to set Trunk-to-Trunk Forwarding for a Department Group.
0 = Off 1 = On
18
No Recall Allow (0) or deny (1) answered transferred calls from recalling the originating extension.
0 = Off 1 = On
19
Hold/Extended Park Determine if an extensions Class of Service should allow either a normal or extended Park.
0 = Off 1 = On
2 - 169
Document Revision 1
20
0 = Off 1 = On
21
Restriction for Tandem Trunking on Hang Up Allow (0) or deny (1) an extension users ability to set up a tandem/conference call automatically when they hang up.
0 = Off 1 = On
22
Restricted Unsupervised Conference Allow or Deny an extensions ability to initiate an unsupervised conference.
0 = Off 1 = On
23
Class of Service Options (Hold/Transfer Service) CAR/VE Call Forward Set/Cancel Turn on or off an extensions ability to set or cancel call forwarding for a virtual extension.
24
Trunk Park Hold Mode Set the hold type when a trunk call is put on hold by an extension.
25
Transfer Park Call Turn off or on and extensions ability to transfer a parked call.
Conditions None
2 - 170
Document Revision 1
Description
This program defines the Charging Cost service availability for each extension service class.
Default Item No. Item Input Data COS 01~14 COS 15
01 02
0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On
0 1
0 1
03
Conditions None
2 - 171
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-13 : Class of Service Options (Supplementary Service) to define the supplementary feature availability for each extension Class of Service (COS).
Input Data
Class of Service Number 01~15
Default Item No. Item Input Data COS 01~14 COS 15 Related Programming
01
Long Conversation Alarm Turns off or on the Warning Tone for Long Conversation (not for single line telephones).
0 = Off 1 = On
02
Long Conversation Cutoff (Incoming) Turns off or on an extension to use Long Conversation Cutoff for incoming calls.
0 = Off 1 = On
03
Long Conversation Cutoff (Outgoing) Turns off or on an extension to use Long Conversation Cutoff for outgoing calls.
0 = Off 1 = On
04
Call Forward/DND Override (Bypass Call) Turns off or on an extension to use Call Forwarding/ DND Override.
0 = Off 1 = On
05
Intercom Off-Hook Signaling Turns off or on an extensions ability to receive Off-Hook signals.
0 = Off 1 = On
06
Automatic Off Hook Signaling (Automatic Override) Allows a busy extensions ability to manually (0) or automatically (1) receive off-hook signals.
0 = Off 1 = On
07
0 = Off 1 = On
2 - 172
Document Revision 1
Default Item No. Item Input Data COS 01~14 COS 15 Related Programming
08
0 = Off 1 = On
09
Privacy Release Turns off or on an extensions ability to initiate a Voice Call Conference.
0 = Off 1 = On
10
Barge-in Monitor Enables the extension Barge-in Mode to be speech mode (0) or Monitor mode (1).
0 = Off 1 = On
11
Room Monitor, Initiating Extension Turns off or on an extension's ability to Room Monitor other extensions.
0 = Off 1 = On
12
Room Monitor, Extension Being Monitored Turn off or on an extension's ability to be monitored by other extensions.
0 = Off 1 = On
13
Continued Dialing (DTMF) Signal on ICM Call Turn off or on an extensions ability to use Continued Dialing, which allows DTMF signal sending while talking on extension.
0 = Off 1 = On
14
Department Calling (PLT No Called Extension) Turns off or on an extensions ability to call a Department Group Pilot.
0 = Off 1 = On
15
Barge In, Initiate Turns off or on an extension's ability to barge in on other's calls.
0 = Off 1 = On
16
Barge In, Receive Turns off or on an extension's ability to have other extensions barge in on calls.
0 = Off 1 = On
17
Barge-in Tone/Display (Intrusion Tone) Turns off or on the Barge In tone. If on, callers hear an alert tone and their display indicates the Barge In when another extension barges into their conversation. If off, there is no alert tone or display indication.
0 = Off 1 = On
18
Programmable Function Key Programming (General Level) Turns off or on an extensions ability to program General function keys using Service Code 751 (by default). (Refer to Program 20-07-10 for Service Code 752.)
0 = Off 1 = On
2 - 173
Document Revision 1
Default Item No. Item Input Data COS 01~14 COS 15 Related Programming
19
Selectable Display Messaging (Text Messaging) Turns off or on an extensions ability to use Selectable Display Messaging.
0 = Off 1 = On
20
Account Code/Toll Restriction Operator Alert (Restricted Operation Transfer) Turns off or on operator alert when an extension improperly enters an Account Code or violates Toll Restriction.
0 = Off 1 = On
21
0 = Off 1 = On
22
Busy Status Display (Called Party Status) Turns off or on the ability to display the detailed state of the called party.
0 = Off 1 = On
23
Display the Reason for Transfer Select whether an extension should display the reason a call is being transferred to their extension (Call Forward Busy, Call Forward No Answer, DND).
0 = Off 1 = On
24
Privacy Release by Pressing Line Key Turns off or on a users ability to press a line key to barge into an outside call. The Barge In feature must be enabled if this option is to be used.
0 = Off 1 = On
25 26
--- Not Used --Group Listen Turns off or on an extensions ability to use Group Listen.
0 = Off 1 = On
27
Busy on Seizing Virtual Extension If set to 1, you can call a busy extension which is talking on a virtual extension key. Program 20-13-06 (Call Waiting) must be set to off for this option to work.
0 = Off 1 = On
28
Allow Class of Service to be Changed Turns off or on the ability of an extension Class of Service to be changed via Service Code 677.
0 = Off 1 = On
29
0 = Off 1 = On
30
Background Music Allows or Denys an extension to turn Background Music on and off.
0 = Off 1 = On
2 - 174
Document Revision 1
Default Item No. Item Input Data COS 01~14 0 COS 15 0 Related Programming
31 32
0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On
Deny Multiple Barge Ins Allows or Denys an extension from having multiple users Barge in to their conversation.
33
ACD Supervisors Position Enhancement This option must be on in order for the operator to use service codes in Program 11-13-10 through 11-13-13.
0 = Off 1 = On
34
Block Manual Off-Hook Signaling Turns off or on an extensions ability to block off-hook signals manually sent from a co-worker.
0 = Off 1 = On
35
Block Camp On Turns off or on an extensions ability to block callers from dialing to Camp On.
0 = Off 1 = On
36
Call Duration Timer Display Turns off or on an extensions display of the Call Duration Time. The system waits until the interdigit timer (Program 21-01-01) expires before beginning this timer.
0 = Off 1 = On
37 38
--- Not Used --Headset Ringing Turn off or on an extensions ability to use the Headset ringing.
0 = Off 1 = On
39
ACD Queue Status Display Turns off or on the ACD Queue Status Display for an extension Class of Service. Any extension which has this option enabled will also hear the queue alarm.
0 = Off 1 = On
40
Do Not Disturb Turn off or on and extensions ability to set or cancel Do Not Disturb.
0 = Off 1 = On
11-11-08 15-07-03
41
Voice Mail Message Indication on DSS Turn off or on the Voice Mail Message Indication for an extension on a DSS console.
0 = Off 1 = On
42
Extension Data Swap Enabling Turn off or on an extension's ability to use Extension Data Swap.
0 = Off 1 = On
11-15-12
43 44
--- Not Used --Live Monitor Enabling Turn off or on an extensions ability to use Live Monitor.
0 = Off 1 = On
2 - 175
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 176
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-14 : Class of Service Options for DISA/E&M to enable/disable DISA and tie line Class of Service options. You assign a DISA Class of Service to DISA users in Program 25-09. Assign tie line Classes of Service in 34-02. Up to 15 DISA/E&M Classes of Service can be defined.
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05
Analog trunk-to-analog trunk and ISDN trunk-to-ISDN trunk calls are supported by this program. However, analog trunk-to-ISDN trunk and ISDN trunk-to-analog trunk calls are NOT supported by this program.
Input Data
Class of Service Number 01~15
First Digit Absorbtion (Delete First Digit Dialed) For tie lines, enable or disable the ability to absorb (ignore) the first incoming digit. Use this to make the tie trunk compatible with 3- and 4-digit tie line service. This option does not apply to DISA. Trunk Group Routing/ARS Access This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to dial 9 for Trunk Group Routing or Automatic Route Selection (ARS). Trunk Group Access This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to access trunk groups for outside calls (Service Code 704). Outgoing System Speed Dial This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to use the System Speed Dialing. Operator Calling This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to dial 0 for the telephone system operator.
0 = Off 1 = On
0 = Off 1 = On
0 = Off 1 = On
0 = Off 1 = On
0 = Off 1 = On
2 - 177
Document Revision 1
06
Internal Paging This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to use the telephone systems Internal Paging.
0 = Off 1 = On
07
External Paging This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to use the telephone systems External Paging.
0 = Off 1 = On
08
Direct Trunk Access This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to use Direct Trunk Access (Service Code #9).
0 = Off 1 = On
09
Forced Trunk Disconnect <Not for ISDN T-point> This option enables or disables a tie trunk callers ability to use Forced Trunk Disconnect (Service Code 3). This option is not available to DISA callers.
0 = Off 1 = On
10
Call Forward Setting by Remote via DISA Enable or disable a DISA callers ability to use the Call Forward service codes (Programs 11-11-01 through 11-11-05).
11
DISA/Tie Trunk Barge In This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk callers ability to use the Barge In feature.
12
Retrieve Park Hold This option enables or disables a DISA or tie trunk caller's ability to retrieve a Park Held call.
Conditions None
2 - 178
0 = Off 1 = On
0 = Off 1 = On
0 = Off 1 = On
J J J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-15 : Ring Cycle Setup to define the ringing cycles for each ring type.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 Incoming Signal Type Normal Incoming Call on Trunk PBX, CES Incoming Call Incoming Internal Call DID/DISA/VRS DID/DDI Dial-In in the E&M Tie Line Door Box Ringing for SLT Virtual Extension Ring Callback Alarm for SLT VRS Waiting Message Incoming Call Ringing Cycle 1~13 Default 8 8 12 8 8 12 8 8 11 5 6
2 - 179
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 180
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-16 : Selectable Display Messages to enter the Selectable Display Messages. There are 20 alphanumeric messages, up to 24 characters long. Use the following chart when programming messages.
Use this keypad digit . . . 1 When you want to. . . Enter characters: 1 @ [ ] ^ _ ` { | } Enter characters A-C, a-c, 2. Enter characters D-F, d-f, 3. Enter characters G-I, g-i, 4. Enter characters J-L, j-l, 5. Enter characters M-O, m-o, 6. Enter characters P-S, p-s, 7. Enter characters T-V, t-v, 8. Enter characters W-Z, w-z, 9. Enter characters: 0 ! # $ Enter characters: + , - .
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0
% / :
& ;
<
( =
) > ?
# = Accepts an entry (only required if two letters on the same key are needed - ex: TOM). Pressing # again = Space. (In system programming mode, use the right arrow soft key instead to accept and/or add a space.) Clear the character entry one character at a time. Clear all the entries from the point of the flashing cursor and to the right.
CONF HOLD
E B
2 - 181
Document Revision 1
When using DTP or DTU style telephones on the Electra Elite IPK II system, not all the same characters are available.
Input Data
Selectable Display Message Number 01~20
Item No. 01
Default Number 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 Message IN MEETING UNTIL ##:## MEETING ROOM - ######## COME BACK ##:## PLEASE CALL ########### BUSY CALL AFTER ##:## OUT FOR LUNCH BACK ##:## BUSINESS TRIP BACK ##/## BUSINESS TRIP ########## GONE FOR THE DAY ON VACATION UNTIL ##/## MESSAGE 11 MESSAGE 12 MESSAGE 13 MESSAGE 14 MESSAGE 15 MESSAGE 16 MESSAGE 17 MESSAGE 18 MESSAGE 19 MESSAGE 20
2 - 182
Document Revision 1
Conditions
2 - 183
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-17 : Operators Extension to designate an operator. When an extension user dials 0 or 9 (defined by Program 11-01 Type 5), calls go to the operator selected in this program. If you do not assign an extension in Program 90-11-01, system alarms appear on the extension assigned in this option.
Input Data
Operator Number 1~8
Item No. 01
Item
Operators Extension Number Define the extension numbers which are to be used as operators.
Input Data
Up to 8 digits
Default 101
Conditions None
2 - 184
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-18 : Service Tone Timer to set the values for the system service tone timers. Refer to the following chart for a description of each option, its range and default setting.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Extension Dial Tone Time
Default 30
Description
After getting Intercom dial tone, a keyset user has this interval to dial the first digit of the Intercom call.
Related Program
02 03
15 10
A Busy Tone when system resources run short. (such as DTMF receiver resources). This option sets the interval between Call Waiting tones. This timer also sets the interval between Off-Hook Signaling alerts.
Congestion Tone
04
10
05 06 07
Multiline Confirmation Tone Interval of Call Waiting Tone Intrusion Tone Repeat Time
10 10 0
After a call is interrupted (such as Barge In, Voice Mail Conversation Recording, Voice Over, etc), the system repeats the Intrusion Tone after this interval. Normally, you should enter 0 to disable this interval.
08 09
0 60 14-01-18
2 - 185
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 186
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-19 : System Options for Caller ID to define the system options for the Caller ID feature.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Caller ID Displaying Format (if displaying digits are more than 12 digits)
Input Data
0 = First 10 digits (Upper) = Last 10 digits (Lower)
Default 0
02
Caller ID Wait Timer When an incoming CO call is received, the system starts the timer. It will wait the programmed time for Caller ID information from telco before connecting the CO call.
0~30 seconds
03
Caller ID Edit Mode If Caller ID Edit Mode is disabled (0), no trunk access code will be added to the Caller ID. If this option is enabled (1), the trunk access code entered in Program 10-02-05 will be added to the beginning of the Caller ID.
0 1
= Off = On
04
Wait Facility IE Timer This timer is used with ISDN trunks to determine how long the system will wait for the Caller ID name from the Telco.
0~64800 seconds
10
05
0~64800 seconds
Conditions None
2 - 187
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-20 : Message Setup for Non-Caller ID Data to define the messages which will be displayed when no Caller ID information is received.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03
Private Call
Item
Conditions None
2 - 188
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-21 : System Options for Long Conversation to define the system options for the Long Conversation feature.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Long Conversation Alarm 1 The warning tone for long toll calls sounds after this interval.
Default 170
02
Long Conversation Alarm 2 After the initial long toll call warning tone, additional warning tones sound after this interval.
0~64800 (sec)
180
14-01-15
03
Long Conversation Cutoff for Incoming Call This timer determines how long the system will wait before disconnecting an incoming call.
0~64800 (sec)
14-01-14
04
Long Conversation Cutoff for Outgoing Call This timer determines how long the system will wait before disconnecting an outgoing call.
0~64800 (sec)
14-01-14
Conditions None
2 - 189
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-22 : System Options for Wireless DECT Service to define the time the system waits before determining the Wireless DECT (DECT) phone is out of range. For incoming calls, the timer begins when the call is received. If the time defined here expires before the Wireless DECT phone starts to ring, the system determines the phone is out of range and provides the out-of-range services (indicates out-of range, transfers the call to voice mail or to another extension).
Input Data
Item No. 05 06 Item
Out of Area Judging Time Out of Area Talkie
Default 8 0
Related Program
Conditions None
2 - 190
J
Program 20 : System Option Setup
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-23 : System Options for CTI to define the system options for the CTI feature.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03
Delayed ring timer for CTI ALERT replay time (CTI) Trunk Virtual Bridge -TSP Driver Enable or disable the system to send trunk or virtual extension information to the TSP driver.
Item
Input Data 0~64800 (sec) 0~64800 (sec) 0 = Disable (No) 1 = Enable (Yes) 0~64800 (sec)
Default 30 8 0
04
The Timer that waits for an off-hook for Single Line Telephone
30
Conditions None
2 - 191
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-25 : ISDN Options to define the ISDN system options.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04 Item
Send the Release Message After Subscriber Hangs Up Progress Indicate Information Element Detect
Input Data
0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 = Service Off = Service On = Service Off = Service On = 3.1KHz Audio = Speech = Service Off = Service On
Default 1 1 0 0
Send DT until user dials first digit (Local Dial Tone) With Overlap Sending Mode, if the network side stops dial tone when CLI is included in the SETUP message, the system sends dial tone until the user dials the first digit instead of the network.
05 06 07
T305 Timer Start After Sending Disconnect Message Call Proceeding Send Mode
0 1 0 1 0 1
= Service Off = Service On = Service Off = Service On = Local Busy Tone Off = Busy Tone from NT (network side)
1 1 0
08 09 10 11
0 = Disable (Off) 1 = Enable (On) 0 = Disable (Off) 1 = Enable (On) 0 = Disable (Off) 1 = Enable (On) 0 = Disable (Off) 1 = Enable (On)
1 1 1 0
Automatic Changing System Clock When Date/ Time Information Element Received
2 - 192
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 12 Item
Call Forward Options (Auto Connect Send) Incoming Calls Forwarded Out Automatically Return Connect Message When Outgoing Call Receives Alerting Message.
Default 0
13
Local Busy Tone (Release) Busy tone send when T-point receiving a RELEASE message from Network.
14
No Response Release Send Operation mode setting for when second T303 timer is expired.
Conditions None
2 - 193
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-26 : Multiplier Changing CO to define the Multiplier for charging cost to each extension service class.
Input Data
Service Class 1~15
Input Data
Item No. 01
Value %
Item
Input Data
100~500
Default 100
Conditions None
2 - 194
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-28 : System Options for Trunk to Trunk Conversation to define system options for Trunk to Trunk Conversation.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Conversation Continue Code
Input Data
Default No Setting
Related Programming 14-01-25 20-28-03 24-02-07 24-02-10 25-07-07 25-07-08 14-01-25 24-02-07 24-02-10 25-07-07 25-07-08 14-01-25 20-28-01 24-02-07 24-02-10 25-07-07 25-07-08
03
0~64800 seconds
Conditions None
02
0~9, #,
0~9, #,
No Setting
2 - 195
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-29 : Timer Class for Extension to assign the timer class to each extension. There are 16 Classes that can be assigned. You make eight entries for this Program, one for each Night Service Mode. This entry includes virtual extension numbers. The details of classes are assigned by PRG 20-31.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Day/Night Mode 1~8, Class Number
Input Data
0~15 0 = Not assigned
Default 0
Related Programming
Conditions None
2 - 196
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-30 : Timer Class for Trunks to assign the timer class to each trunk. There are 16 Classes that can be assigned. You make eight entries for this Program, one for each Night Service Mode. The details of classes are assigned by PRG 20-3.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Day/Night Mode 1~8, Class Number
Input Data
0~15, #, 0 = Not assigned
Default 0
Related Programming
Conditions None
2 - 197
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 20-31 : Timer Class Timer Assignment to assign values to the timers on a class of service basis.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 Item
Trunk Queuing Callback Duration Time Callback / Trunk Queuing Cancel Time CAR/SIE/Virtual Extension Delay Interval Intercom Inter-digits Time (Intercom I/D Timer) Trunk Inter-digits Time (Trunk I/D Timer) Hotline Time Start Time (Hotline Start) Ring No Answer Alarm Time DIL/Incoming Ring Group No Answer Time DID Ring-No-Answer Time Hold Recall Time (Non Exclusive Hold) Hold Recall CallBack Time (Non Exclusive Hold) Exclusive Hold Recall Time Exclusive Hold Recall Callback Time Park Hold Time Normal Delayed Call Forwarding Time (Call Forward No Answer) Transfer Recall Time DID/DISA No Answer Time (Disconnect or IRG or VM) Disconnect after Re-transfer to IRG
Input Data
0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds
Default 15 seconds 64800 seconds 10 seconds 10 seconds 5 seconds 5 seconds 60 seconds 0 seconds 20 seconds 90 seconds 30 seconds 90 seconds 30 seconds 90 seconds 10 seconds 30 seconds 30 seconds 60 seconds
Related Programming 20-01-08 20-01-09 20-04-03 21-01-02 21-01-03 21-01-09 22-01-02 22-01-04 22-01-06 24-01-01 24-01-02 24-01-03 24-01-04 24-01-06 24-02-03 24-02-04 25-07-02 25-07-03
2 - 198
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 19 20 21 22 23 Item
Long Conversation Warning Tone Time (Trunk to Trunk) Long Conversation Disconnect (Trunk to Trunk) DISA Internal Paging Time DISA External Paging Time Page Announcement Duration
Input Data
0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds 0~64800 seconds
Conditions
These timers are used when an extension or trunk is assigned to a class from 1 to 16 in 20-29-01 or 20-30-01. When the timer class is set to 0, the system-wide timer is used. All defaults are the same as the system wide timers.
H H
2 - 199
Document Revision 1
2 - 200
Description
Use Program 21-01 : System Options for Outgoing Calls to set the system options for Outgoing Call Service.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 Item
Seizure Trunk Line Mode
Input Data
0 = Priority Route 1 = Circular Route
Default 0 10
Intercom Interdigit Time When placing Intercom calls, extension users must dial each digit within this interval.
0~64800 (sec)
03
Trunk Interdigit Time (External) The system waits for this timer to expire before placing the call in a talk state (Call Timer starts after timer expires, Voice Over and Barge-In are not allowed until after timer expires).
0~64800 (sec)
14-02-08
04 05
Researched Time for DTD Circuit Dial Tone Detection Time If dial tone detection is enabled, the system will wait this interval for the Telco to return dial tone. When the interval expires, the system assumes dial tone is not present. To disable this timer (and have the system wait continuously), enter 0.
5 3
14-02-05
06 07
Dial Pause at First Digit Toll Restriction Override Time After dialing the Toll Restriction Override codes, the system removes Toll Restriction from the extension for this interval.
1 10 20-08-06 21-07
2 - 201
margorP
21
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 08 09 Item
Preset Dial Display Hold Time Ringdown Extension Timer (Hotline Start) A Ringdown extension automatically calls its programmed destination after this interval.
Input Data
0~64800 (sec) 0~64800 (sec)
Default 10 5
Related Program
20-08-09 21-11
10
Dial Digits for Toll Restriction Path If this option is programmed with an entry other than 0, a call will not have a talk path unless the user dials at least the number of digits entered in this option when placing an outgoing call. This means that an entry of 4 or higher in this program will cause a problem when dialing 911. Since it is only a 3-digit number, the call will not have a talk path, preventing the emergency dispatcher from hearing the caller. It is recommended that this option be kept at its default setting of 0 to prevent any problems with dialing 911.
0~24
11 12
Inter-Digit Time for Toll Restriction Path Control Dial E911 Routing Without Trunk Access If enabled (1), an extension user can dial 911 without first dialing a trunk access code or pressing a line key. If disabled (0), an extension user must dial a trunk access code (e.g., 9) or press a line key before dialing 911.
0~60
0 = Trunk Access Code Required = Trunk Access Code Not Required
0 1
13
Alarm Ring Timer (E911) Use this option to set the duration of the E911 Alarm Ring Time. If set for 0, the E911 Alarm will not ring.
11-12-56 20-08-16
14
Forced Account Code Inter-digit Timer The system waits this interval for a user to enter a Forced Account code.
0~64800 (sec)
15
Outgoing Disable on Incoming Line (Toll Restriction) Enable or disable the Outgoing Disable on Incoming Line feature.
0 1
2 - 202
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 16 Item
Supervise Dial Detection Timer With the Outgoing Disable on Incoming Line feature, if dial tone is not detected after the extension answers an incoming line, the system determines the call is unable to complete and releases the DTMF receiver.
Input Data
0~64800 (sec)
Default 20
17
Restriction Digit in Outgoing Disable on Incoming Line With the Outgoing Disable on Incoming Line feature, determine the number of digits to be dialed before the call should be disconnected.
Digits 0~9
18 19
0 0
99-01-01 15-01-07
Conditions None
2 - 203
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-02 : Trunk Group Routing for Extensions to assign Program 14-06 routes to extensions.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions None
2 - 204
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-03 : Trunk Group Routing for Trunks to set the Trunk Route Table for Automatic External Call Forward. The Route Table is set in Program 14-06.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions None
2 - 205
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-04 : Toll Restriction Class to assign a Toll Restriction class to an extension. The details of Toll Restriction are defined in Program 21-05 and 21-06.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Default 2
Conditions None
2 - 206
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-05 : Toll Restriction Class to set the system Toll Restriction classes (1~15).
Input Data
Toll Restriction Class Number 1~15
Item No. 01
Item
International Call Restriction Table
0 1
Input Data
= Unassigned (No) = Assigned (Yes)
Default 1
Description
This option assigns/unassigns the International Call Restrict Table for the Toll Restriction Class you are programming. Enter International Call Restrict Table data in Program 21-06-01. This option assigns/unassigns the International Call Permit Table for the Toll Restriction Class you are programming. Enter International Call Permit Table data in Program 21-06-02.
02
0 1
21-06-02
03 04
Select the table (defined in 21-06-03) to be used to determine the maximum number of digits allowed for outgoing calls. It chooses whether the table set up by 21-06-04 is referred to, or not referred to. It chooses whether the table set up by 21-06-05 is referred to, or not referred to. Set the tables 1~4 when referring to the table set up by 21-06-06.
21-06-03
05
0 1
21-06-04
06
0 1
21-06-05
07
21-06-06
2 - 207
Document Revision 1
Item No. 08
Item
Restriction Table
Input Data
1~4 = Table 0 = Disable (None)
Default 0
Description
Set the tables 1~4 when referring to the table set up by 21-06-07. Use this option to enable/disable Toll Restriction for Common Speed Dialing numbers. If enabled, System Speed Dialing numbers have the same restrictions as manually dialed numbers. Use this option to enable/disable Toll Restriction for Group Speed Dialing numbers. If enabled, Group Speed Dialing numbers have the same restrictions as manually dialed numbers. It chooses whether ICM incoming call is restricted.
09
0 1
10
0 1
= Does Not Restrict = Following Restriction Check = Disable (No) = Enable (Yes) = Disable (No) = Enable (Yes)
11
0 1
12
0 1
Use this option to set how the system Toll Restricts calls over PBX trunks. If you enable PBX Toll Restriction, the system begins Toll Restriction after the PBX access code. The user cannot dial a PBX extension. If you disable PBX Toll Restriction, the system only restricts calls that contain the PBX access code. The system does not restrict calls to PBX extensions. Refer to the PBX compatibility feature. Make sure Program 21-05-04 (Maximum Number of Digits Table Assignment) allows for PBX Toll Call Dialing (normally 12 digits). It chooses whether the toll restriction of the dial set up by 3408 is enabled or disabled.
13
0 1
= Disable (No) = Enable (Yes) = Not allow = Allow = Not allow = Allow
34-08
14
Trunk Transfer Restriction on Incomplete Dial Common Hold Restriction on Incomplete Dial
0 1 0 1
0 (Not allow)
If this program isset to 1, you can transfer the outgoing trunk which you dialed incompletely. If this program is set to 1, you can hold the outgoing trunk which you dialed in restriction check.
15
0 (Not allow)
2 - 208
Document Revision 1
Default
Item No. 1 Class No. 1 Class No. 2 Class No. 3 Class No. 4 Class No. 5 Class No. 6 Class No. 7 Class No. 8 : Class No. 15 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 : 1 2 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 : 1 3 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 : 1 4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 : 1 5 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 : 1 6 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 : 1 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 : 1 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 : 1 9 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 : 1 10 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 : 1 11 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 : 1 12 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 : 1 13 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 : 0 14 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 15 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Conditions None
2 - 209
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-06 : Toll Restriction Table Data Setup to set the system Toll Restriction data. Dial 1-9, 0, , # can be entered in each table.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
InternationaL Call Restriction Table
Table 1~10
02
1~20
03
1~4
04
1~10
05
1~10
2 - 210
Input Data
Dial (Up to 4 digits)
Default
Tables 1~10 = No Setting
Description
This option lets you program the Restrict Table for international calls. The system has 10 International Call Restrict Tables. Each entry can be up to four digits long. This option lets you program the Permit Table for international calls. The system has 20 International Call Permit Table. Each entry can be up to six digits long, using. This option selects the maximum number of digits allowed in outgoing calls for each table. This option lets you program the Common Permit Code Table. This table contains up to 10 codes you commonly allow users to dial.
No Setting
4-30
Tables 1~ 4 = 30
Table 1 = 911 Table 2 = 1800 Table 3 = 1888 Table 4 = 1822 Table 5 = 1833 Table 6 = 1844 Table 7 = 1855 Table 8 = 1866 Table 9 = 1877 Table 10 = No Setting
This option lets you program the Common Restrict Code Table. This table contains up to 10 codes you commonly prevent users from dialing.
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 06 Item
Permit Code Table 1~4 (table) 001~200 (Entry)
Table
Input Data
Dial (Up to 12 digits)
Default
Table 1~4 = No Setting
Description
This option lets you program the Permit Code Tables. If the system has Toll Restriction enabled, users can dial numbers only if permitted by these tables and the Common Permit Table (21-06-04). There are four Permit Code Tables, with up to 200 entries in each table. The system permits calls exactly as you enter the code. This option lets you program the Restrict Code Tables. If the system has Toll Restriction enabled, users cannot dial numbers listed in these tables. There are four Restrict Code Tables, with up to 200 entries in each table. The system restricts calls exactly as you enter the code. Use this option to enter the PBX Access Code. When the system is behind a PBX, this is the code users dial to access a PBX trunk. Toll Restriction begins after the PBX access code. For PBX trunks (Program 14-04) the system only Toll Restricts calls that contain the access code. Always program this option when the system is behind a PBX, even if you dont want to use Toll Restriction. PBX Access Codes can be up to 2 digits, using 0-9, #, * and LINE KEY 1 (dont care). When using Account Codes, do not use an asterisk within a PBX access code. Otherwise, after the *, the trunk would stop sending digits to the central office. Entries 1-4 correspond to the 4 PBX Access Codes. Each code can have up to 2 digits.
07
08
1~4
09
1~20
No Setting
10
1~20
No Setting
2 - 211
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 212
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-07 : Toll Restriction Override Password Setup to assign Toll Restriction Override codes to extension ports. Each code must be four digits long, using any combination of 0~9, # and . Each extension can have a separate code, or many extensions can share the same override code.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Conditions None
Default No Setting
2 - 213
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-08 : Repeat Dial Setup to define the automatic Repeat Dial data.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Repeat Redial Count Sets how many times a Repeat Redial automatically repeats if the call does not go through.
Default 3
Related Program
02
Repeat Redial Interval Time This timer sets the interval between Repeat Redial attempts.
0~64800 (sec)
60
03
Repeat Dial Calling Timer After dialing the trunk call, Repeat Redial maintains the call after this interval. After this interval, the system terminates the call, waits the Repeat Redial Time (Timer 02) and tries again.
0~64800 (sec)
30
04
Time for Send Busy Tone for ISDN Trunk Sets the timer (sec) to send out Busy Tone with an ISDN line, when called party is busy.
0~64800 (sec)
Conditions None
2 - 214
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-09 : Dial Block Setup to define the Dial Blocking Toll Restriction Class and Dial Block Password to be used by the Supervisor extension.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Toll Restriction Class With Dial Block Assign a Toll Restriction Class of Service when the Dial Block feature is used.
Default 15
Assign a 4-digit password to be used by the supervisor to enable or disable Dial Block for other extensions.
Conditions
This function works by password and Class of Service control (the supervisor is not an assigned extension). If Dial Block is available for all Classes of Service, everyone may become a supervisor if they know the Dial Block password.
02
Supervisor Password
No Setting
2 - 215
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-10 : Dial Block Restriction Class Per Extensions to define the Toll Restriction Class to each extension when the extension is set for Dial Block Restriction. If this data is 0, Toll Restriction Class follows Program 21-09-01.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digit
Item No. 01
Conditions None
2 - 216
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-11 : Extension Ringdown (Hotline) Assignment to define the Hotline destination number for each extension number.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Hotline Destination Number 0, , #, Pause, Hook Flash, @ (Code to wait for a response) (maximum 24 digits)
Default No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 217
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-12 : ISDN Calling Party Number Setup for Trunks to assign Calling Party Numbers for each trunk (maximum 16 digits per entry). When a call is made by an extension which does not have an Extension Calling Number assigned (Program 21-13), the system sends the calling number for the ISDN trunk defined in 21-12.
Conditions None
2 - 218
J
If the Calling Party Number is assigned in both Programs 21-12 and 21-13, the system sends the data in Program 21-13.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Default No Setting
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-13 : ISDN Calling Party Number Setup for Extensions to assign each extension a Calling Party Number (maximum 16 digits per entry). The calling number is the subscriber number of the dial-in number. When a call is made by an extension which does not have an Extension Calling Number assigned (Program 21-12), the system sends the calling number for the ISDN trunk defined in Program 21-13.
Conditions None
J
If a Calling Party Number is assigned in both Programs 21-12 and 21-13, the system sends the data in Program 21-13.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Default No setting
2 - 219
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-14 : Walking Toll Restriction Password Setup to assign the password and Toll Restriction Class for Walking Toll Restriction. Each code is six digits long, using any combination of 0-9, # and .
Input Data
ID Table Number 1~500
Item
Conditions None
2 - 220
Default No Setting 1
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-15 : Individual Trunk Group Route for Extensions to designate the alternate trunk access route accessed when a user dials the Alternate Trunk Route Access Code. Refer to Program 11-09-02 : Alternate Trunk Access Code when setting up alternate trunk codes. Refer to 14-06 : Trunk Group Routing to set up the trunk routes. When entering data for this option, enter the route number or 0 to prevent routing.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 221
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-21 : Toll Restriction for Trunks (Seized Trunk Basis Setting) to define the toll restriction class to each trunk. The details of toll restriction are defined by PRG 21-05 and 21-06. This program is compared to Station Restriction Class. The higher class is applied.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 000~200
Item No. 01
Description
Restriction Class Enter the Calling Party Number to be displayed for each IP trunk used.
Default 1
Conditions None
2 - 222
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 21-22 : CO Message Waiting Indication - Call Back Settings define the settings of CO Message Waiting Indication.
Input Data
Trunk 001~200
Item No. 01
Description
CO MWI Call Back Enabling Enable or Disable CO MWI Call Back.
Default 0
Related Program
02
CO-MWI Call Back Number Area Setting Define the Speed Dial Bin number for MWI Call Back.
1999
Conditions None
2 - 223
Document Revision 1
2 - 224
Description
Use Program 22-01 : System Options for Incoming Calls to define the system options for incoming calls.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Incoming Call Priority
Input Data
0 = Intercom Call Priority = Trunk Call Priority = Disable (Off) = Enable (On)
Default 1
Description
Use this option to determine if Intercom calls or trunk calls have answer priority when both are ringing simultaneously.
02
0 1
If enabled, an incoming call that rings longer than the Ring No Answer Alarm interval (22-01-03), will change to a unique ring cadence to indicate that the call has been ringing too long. If disabled, this will not occur. If a trunk rings a multiline telephone longer than this interval, the system changes the ring cadence. This indicates to the user that the call has been ringing too long. A DIL that rings its programmed destination longer than this interval diverts to the DIL No Answer Ring Group (set in Program 22-08).
22-01-03 22-01-04
03
0~64800 (sec.)
60
22-01-02
04
0~64800 (sec.)
05 06
0~64800 (sec.)
20
In systems with DID Ring-No-Answer Intercept, this interval sets the Ring-NoAnswer time. This interval is how long a DID call rings the destination extension before rerouting to the intercept ring group.
22-12
07
0~64800 (sec.)
20
2 - 225
margorP
22
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 08 09 Item
DID Pilot Call No answer timer DID to Trunk to Trunk no answer timer VRS Waiting Message Operation
Input Data
0~64800 (sec.) 0~64800 (sec.)
Default 60 20
Description
Related Program
10
0 1
This program sets up the operation mode for Auto Attendant and Queuing Message.
22-14 22-15 22-08 22-04 22-01-04 20-15-11 15-07 22-14-06 22-15-06 41-11-06
11
0~64800 (sec.)
20
Setup the sending duration time of the Auto - Attendant & Queuing. The message is repeatedly sent out within the specified time.
Conditions None
2 - 226
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-02 : Incoming Call Trunk Setup to assign the incoming trunk type for each trunk. There is one item for each Night Service Mode.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Incoming Type
= Normal = VRS (second dial tone if no VRS installed) = DISA = DID = DIL = E&M Tie line = Delayed VRS = ANI/DNIS = DID(DDI) Mode Switching
Default 0
Description
Use this option to set the feature type for the trunk you are programming.
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Conditions
When connecting to T1 trunks, after changing Program 22-02-01 to match the Telcos connected T1 service type, the T1 cable or the T1 PCB must be unplugged and then reconnected in order for the T1 PCB to sync. When the trunk type is set to a 3 (DID), the DID Transfert Destination in 22-11-04 for each DID feature is not supported. This feature is only supported for DID trunks when assigned as VRS.
H H
2 - 227
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-03 : Trunk Ring Tone Range to select the ring tone range for the trunk. The trunk uses a ring tone within the range selected when it rings an extension. There are eight ring tones available. Customize the Trunk Ring Tones in Program 82-01.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Ring Tone Pattern 0~8 (Ring Tone Pattern 1~4) (Melody 1~ Melody 5)
Default 0
Description
Use this program to select the ring tone range for the trunk. The trunk uses a ring tone within the range selected when it rings an extension. There are eight ring tones available.
Pattern 2
Pattern 3
Pattern 4
2 - 228
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 229
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-04 : Incoming Extension Ring Group Assignment to assign extensions to Ring Groups. Calls ring extensions according to Ring Group programming. Use Program 22-05 to assign trunks to Ring Groups and use Program 22-06 to set the ringing for the phones. An Incoming Ring Group (IRG) can have up to 32 extension numbers assigned.
Conditions None
2 - 230
J
Input Data
Incoming Ring Group Number 1~100
Item No. 01
Description
Use this program to assign extensions (up to 32) to Ring Groups. Calls ring extensions according to Ring Group programming.
Default
Extensions 101~108 (first 8 ports) ring for incoming Ring Group 1 calls. All other extensions do not ring for incoming Ring Group 1 calls.
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-05 : Incoming Trunk Ring Group Assignment to assign trunks to incoming Ring Groups. There are 100 available Ring Groups.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 00~200
Item No. 01
Incoming Group Number 0 (No Setting) 1~8 or 001~100 (Incoming Group) 101 (DSPII-U10 Internal Voice Mail on Compact Flash) 102 (In-Skin/ External Voice Mail) 103 (Not used)
Default 1
Description
Use this program to assign Normal Ring Trunks (22-02) to Incoming Ring Groups (22-04).
Conditions None
2 - 231
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-06 : Normal Incoming Ring Mode to define whether or not an extension should ring for the Normal Incoming Ring Mode.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions None
2 - 232
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-07 : DIL Assignment to assign the destination extension or Department Calling Group for each DIL Incoming trunk. A DIL rings an extension directly, without any other Access Map or Ring Group programming. If an extension has a line key, the DIL rings the line key. If the extension does not have a line key, the DIL rings CAP keys. Use Program 22-02 to designate a trunk as a DIL). You can make eight DIL assignments, one for each Night Service mode.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Default No Setting
Conditions
2 - 233
Document Revision 1
Description
For DIL Delayed Ringing, use Program 22-08 : DIL/IRG No Answer Destination to assign the DIL No Answer Ring Group. An unanswered DIL rings this group after the DIL No Answer Time expires (Program 22-01-04). DIL Delayed Ringing can also reroute outside calls ringing a Ring Group. Make eight assignments, one for each Night Service mode.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Incoming Group Number 0 (No Setting) 1~8 or 001~100 (Incoming Group) 101 (DSPII-U10 Internal Voicemail on Compact Flash) 102 (In-Skin/External Voice Mail) 103 (Centralized Voice Mail)
Default 1
Conditions None
2 - 234
J J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-09 : DID Basic Data Setup to define the basic setting of Dial-In incoming calls for each trunk group.
Input Data
Trunk Group Number 001~100
Item No. 01
Item
Expected Number of Digits Enter the number of digits the table expects to receive from the telco. Use this program to make the system compatible with three- and four-digit DID service.
Default 4
02
Received Vacant Number Operation Use this option to enable or disable Vacant Number Intercept.
0 1
= Disconnect (Cut) = Transfer (Refer to Program 22-12 : DID Intercept Ring Group on page 2-243.) = Extension # Specify (Intercom) = DID Conversion Table = Enbloc Receiving = Overlap Receiving
03
Sub-Addressing Mode
0 1
04 05
0 1
0 0
06
No Setting
07
No Setting
08
0 1
= Disconnect (Cut) = Transfer (Refer to Program 22-12 : DID Intercept Ring Group on page 2-243.)
2 - 235
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 236
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-10 : DID Translation Table Setup to specify the size of the DID Translation Tables. There are 2000 Translation Table entries that you can allocate among 20 Translation Tables.
Input Data
Conversion Table Area Number 01~20
Item No. 01
Item 1st Area Setup (Start Address) 1st Area Setup (End Address) 2nd Area Setup (Start Address) 2nd Area Setup (End Address)
Input Data 0~2000 (0 = No Setting) See below See below See below
Default
1st Conversion Table Area 1 2 3 4 : 20 Start Table 1 101 201 301 : 0 End Table 100 200 300 400 : 0 Start Table 0 0 0 0 : 0 2nd End Table 0 0 0 0 : 0
2 - 237
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 238
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-11 : DID Translation Table Number Conversion to specify for each Translation Table entry (2000):
The digits received by the system (eight maximum) The extension the system dials after translation (24 digits maximum) The name that should show on the dialed extensions display when it rings (12 characters maximum) The Transfer Target 1 and 2
If the Transfer Targets are busy or receive no answer, those calls are transferred to the final transfer destination (Program 22-10).
Use the following chart when entering and editing text for names. Press the key once for the first character, twice for the second character, etc. For example, to enter a C, press 2 three times.
Key for Entering Names
When entering names in the procedures below, refer to this chart. Names can be up to 12 digits long. Use this keypad digit . . . When you want to. . .
J J J J J
Operation Mode
Enter characters: 1 @ [ ] ^ _ ` { | } Enter characters A-C, a-c, 2. Enter characters D-F, d-f, 3. Enter characters G-I, g-i, 4. Enter characters J-L, j-l, 5. Enter characters M-O, m-o, 6. Enter characters P-S, p-s, 7. Enter characters T-V, t-v, 8.
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
2 - 239
Document Revision 1
9 0
% :
& ;
<
( =
) >
# = Accepts an entry (only required if two letters on the same key are needed - ex: TOM). Pressing # again = Space. (In system programming mode, use the right arrow soft key instead to accept and/or add a space.) Clear the character entry one character at a time. Clear all the entries from the point of the flashing cursor and to the right.
CONF HOLD
Input Data
Conversion Table Number 1~2000
Item No. 01 02 03 04
Item
Received Number Target Number DID Name Transfer Operation Mode
2 - 240
E B
Document Revision 1
Item No. 05 06
Item
Transfer Destination Number -1 Transfer Destination Number -2 400 = Allows the outside party to dial a different extension number in the translation table (for example, ring no answer to a dialed number, the caller then hears a dial tone, allowing them to enter another Valid Extension Number). 401 = Provides the caller with DISA dialing options (requires the use of the DISA password). Note: This applies to 22-11-05 and 22-1106.
Input Data 0 = No Setting 1~8 or 1~100 = Incoming Group 101 = DSPII-U10 Voice Mail 102 = In-Skin/External Voice Mail 103 = Centralized Voice Mail 201~264 = Extension Group 400 = Valid Extension Number 401 = DISA 1000~999 = Speed Number (000~999)
Default 0 0
07
Call Waiting
0 = Disable (No) 1 = Enable (Yes) 0~200 (0 = No Limit) 0 = IC/MOH Port 1 = BGM Port 2 = ACI Port When a sound source type is 2 in above : (0~96) 0 = Disable 1 = Enabled
08 09
0 0
10 11
0 1
Ring Group Transfer Enable (1) or disable (0) each conversation tables ability to follow the Ring Group programming defined in Program 22-12-01 : DID Intercept Ring Group. If Program 22-11-05 : DID Translation Number Conversion, Transfer Destination Number 1 and Program 22-11-06 : DID Translation Number Conversion, Transfer Destination Number 2 are set, the priority of transferring will be in this order: Program 22-11-05 then Program 22-11-06 then if Program 22-11-11 is enabled, Program 22-12-01.
2 - 241
Document Revision 1
Conditions
When the trunk type is set to a 3 (DID) in 22-02-01, the DID Transfer Destination for each DID feature is not supported. This feature is only supported for DID trunks when assigned as VRS.
2 - 242
Document Revision 1
Description
For each DID Translation Table, use Program 22-12 : DID Intercept Ring Group to define the first destination group for DID calls. Depending on the entry in Program 22-09-02 and 22-11-04, the incoming calls will route to the first destination group by the following:
Vacant number intercept (vacant number means that there is no phone connected, no station card installed, or the extension number is not defined in Program 11-02) Busy intercept Ring-no-answer intercept
J J J
If the destination is '0', the calls will be forwarded to the trunk ring group defined in Program 22-11 based on the table assigned to the DID trunk.
If Program 22-11-05 and 22-11-06 are set, the priority of transferring will be in this order: Program 22-11-05 + Program 22-11-06 + Program 22-12. For busy and no-answer calls, if the first and third destinations are programmed but the second destination is not, the incoming call goes to the third destination after the first destination. If the first and second destinations are not defined, but the third destination is, the call goes directly to the third destination (as defined in Program 22-12).
Conversion Table Area Number 01~20
Item No. 01
Incoming Group Number 0 (No Setting) 1~8 or 1~100 (Incoming Group) 101 (DSPII-U10 Voice Mail) 102 (In-Skin/External Voice Mail) 103 (Centralized Voice Mail)
Default 1
2 - 243
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 244
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-13 : DID Trunk Group to Translation Table Assignment to assign the DID Trunk Groups to DID Translation Tables. DID trunks should be in their own group. If you have more than one type of DID trunk, put each type in a separate Trunk Group. For each Trunk Group, you make a Translation Table entry for each Night Service mode.
Input Data
Trunk Group Number 1~100
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions None
2 - 245
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-14 : VRS Delayed Message for IRG (Incoming Group Ring) to define for each incoming ring group the timers, VRS message number and type of tone for VRS Waiting Message.
Input Data
Incoming Ring Group Number 1~100
Item No. 01 02
Item 1st Waiting Message Start Timing 1st Waiting Message Number
Input Data
0~64800 (sec) 0~49 0 = No Message 49 = Fixed Message 0~255 (time) 0~49 0 = No Message 49 = Fixed Message 0~255 (time) 0 = Ring Back Tone 1 = MOH Tone 2 = BGM Source 0 = No Disconnect 1~64800 Seconds
Default 0 0
03 04
0 0
05 06
0 0
07
60
Conditions None
2 - 246
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-15 : VRS Waiting Message for Department Group to define for each Department (Extension) Group the timers, VRS message number and tone kind for VRS Waiting Message. There are 64 available Department Groups.
Input Data
Extension Group Number 01~64
Item No. 01 02
Item 1st Waiting Message Start Timing 1st Waiting Message Number
Input Data 0~64800 (sec) 0~49 0 = No Message 49 = Fixed Message 0~255 (time) 0~49 0 = No Message 49 = Fixed Message 0~255 (time) 0 = Ring Back Tone 1 = MOH Tone 2 = BGM Source 0 = No Disconnect 1~64800 (sec)
Default 0 0
03 04
0 0
05 06
0 0
07
60
Conditions None
2 - 247
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-16: Private Call Refuse Target Area Setup to define Speed Dial group number for Private Call Refuse.
Item No. 01 Item
Speed Dial Group Number
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 248
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-17: Dial-In Conversion Table Area Setup for Time Pattern to define Time Zone and Dial-In Conversion Table (PRG22-11) for Time Pattern.
Item No. 01 02 03 04 Item
Received Dial Start of Time
End of Time
Conditions None
2 - 249
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 22-18: Private Call Assignment Setup to define assignment and incoming ring pattern for Private Calls.
Item No. 01 02 03 Item
Transfer Mode Destination Number Incoming Ring Pattern
Default 0 No Setting 0
Conditions None
2 - 250
Description
Input Data
Extension Number
Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Priority 1~999
Default 1 xxx
Description
Use this program to assign extensions to Call Pickup Groups other than the extension group set up by a Program 16-02.
Conditions None
2 - 251
margorP
Use Program 23-02 : Call Pickup Groups to assign extensions to Call Pickup Groups. This program also lets you assign an extensions Call Pickup Group priority. If two extensions in a group are ringing at the same time, Group Call Pickup intercepts the highest priority extension first.
23
J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 23-03 : Universal Answer/Auto Answer to assign trunk routes (set in Program 14-06) to extensions for Universal Answer. If the call ringing the paging system is in an extensions assigned route, the user can dial the Universal Answer code (#0) to pick up the call. You can also use this program to let an extension user automatically answer trunk calls that ring other extensions (not their own). When the user lifts the handset, they automatically answer the ringing calls based on Trunk Group Routing programming (defined in Program 14-06). The extension users own ringing calls, however, always have priority over calls ringing other co-workers extensions. Refer to the Line Preference feature in the Electra Elite Electra Elite IPK II Features and Specifications Manual for more information. Make one entry for each Night Service mode.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Default 0
Description
Use this program to let an extension user automatically answer trunk calls that ring other extensions. When the user lifts the handset, they automatically answer the ringing calls based on Trunk Group Routing programming (defined in Program 14-06).
2 - 252
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
J J
2 - 253
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 23-04 : Ringing Line Preference for Virtual Extensions to set the off-hook automatic response priority for calls ringing virtual extension keys on a telephone.
2 - 254
J
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Order 1~4
Default 00
Description
When an extension has a virtual extension assigned to a Programmable Function Key, this program determines the priority for automatically answering the ringing calls when the handset is lifted. If 0 or 00 is selected, when the user lifts the handset, the user will answer a ringing call from any group.
Conditions None
Description
Use Program 24-01 : System Options for Hold to define the system options for the Hold feature.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Hold Recall Time A call on Hold recalls the extension that placed it on Hold after this interval. This timer works with the Hold Recall Callback Timer (Item 2).
Default 90
Related Program
02
Hold Recall Callback Time A trunk recalling from Hold or Park rings an extension for this interval. This timer works with timer 01 (Hold Recall Time) or timer 06 and 07 (Park Recall Time). After this interval, the system invokes the Hold recall time again. Cycling between timer 01 and 02 and 06 and 07 continues until a user answers the call.
0~64800 (sec)
30
03
Exclusive Hold Recall Time A call left on Exclusive Hold recalls the extension that placed it on Hold after this interval.
0~64800 (sec)
90
04
Exclusive Hold Recall Callback Time An Exclusive Hold Recall rings an extension for this interval. If not picked up, the call goes back on System Hold.
0~64800 (sec)
30
05
Forced Release of Held Call Depending on the setting of Program 14-01-16, the system disconnects calls on Hold longer than this interval.
0~64800 (sec)
1800
14-01-16
2 - 255
margorP
24
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 06 Item
Park Hold Time - Normal A call left parked longer than this interval recalls the extension that initially parked it.
Default 90
07
Park Hold Time - Extended (Recall) A call left parked longer than this interval recalls the extension that initially parked it.
0~64800 (sec)
300
20-11-19
Conditions None
2 - 256
J J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 24-02 : System Options for Transfer to define the system options for the Transfer feature.
Input Data
Item No. 01
Busy Transfer Use this option to prevent or allow extensions to Transfer calls to busy extensions.
Item
0 1 0 1
Input Data
= Disable (No) = Enable (Yes) = Hold Tone = Ring Back Tone
Default 1
Related Program
02
MOH or Ringback on Transferred Calls Use this option to enable or disable MOH on Transfer. If enabled (0), a transferred caller hears MOH while their call rings the destination extension. If disabled (1), a transferred caller hears ringback while their call rings the destination extension.
20-03-02
03
Delayed Call Forwarding Time If activated at an extension, Delayed Call Forwarding occurs after this interval. This also sets how long a Transferred call waits at an extension forwarded to Voice Mail before routing to the called extensions mailbox.
0~64800 (sec)
10
04
Transfer Recall Time An unanswered transferred call recalls to the extension that initially transferred it after this interval.
0~64800 (sec)
30
05
Message Wait Ring Interval Timer For SLTs without message waiting lamps, this timer determines the amount of time between intermittent ringing. If this timer is set to '0' then the system rings once.
0~64800 (sec)
30
2 - 257
Document Revision 1
Input Data
07
Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer Release Warning Tone This timer will start when a trunk begins talking with another trunk (for example: trunk-to-trunk transfer, outgoing from trunk, Tandem Trunking). When this timer expires, a warning tone is heard. If Program 24-02-10 is set, the conversation disconnects after that timer expires. This timer is set again when the external digit timer expires. One of the trunks used must be an analog trunk (or leased line).
0~64800 (sec)
1800
08
0~64800 (sec)
10
11-11-28 11-11-29 15-07-59 10-03-16 (PRI) 14-01-25 20-28-01 20-28-02 20-28-03 24-02-07 14-01-26 14-01-26
09 10
10 0
Disconnect Trunk-to-Trunk
11 12
10 0
Conditions None
2 - 258
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 24-03 : Park Group to assign an extension to a Park Group. The system allows a total of 64 Park Groups. An extension can only pick up a call parked in orbit by an extension in its own group.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Default 1
Description Assign an extension to a Park Group. The system allows a total of 64 Park Groups.
Conditions None
2 - 259
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 24-04 : Automatic Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer Target Setup to assign the Speed Dialing number bin which should be used as the destination of the Automatic Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Default 1999
Description
The destination telephone number of the Trunk-to-Trunk Transfer uses the number registered into the Speed Dial. Use this program to setup the Speed Dial Bin Number.
Conditions None
2 - 260
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 24-05 : Department Group Transfer Target Setup to assign the Speed Dialing bin which is used as the destination of the extension for the Extension Group.
J
Input Data
Extension Group Number 01~64
Item No. 01
Default 1999
Description
The Speed Dialing area is used to program the destination number of the transferred telephone number when a Department Groups call is transferred using the Trunk-to-Trunk Forwarding feature.
Conditions None
2 - 261
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 24-09 : Call Forward Split Settings to assign Call Forwarding Type and the destination numbers for each extension/virtual extension. The destination can be up to 24 digits long, using 0~9, , # and P (pause). Be sure to include the trunk access code (e.g., 9) in the number if the destination is off-premise.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Input Data
Call Forwarding Type: 0 = Call Forwarding Off 1 = Call Forwarding with both ring 2 = Call Forwarding when no answer 3 = Call Forwarding all calls 4 = Call Forwarding busy or no answer 5 Call Forwarding when busy
02
CO Call Forwarding Destination for Both Ring, All Call, No Answer (Up to 24 digits)
03
Intercom Call Forwarding Destination for Both ring, All Call, No Answer (Up to 24 digits)
04
05
2 - 262
1~9, 0, #,
1~9, 0, #,
1~9, 0, #,
1~9, 0, #,
, P, R, @
, P, R, @
, P, R, @
, P, R, @
Default 0
No Setting
No Setting
No Setting
No Setting
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 263
Document Revision 1
2 - 264
Description
Use Program 25-01 : VRS/DISA Line Basic Data Setup to define the basic setting of each VRS/DISA line.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Item
VRS/DISA Dial-In Mode
Input Data
0 = Extension Number Service Code Specify (Intercom) = Use Dial Conversion Table = Off = On = Normal (Off) = Alarm (On)
Default 0
02 03
DISA User ID
0 1 0 1
1 0
25-08
Conditions None
2 - 265
margorP
25
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 25-02 : DID/DISA VRS Message to assign the VRS message number to be used as the Automated Attendant Message for each trunk which is assigned as a VRS/DISA.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Additional Data
1: 01~48 (VRS Message Number) 2: 01~16 (ACI Group Number) 3: 1~8 or 01~64 (Extension Group Number)
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 266
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 25-03 : VRS/DISA Transfer Ring Group With Incorrect Dialing to set what happens to a call when the DISA or Automated Attendant caller dials incorrectly or waits too long to dial. The call can either disconnect (0) or Transfer to an alternate destination (a ring group or voice mail). When setting the DISA and DID Operating Mode, make an entry for each Night Service mode.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Incoming Group Number 0 (Disconnect) 1~8 or 1~100 (Incoming Group) 101 (DSPII-U10 Internal Voice Mail on Compact Flash) 102 (In-Skin/External Voice Mail) 103 (Centralized Voice Mail)
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 267
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 25-04 : VRS/DISA Transfer Ring Group With No Answer/Busy to set the operating mode of each DISA trunk. This sets what happens to the call when the DISA or Automated Attendant caller calls a busy or unanswered extension. The call can either disconnect (0) or Transfer to an alternate destination (a ring group or voice mail). When setting the DISA and DID Operating Mode, make an entry for each Night Service mode.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Incoming Group Number 0 (Disconnect) 1~8 or 1~100 (Incoming Ring Group) 101 (DSPII-U10 Internal Voicemail on Compact Flash) 102 (In-Skin/External Voice Mail) 103 (Centralized Voice Mail)
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 268
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 25-05 : VRS/DISA Error Message Assignment to assign the VRS message number to be used as the Automated Attendant error message. For each VRS/DISA trunk that the VRS will answer, enter the VRS message (1~48) the outside caller hears if they dial incorrectly. If you enter 0 (i.e., no error message), the call reroutes according to Program 25-03 and 25-04. For each trunk, you make a separate entry for each Night Service mode.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 269
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 25-06 : VRS/DISA One-Digit Code Attendant Setup to set up single digit dialing through the VRS. This gives VRS callers single key access to extensions, the company operator, Department Calling Groups and Voice Mail. For each VRS message set to answer outside calls (refer to Program 25-04 and 25-05), you specify:
The digit the VRS caller dials (0-9, , #). (Keep in mind that if you assign destinations to digits, outside callers will not be able to dial system extensions. The destination reached (eight digits max.) when the caller dials the specified digit.
The destination can be an extension, a Department Calling pilot number or the Voice Mail master number. A one-digit code can be assigned for each Automated Attendant message. Example: Message Number=01, Destination=2, Next Message Number=0, Dial=399 In this example, when 2 is dialed by an outside caller, the system transfers the call to 399. This means that extension 200~299 cannot receive calls from VRS/DISA users during/after VRS Message 01.
Input Data
Attendant Message Number Received Dial 01~48 1-9,0, ,#
Item No. 01 02
Item
Next Attendant Message Number Destination Number
2 - 270
J J
Default 0 No Setting
Document Revision 1
Conditions
Outside caller may not be able to dial individual extensions or lines if the same first digit is defined here.
J J
2 - 271
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 25-07 : System Timers for VRS/DISA to set the value for the system timers which affect DID and DISA. Refer to the following chart for a description of each option, its range and default setting.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
VRS/DISA Dial Tone Time After answering a DISA trunk, the system waits this interval for the caller to dial the first digit of the DISA password. If the caller fails to dial within this interval, the system drops the call.
Default 10
02
VRS/DISA No Answer Time A VRS/DISA caller can ring an extension for this interval before the system sets the call as a Ring No Answer. After this interval expires, the call follows the programmed Ring No Answer routing (set in Program 25-03 and 25-04).
0~64800 (sec)
25-04
03 04
60 10
Calling Time to Automatic Answering Telephone Set Set the answering waiting time of the automatic answering extension when an incoming DID trunk call is received.
05
Duration Time for Guidance Message by Automatic Answering Telephone Set Set the announcement time of the automatic answering extension after which in incoming DID trunk caller is disconnected.
0~64800 (sec)
10
06
Duration Time for Guidance Message by ACI Set the announcement time by the ACI after which an incoming DID trunk caller is disconnected.
0~64800 (sec)
10
07
Long Conversation Warning Tone Time Determine the length of time a DISA caller or any trunkto-trunk (such as Tandem Trunking) conversation can talk before the Long Conversation tone is heard.
0~64800 (sec)
3600
2 - 272
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 08 Item
Long Conversation Disconnect This timer determines how long the system will wait before disconnecting a DISA caller or any trunk-to-trunk (such as Tandem Trunking) conversation call after the Long Conversation tone is heard.
Default 10
09
DISA Internal Paging Time This is the maximum length of an Internal Page placed by a DISA caller. If the Page continues longer than this interval, the system terminates the DISA call.
0~64800 (sec)
30
10
DISA External Paging Time This is the maximum length of an External Page placed by a DISA caller. If the Page continues longer than this interval, the system terminates the DISA call.
0~64800 (sec)
30
11
VRS/DISA Answer Delay Timer Set up the interval time the system will wait after receiving an incoming VRS/DISA call until the system will automatically answer the call.
0~64800 (sec)
13
VRS/DISA Busy Tone Interval If a DISA caller dials a busy extension (and Program 25-04 = 0), the system plays busy tone for this interval before disconnecting.
0~64800 (sec)
14
Delayed VRS Answer Timer Assign the delay time from switching from a normal incoming status to DID mode. If this time is set to 0, the call will switch to DID mode immediately.
0~64800 (sec)
10
Conditions None
2 - 273
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 25-08 : DISA User ID Setup to set the 6-digit DISA password for each user. There are 15 users each with one 6-digit password.
Input Data
DISA User Number 1~15
Item No. 01
Default No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 274
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 25-09 : Class of Service for DISA Users to set the DISA Class of Service for each user. When a DISA caller enters a password (defined in Program 25-08), the system identifies the user and associates the appropriate DISA Class of Service with the call. Assign the DISA Class of Service options in Program 20-14. When programming DISA Class of Service, you make one entry for each Night Service mode.
Input Data
DISA User Number 1~15
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions
DISA Class of Service cannot be 0. Program 20-06 cannot be used to assign Class of Service to DISA trunks.
H H
2 - 275
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 25-10 : Trunk Group Routing for DISA to assign the Trunk Group route chosen when a user places a DISA call into the system and dials 9. Set Trunk Group Routing in Program 14-06. Enable or disable the DISA callers ability to dial 9 in Program 20-14-02. You assign a route to each DISA Class of Service (1-15). The system assigns a DISA Class of Service to a call based on the password the DISA caller dials. When programming, you make a separate entry for each Night Service Mode.
Input Data
DISA User Number 1~15
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions None
2 - 276
Document Revision 1
Description
For systems that use Toll Restriction, use Program 25-11 : DISA Toll Restriction Class to assign a Toll Restriction Class (1-15) to each DISA user (1-15). The system uses the Toll Restriction Class you enter in Program 21-05 and 21-06. The Toll Restriction Class assigned to a DISA call is based on the DISA Class of Service and user, which is determined by the password the caller dials. When programming, you make a separate entry for each Night Service mode.
Input Data
DISA User Number 1~15
Item No. 01
Default 2
Conditions
J J
2 - 277
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 25-12 : Alternate Trunk Group Routing for DISA to define the trunk route selected when a DISA caller dials the Alternate Trunk Access Code. The route selected is based on the DISA callers Class of Service, which is in turn determined by the password the caller dials. When programming, you make a separate entry for each Night Service Mode. Use Program 11-09-02 to set the Alternate Trunk Access Code. Use Program 14-06 to set trunk routes.
Input Data
DISA User Number 1~15
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions
You cannot use Program 21-15 to assign alternate trunk routing to DISA trunks.
2 - 278
J J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 25-13 : System Option for DISA to enter the password DISA callers must dial before the system will allow them to record, listen to and or erase the VRS messages. This program also is used to define additional DISA call options.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
VRS Message Access Password Enter the password DISA callers must dial before the system will allow them to record, listen to and or erase the VRS messages.
Default No Setting
02 03
Conditions None
J J
2 - 279
Document Revision 1
2 - 280
Description
Use Program 26-01 : Automatic Route Selection Service to define the system options for Automatic Route Selection (ARS).
Input Data
Item No. 01
ARS Service Enable or disable ARS.
Item
0 1
Input Data
= Disable (Off) = Enable (On)
Default 0
02
Network Outgoing Inter-Digit ARS Timer With Networking, this timer replaces 20-03-04 when determining if all network protocol digits have been received. If ARS is enabled at Site B, this timer can be programmed for 5 (500 msec) at Site A. If ARS is disabled and Site B is using F-Route for outbound dialing, this timer should be programmed for 30 (3 seconds) at Site A.
0~64800 (msec)
30
03
ARS Misdialed Number Handling If a user dials a number not programmed in ARS, this option determines if the system should route over trunk group 1 or play error tone.
0 1
21-02
04 05 06 07
--- Not Used ----- Not Used --Class of Service Match Access
0 0
2 - 281
margorP
26
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 282
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 26-02 : Dial Analysis Table for ARS/LCR to set pre-transaction tables for selecting Automatic Route Selection (ARS).
Service Type 1 (Route to Trunk Group Number) - The number routes to a trunk group. Service Type 2 (F-Route Selected) - The number is controlled by the F-Route table.
Item No. 01
Dial
Item
02
03
If Service Type 1 (in 26-02): Select Trunk Group Number (0~100, 0= No Route) If Service Type 2 (in 26-02): F-Route Time Schedule Not Used = 0~500 (F-Route Table Number). Refer to Program 44-05 : ARS/F-Route Table on page 2-399. F-Route Time Schedule Used = 0~500 (F-Route Selection Number). Refer to Program 44-04 : ARS/F-Route Selection for Time Schedule on page 2-398).
04 05
J J
Input Data
Dial Analysis Table Number 1~200
Input Data Dial Digits (16 digits maximum) 1-9, 0, , #, or for wild character (Press line key 1)
Default No Setting 0
Related Programming
44-04 44-05
0~16 0~15
0 0
2 - 283
Document Revision 1
Item No. 06
Item
LCR Carrier Table Select the Carrier Table to be used for dial edit. Table 1 is a special table - this table will be automatically used for all numbers that begin with 0 and which do not correspond with the entry in Program 26-02-01.
Default 0
Related Programming
Conditions None
2 - 284
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 26-03 : ARS Dial Treatments to assign the 15 Dial Treatments for automatic ARS dialing translation. Assign Dial Treatments to Service Numbers (Trunk Groups) in Program 26-02. The ARS Dial Treatment options are:
3 - Delete the NPA if dialed as part of the initial call.
Requires at least eight digits in the ARS table (Program 26-02-01).
DNN - Outdial the NN number of digits or execute the code that follows. For example, D041234 outdials 1234. Valid entries are 0-9, #, , Wnn (wait nn seconds) and P (pause). Each digits code counts as a digit. So, for example, if a P was added for a pause, the entry would look like: D05P1234. Wnn - Wait nn seconds. P - Pause in analog trunk. R - Redial the initially dialed number, including any modifications. E - End of Dial Treatment. All Dial Treatments must end with the E code. X - When ARS is enabled, X must be entered in the Dial Treatment in order for the system to output the extension number of the calls originator to the black box for the E911 feature.
J J J J J J J J J J
2 - 285
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Dial Treatment Table Number 1~15
Item No. 01
Default No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 286
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 26-04 : ARS Class of Service to set the ARS Class of Service for an extension. Automatic Route Selection uses ARS Class of Service when determining how to route extension calls.
Input Data
Extension Number Up to 8 digits
Item No. 01
Class 0~16
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 287
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 26-05 : LCR Carrier Table to set the Carrier Table for LCR.
Input Data
LCR Carrier Table 1~25
Item No. 01 02 03 04
Delete Digit Access Code
Item
Default 0 No Setting 0 0
Conditions None
2 - 288
1~10
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 26-06 : LCR Authorization Table to set the Authorization Code Table for LCR.
Input Data
LCR Authorization Table 1~10
Item No. 01
Authorization Code
Item
Default No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 289
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 26-07 : LCR Cost Center Code Table to set the Cost Center Code for LCR.
Input Data
Extension Number Up to 8 Digits
Item No. 01
Cost Center Code
Item
Conditions None
2 - 290
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 26-08 : LCR Manual Override Access Code Table to set the Manual Override Access Codes for LCR.
Input Data
LCR Manual Override Access Code Table 1~10
Item No. 01 02
Item
Manual Override Access Code (Dial) Carrier Table
Default No Setting 0
Conditions None
2 - 291
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 26-09 : LCR Manual Override Exemption Table to set Manual Override Exemption for LCR.
Input Data
LCR Carrier Table 1~25
Item No. 01
Item
LCR Manual Override Exemption Code
Default No Setting
Table Number 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
Default 999 112 No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting
2 - 292
Document Revision 1
Table Number 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
Default No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 293
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 26-11 : Transit Network ID Table to define Transit Network ID for Alternate carrier access, which is referred from PRG26-03.
Input Data
Transit Network ID Table 1~4
Item No. 01
Item
Transit Network ID (Carrier ID)
Default No setting
Conditions None
2 - 294
Description
Regular (Business) Mode (0) Hotel Mode (1) ACD Monitor Mode (2) Business (BS) and ACD Monitor Modes (3)
Input Data
DSS Console Number 01~32
Item No. 01
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 295
margorP
Use Program 30-01 : DSS Console Operating Mode to set the mode of the system DSS Consoles. The entry for this option applies to all the system DSS Consoles. The available options are:
J J J J J J
30
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 30-02 : DSS Console Extension Assignment to identify which extensions have DSS Consoles connected.
Up to 32 different extensions with DSS Consoles can be set up. A single extension can have up to four 60-button DSS Consoles (32 is the maximum allowed per system).
2 - 296
J
01
When programming, each extension/DSS Console(s) combination is called a Console Number. There are 32 Console Numbers (1~32). Console Numbers can be assigned to extensions. When entering data, the assignment for Console Number 1 is normally made first.
Input Data
60-button DSS Console Number 01~32
Item No.
Item
Extension Number
Description The extension number for the multiline terminal connected with the DSS console (up to 8 digits)
Default No Setting
Conditions None
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 30-03 : DSS Console Key Assignments to customize the key assignments for 60-button DSS Consoles. A DSS Console key can have any function up to four digits long (e.g., extension number or Service Code). To prevent lamping problems when reassigning DSS Console keys, it is recommended that you clear an extension's programmed key before reassigning it [Enter key to be cleared + 00 or 00 (If using Web or PC Programming, delete the key assignments and upload the change to the system before proceeding.)] Without clearing an extension key first, the DSS Console may not show the correct lamping, although the DSS function works correctly. If you are programming the system from the extension to which the DSS Console is connected, either by phone or using the Web or PC Program, you may need to unplug the DSS and plug it back in to reset the console's lamping.
Input Data
Index 1 DSS Console Number Index 2 Item No. 01 Key Number 01~60 Function Number 0~99 (General Functional Level) 00 ~ 99 (Appearance Functional Level) Additional Data Refer to Function Number List on the following pages. 01~32
2 - 297
Document Revision 1
Red On: Extension Busy Off: Extension Idle Rapid Blink (Red): DND or Call
Forward
02
Red On: Mic On Off: Mic Off Red On: DND Red On: BGM On Off: BGM Off Red On: Under Headset Operation
None
03 04
05 06 07 08
Red On: Under Conference Operation Rapid Blink (Red): New Call Log Red On: Call Log Off: No Call Log
Mode Number (1~8)
09 10
Red On: On mode Slow Blink (Red): Forwarding State Rapid Blink (Red): Forwarded State Slow Blink (Red): Forwarding State Rapid Blink (Red): Forwarded State Slow Blink (Red): Forwarding State Rapid Blink (Red): Forwarded State Slow Blink (Red): Forwarding State Rapid Blink (Red): Forwarded State Slow Blink (Red): Forwarding State Rapid Blink (Red): Forwarded State Slow Blink (Red): Forwarding State Rapid Blink (Red): Forwarded State
11
12
13
14
15
Follow Me
16 17 18
--- Not Used ----- Not Used --Text Message Setup Message Numbers (01~20)
2 - 298
Document Revision 1
20 21
External All Call Paging Internal Group Paging Internal Paging Number (01~64)
22 23 24 25 26 27
Internal All Call Paging Meet-Me Answer to Internal Paging Call Pickup Call Pickup for Another Group Call Pickup for Specified Group Speed Dial System/ Private Speed Dial - Group Repeat Redial Call Pickup Group Number Speed Dial Number (Speed/Private) Speed Dial Number (Group)
None None
28 29
None
30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38
Saved Number Redial Memo Dial Meet Me Conference Override (Off-Hook Signaling) Barge-In Camp On Step Call DND/FWD Override Call Message Waiting
2 - 299
Document Revision 1
Rapid Blink (Red): Under Monitored Slow Blink (Red): Under Monitoring
With Room Monitor there are two parties in the monitor, one being monitored and one who is monitoring. The same key is used on both phones, but the COS says if the key is set to be either a monitored or monitoring party.
40 41
Red On: Transmission cut-off Red On: Transmission Side Rapid Blink (Red): Receiver Side Red On: Boss Secretary Mode
None None None
42 43 44 45 46 47
Boss Secretary Call Pickup Series Call Common Hold Exclusive Hold Department Group Log Out Reverse Voice Over
Extension Number
Red On: Extension Busy Off: Extension Idle Rapid Blink (Red): DND or Call
Forward
48
Voice Over
Red On: Relay On Red On: Under Setting Red On: Active Red On: Active
2 - 300
Document Revision 1
69
70 71 72 73 74
Automated Attendant for Extension Message Change for Voice Attendant Keypad Facility Key Keypad Hold Key Keypad Retrieve Key
2 - 301
Document Revision 1
Red On: Access to Voice Mail Rapid Blink (Green): New Message Rapid Blink (Red): Recording
78
Conversation Recording
79
Red On: Set Up for All Calls Slow Blink (Red): Set Up for Busy/No
Answer Calls
80
Tandem Ringing
0 = Cancel 1 = Set Extension Number to Tandem Ring Trunk Line Number 001~200
81 82 83
Automatic Transfer to Transfer Key Dterm IP Call Log Conversation Recording Function
Function Number List [2] Appearance Function Level ( 00 - 99) (Service Code 752)
Function Number 00 01 02 Function --- Not Used --Trunk Key Trunk Group/Loop Key Trunk Number (1~8 or 001~200) Trunk Group Number (1~8 or 001~100) Extension Number or Department Group Number Additional Data
03
2 - 302
LED Indication
, , , ,
Document Revision 1
Function Number List (Continued) [2] Appearance Function Level ( 00 - 99) (Service Code 752)
04 05 06 07 08 10 Park Key --- Not Used --Trunk Access Via Networking Station Park Hold None CAP Key -- CAP Orbit No. (01-64) ACD Log-In/Log-Out Network System Number (01~50) Park Number (01~64)
11
12
13
14 15 16 17
ACD Start / End ACD Monitor Mode ACD Standby Mode ACD Wrap-Up Mode
18
19
Default
The DSS keys 01~60 of all DSS consoles = DSS/One-Touch key 101~160.
Conditions None
, , , , , , , , , , , , , ,
Red On: ACD Operation End Red On: Under Monitor Red On: Standby Red On: Under work time Slow Blink (Red): Under
Reservation
2 - 303
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 32-05 : DSS Console Lamp Table to define the LED patterns for functions on the DSS consoles.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
--- Not Used --Busy Extension DND Extension ACD Agent Busy Out of Schedule (ACD DSS) ACD Agent Log Out (ACD DSS) ACD Agent Log In (ACD DSS) ACD Agent Emergency (ACD DSS) Hotel Status Code 1 (Hotel DSS) Hotel Status Code 2 (Hotel DSS) Hotel Status Code 3 (Hotel DSS) Hotel Status Code 4 (Hotel DSS) Hotel Status Code 5 (Hotel DSS) Hotel Status Code 6 (Hotel DSS) Hotel Status Code 7 (Hotel DSS) Hotel Status Code 8 (Hotel DSS) Hotel Status Code 9 (Hotel DSS) Hotel Status Code 0 (Hotel DSS) Hotel Status Code * (Hotel DSS) Hotel Status Code # (Hotel DSS)
Item
Default
0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7 0~7
7 (On) 3 (RW) 7 (On) 0 (Off) 5 (IL) 4 (IR) 6 (IW) 7 (On) 1 (FL) 2 (WK) 3 (RW) 5 (IL) 3 (RW) 6 (IW) 4 (IR) 3 (RW) 0 (Off) 4 (IR) 5 (IL)
2 - 304
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 21 Item
VM Message Indication
Default 3 (RW)
2 - 305
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 306
Description
Use Program 31-01 : System Options for Internal/External Paging to define the system options for Internal/External Paging. The system shows the names you program on the telephone displays. Use the following chart when entering and editing text. When using the keypad digits, press the key once for the first character, twice for the second character, etc. For example, to enter a C, press key 2 three times. Press the key six times to display the lower case letter.
Key for Entering Names When entering names in the procedures below, refer to this chart. Names can be up to 12 digits long. Use this keypad digit . . . 1 When you want to. . . Enter characters: 1 @ [ ] ^ _ ` { | } Enter characters A-C, a-c, 2. Enter characters D-F, d-f, 3. Enter characters G-I, g-i, 4. Enter characters J-L, j-l, 5. Enter characters M-O, m-o, 6. Enter characters P-S, p-s, 7. Enter characters T-V, t-v, 8. Enter characters W-Z, w-z, 9. Enter characters: 0 ! # $ Enter characters: + , - . /
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0
% :
& ;
<
( =
) > ?
2 - 307
margorP
31
E B
Document Revision 1
Key for Entering Names (Continued) When entering names in the procedures below, refer to this chart. Names can be up to 12 digits long. Use this keypad digit . . . # When you want to. . . # = Accepts an entry (only required if two letters on the same key are needed - ex: TOM). Pressing # again = Space. (In system programming mode, use the right arrow soft key instead to accept and/or add a space.) Clear the character entry one character at a time. Clear all the entries from the point of the flashing cursor and to the right.
CONF HOLD
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
All Call Paging Zone Name
Description
Assign a name to each All Call Internal Paging zone. The name shows on the display of the telephone making the announcement. This timer sets the maximum length of Page announcements. Once the user initiates a Meet-Me Conference or Voice Call Conference, the system waits this interval for the Paged party to join the call.
02
1200
04
90
Conditions None
2 - 308
J J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 31-02 : Internal Paging Group Assignment to assign extensions to Internal Paging Groups (i.e., Page Zones). The setting in this program also determines if the Internal Page Group can receive Internal All Call Paging. The system can have up to 64 paging groups. An extension can be in only one Internal Paging Group.
Input Data
Extension Number Maximum 8 digits
Item No. 01
Item
Internal Paging Group Number Assign extensions to Internal Paging Groups (i.e., Page Zones). The system allows up to 64 Internal Paging Groups. An extension can be in only one Internal Paging Group.
02
Internal All Call Paging Receiving Allow or prevent All Call Internal Paging for each extension. If allowed, extension can place and receive All Call Internal Paging announcements. If prevented, extensions can only make (not receive) All Call Internal Paging announcements. If combined, Paging zones should be restricted as well, change the internal page zone group in Program 31-07-01 to 0.
0 = Off 1 = On
Conditions None
2 - 309
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 31-03 : Internal Paging Group Settings to assign names to Internal Paging Groups (i.e., Page Zones) and to define the splash tone for Internal Paging. The system shows the names you program on the telephone displays. Use the following chart when entering and editing text. When using the keypad digits, press the key once for the first character, twice for the second character, etc. For example, to enter a C, press key 2 three times. Press the key six times display the lower case letter.
Key for Entering Names When entering names in the procedures below, refer to this chart. Names can be up to 12 digits long. Use this keypad digit . . . 1 When you want to. . . Enter characters: 1 @ [ ] ^ _ ` { | } Enter characters A-C, a-c, 2. Enter characters D-F, d-f, 3. Enter characters G-I, g-i, 4. Enter characters J-L, j-l, 5. Enter characters M-O, m-o, 6. Enter characters P-S, p-s, 7. Enter characters T-V, t-v, 8. Enter characters W-Z, w-z, 9. Enter characters: 0 ! # $ Enter characters: + , - .
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0
&
( <
) = > ?
2 - 310
E B
Document Revision 1
Key for Entering Names When entering names in the procedures below, refer to this chart. Names can be up to 12 digits long. Use this keypad digit . . . # When you want to. . . # = Accepts an entry (only required if two letters on the same key are needed - ex: TOM). Pressing # again = Space. (In system programming mode, use the right arrow soft key instead to accept and/or add a space.) Clear the character entry one character at a time. Clear all the entries from the point of the flashing cursor and to the right.
CONF HOLD
Input Data
Internal Paging Group Number 01~64
Item No. 01
Item
Internal Paging Group Name
Input Data
Up to 12 Characters
Description
Assign names to Internal Paging Groups (i.e., Page Zones). The system shows the names you program on the telephone displays. Allow an extension to have normal (0), muted (1) or no (2) Internal Paging alert beeps before a Paging announcement.
02
2 - 311
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 312
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 31-04 : External Paging Zone Group to assign each External Paging zone to an External Paging group. Users call the External Paging group when broadcasting announcements to the external zone. When programming, the zones on the PGD(2)-U10 adapter are numbers 1~8. On the Electra Elite IPK II system, the CPUIIs zone is number 9. To simplify programming and troubleshooting, always make the External Paging Zone Group the same number as the External Paging zone (i.e., 1 = 1, 2 = 2, etc.).
Input Data
External Speaker Number 1~9
Item No. 01
Default Speaker 1 [PGD(2)-U10] = 1 (Group 1) Speaker 2 [PGD(2)-U10] = 2 (Group 2) Speaker 3 [PGD(2)-U10] = 3 (Group 3) Speaker 4 [PGD(2)-U10] = 4 (Group 4) Speaker 5 [PGD(2)-U10] = 5 (Group 5) Speaker 6 [PGD(2)-U10] = 6 (Group 6) Speaker 7 [PGD(2)-U10] = 7 (Group 7) Speaker 8 [PGD(2)-U10] = 8 (Group 8) Speaker 9 (CPUII) = 1 (Group 1)
Conditions None
2 - 313
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 31-05 : Universal Night Answer to assign Universal Night Answer ringing to each External Paging zone. For each trunk port, make a separate entry for each External Paging zone. When programming, the zones on the PGD(2)-U10 ADP adapter are numbers 1~8. The CPUII zone is number 9. For UNA ringing, make a separate entry for each Night Service mode.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number External Speaker Number 1~200 1~9
Item No. 01
Input Data
= No Ringing (No) = Ringing (Yes)
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 314
J J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 31-06 : External Speaker Control to define the settings for the external speaker using an amplifier.
Input Data
External Speaker Number 1~9
Item No. 01
Item
Broadcast Splash Tone Before Paging (Paging Start Tone) Use this option to enabled or disable splash tone before Paging over an external zone. If enabled, the system broadcasts a splash tone before the External Paging announcement.
Input Data
0 1 2 = No Tone (None) = Splash Tone = Chime Tone
Default 2
02
Broadcast Splash Tone After Paging (Paging End Time) Use this option to enabled or disable splash tone after Paging over an external zone. If enabled, the system broadcasts a splash tone at the end of an External Paging announcement.
0 1 2
03
Speech Path Determine if the external speaker will be used for talkback (As this option is not available with the CPUII external page zone, speaker 9 should be left at 1.
0 1
04 05
32 32
2 - 315
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 316
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 31-07 : Combined Paging Assignments to assign an External Paging Group (0~8) to an Internal Paging Zone (0~64) for Combined Paging. When an extension user makes a Combined Page, they simultaneously broadcast into both the External and Internal Zone. Use Program 31-04-01 to assign an External Paging Zone (1~9) to an External Page Group (1~8).
Input Data
External Paging Group Number 0~8 (0 = All External Paging)
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions None
J J
2 - 317
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 31-08 : BGM on External Paging to set the Background Music option for each External Paging zone. If enabled, the system will play Background Music over the zone when it is idle. When programming, the zones on the PGD(2)-U10 ADP adapter are numbers 1~8. The CPUII zone is number 9.
Input Data
External Speaker Number 1~9
Item No. 01
Item
BGM
Item
Use this option to allow or prevent the External Paging zone you select from broadcasting Background Music when it is idle.
Input Data
0 1 = Disable (No) = Enable (Yes)
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 318
J J
Description
Use Program 32-01 : Door Box Timers to assign the timers used for the Door Box.
The Door Box feature is referred to as Door Phone when programming via Web Pro and using a Multiline Terminal.
Input Data
Item No. 01
Door Box Answer Time A multiline user must answer Door Box chimes within this interval.
Item
Default 30
02
Door Lock Cancel Time When a single line (2500 type) telephone user hook flashes or a multiline user presses the Recall key while talking to a Door Box, the strike stays open for this interval.
0~64800
10
03
Off-Premise Call Forward by Door Box Disconnect Timer Define the conversation period for an Off-Premise Call Forward by Door Box call. When this timer expires, the caller will hear busy tone for 3 seconds (fixed timer) and the call will then be disconnected.
0~64800
60
Conditions None
2 - 319
margorP
J
32
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 32-02 : Door Box Ring Assignments to assign the extension which will ring when a caller presses the associated Door Box call button.
2 - 320
J
The Door Box feature is referred to as Door Phone when programming via Web Pro and using a Multiline Terminal.
Input Data
Door Box Number Day/Night Mode 1~8 1~8
Item No. 01
Default No Setting
Conditions None
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 32-03 : Door Box Basic Setup to select the chime pattern and gain level for each Door Box. There are six distinctive chime patterns. The chime tones are defined in Program 80-01.
Input Data
Door Box Number 1~8
J
The Door Box feature is referred to as Door Phone when programming via Web Pro and using a Multiline Terminal.
Item No. 01
Item
Chime Pattern
Input Data
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 = = = = = = = None Door Box Ring Door Box Ring Door Box Ring Door Box Ring Door Box Ring Door Box Ring
Default
Door Box 1 = 1 Door Box 2 = 2 Door Box 3 = 3 Door Box 4 = 4 Door Box 5 = 5 Door Box 6 = 6 Door Box 7 = 1 Door Box 8 = 1
1 2 3 4 5 6
02
32
03
32
Conditions None
2 - 321
Document Revision 1
2 - 322
Description
Input Data
ACI Port Number 01~96
Item No. 01
0 1 2
ACI Type
= None = MOH/BGM (Input) = External Audio Port (Input/ Output)
Default 2
Conditions None
2 - 323
margorP
Use Program 33-01 : ACI Port Type Setup to set the function of each software port on an Analog Communications Interface. Each ACI software port can have only one function (input, output or none).
33
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 33-02 : ACI Department Calling Group to assign ACI ports to Department Groups. An ACI port can only be in one group. Also use this program to set the ACI ports priority. When a call comes into the ACI Department Group, it connects to the ACI port in order of their priority. A higher priority port (e.g., 1) receives calls before a lower priority port (e.g., 6). There are 96 ACI ports and 16 ACI Department Groups available.
Input Data
ACI Port Number 01~96
Item No. 01
Priority 1~96
Default
ACI Port 01 02 : 96 Group 1 1 : 1 Priority 1 2 : 96
Conditions None
2 - 324
Description
Use Program 34-01 : E&M Tie Line Basic Setup to defines the basic settings for each E&M Tie line.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Item
DID/E&M Start Signaling
0 1 2 3 = = = =
Input Data
2nd dial tone Wink Immediate Delay
Default 1
Description
Set the start signaling mode for DID and tie trunks. DID and tie trunks can use either immediate start or wink start signaling.
02 03
Determine if the incoming Tie Line call should be directed as an intercom call or if it should follow the DID Translation Table in Program 22-11. Enter 1 if the Tie Line should send dial tone to the calling system once the call is set up. Enter 0 if the Tie Line should not send dial tone. Determine if an incoming Tie Line call should be subject to Toll Restriction.
22-11
04
0 1
05
0 1
= No = Yes
2 - 325
margorP
34
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 326
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 34-02 : E&M Tie Line Class of Service to assign a Class of Service to a Tie line (there are 15 Tie line Classes of Service). The Class of Service options are defined in Program 20-14. For each Tie line, make a separate entry for each Night Service mode.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 1~200
Item No. 01
Class 1~15
Default 1
Conditions
2 - 327
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 34-03 : Trunk Group Routing for E&M Tie Lines to assign the trunk group route 1~8 or 1~100) chosen when a user seizes a Tie Line and dials 9. (Set Trunk Group Routing in Program 14-07.) If the system has Automatic Route Selection, dialing 9 accesses ARS. Make a separate entry for each Tie Line - for each Night Service Mode.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions None
2 - 328
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 34-04 : E&M Tie Line Toll Restriction Class to enter a Toll Restriction Class for each Tie Line. There are 15 Toll Restriction Classes which are defined in Programs 21-05 and 21-06. For each Tie Line, you make a separate Toll Restriction Class entry for each Night Service mode.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Default 2
Conditions
2 - 329
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 34-05 : Tie Line Outgoing Call Restriction to build a restriction matrix for outgoing trunk calls placed from an inbound trunk (e.g., dialed from a Tie Line). For each inbound trunk group, enable or disable access to each CO trunk group.
Input Data
Incoming Trunk Group Number 001~100
Input Data
= Enable (Y-Tandem) = Disable (N-Tandem)
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 330
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 34-06 : Add / Delete Digit for E&M Tie Line to set digits that the system should add or delete for Tie Lines.
Delete Digit Some Tie Line networks pass the location number and extension number to the remote side. This program allows the system to ignore such numbers for a call.
J J J
If individual extensions do not want to receive an incoming call, you could delete all of the digits including the extension number.
Add Digit If a Tie Line network requires additional digits to reroute the call to a location, the digits for the location can be added to the received digits.
Input Data
Incoming Trunk Group Number 001~100
Item No. 01 02
Item
Delete Digit
Default 0 No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 331
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 34-07 : E&M Tie Line Timer to define the system service tone timers.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05
Item
ODT/SRT Mark Method ODT/SRT Wink Start Method 1st Digit Pause (LDT) Leased Line Guard (LDT) Trunk Answer Detect Timer for E&M / E1
Default 3 0 3 0 30
Conditions None
2 - 332
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 34-08 : Toll Restriction Data for E&M Tie Lines to define the toll restriction data for E&M Tie Lines. This data should be defined if Tie Line Toll Restriction is enabled in Program 21-05-13.
Input Data
Class of Service 01~15
Item No. 01
Default No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 333
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 34-09 : ANI/DNIS Service Options to define the ANI//DNIS service option setup for E&M Class of Service.
Input Data
Class of Service 01~15
Item No. 01
Receive Format
COS 15 0
This option defines the character Telco uses as a delimiter (see entries 1~5 in Item 1
03
Route Setup of Receive Dial This option specifies the source of the data the system uses to route incoming ANI/DNIS calls. If option 2 is selected, refer to Program 34-09-04.
2 - 334
0 = Fixed Route (Item08) (No Routing) 1 = Routes on Received DNIS or Address Data 2 = Routes on Received ANI Data
02
1~9, 0, , #
,
34-09-01 0 22-09-01 22-11-01 34-09-04 34-09-08
, ,
, ,
, , ,
, ,
Use this option to specify the format of the ANI/DNIS data received from the telco. Make sure your entry is compatible with the service the telco provides. (The character indicates a delimiter.)
Document Revision 1
Item No. 04
COS 15 0
0 1
05
ANI/DNIS Display as Target Dial Name Use this option to set if ANI data should appear on telephone displays as part of Caller ID display.
06
Routing SPD Table Setup Use this option to define which part of the ABB Table set up in Program 13-04 the system will use for ANI/DNIS Caller ID look-ups and ANI/ DNIS routing. This is required if Items 4 and 5 above are 1 (Caller ID on). When you specify a starting and end address, the system uses the part of the table for look-ups. When you specify a starting address and length, the system uses that part of the table for routing. If the incoming ANI/DNIS number data matches the Number entry in the table, the system routes according to the associated Name data. That data can be an extension, Department Group pilot number, the voice mail master number or a trunk ring group.
07
Routing on ANI/DNIS Error This option lets you determine how the system will handle an ANI/DNIS call if a data error is detected in the incoming data string.
0 1
Start = 0 End = 0
0 1
= Play Busy Tone to Caller = Route Caller to Ring Group Specified in Program 25-03 (Transfer)
25-03
2 - 335
Document Revision 1
Item No. 08
COS 15 0
= Play Busy or Ringback Tone to Caller (Busy/ NoAns) = Route Caller to Ring Group Specified in Program 25-04 (Transfer)
09
Calling Number Address Length When Item 1=0 (ANI/DNIS receive format is address), use this option to specify the address length. The choices are from 1 to 8 digits in length.
1~8
34-09-01
Conditions None
2 - 336
J J
Description
Input Data
SMDR Port Number 1~8
Item No. 01
Output Port Type
Item
0= 1= 3= 4=
Input Data
None COM (CPUII) LAN CTA/CTU
Default 0
This option specifies the type of connection used for SMDR. The baud rate for the COM port should be set in Program 10-21-02 or 15-02-19.
02
Output Destination Number This option specifies the SMDR printer output extension (CTA/CTU extension number).
Up to 8 digits
No Setting
03
Header Language Specify the language in which the SMDR header should be printed.
0 1 2 3 4
= = = = =
04
Omit Digits The number of digits entered in this option do not print on the SMDR report. For example, if the entry is 10, the first 10 digits a user dials do not appear on the SMDR report.
05
Minimum Digits Outgoing calls must be at least this number of digits for inclusion in the SMDR report.
06
Minimum Call Duration The duration of the call must be at least this interval to be included on the SMDR report.
3 - 337
margorP
Use Program 35-01 : SMDR Options to set the SMDR (Station Message Detail Recording) options for each of the eight SMDR ports. Refer to the following chart for a description of each option, its range and default setting.
35
Document Revision 1
Item No. 07
Item
Minimum Ring Time A call must ring for at least this interval to be included on the SMDR report.
Default 0
08
Format Selection
Conditions None
3 - 338
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 35-02 : SMDR Output Options to set the SMDR (Station Message Detail Recording) output options for each of the eight SMDR ports. Refer to the following chart for a description of each option, its range and default setting.
Input Data
SMDR Port Number 1~8
Item No. 01
Toll Restricted Call
Item
0 1 0 1
Input Data
= Not Displayed = Displayed = Not Displayed = Displayed
Default 1
02
PBX Calls When the system is behind a PBX, SMDR can include all calls or just calls dialed using the PBX trunk access code.
03
Trunk Number or Name Select whether the system should display the trunk name (0) or the number (1) on SMDR reports.
0 1
= Name = Number
04
05
06
Summary (Daily) Set this option to (1) to have the SMDR report provide a daily summary (at midnight every night). Summary (Weekly) Set this option to (1) to have the SMDR report provide a weekly summary (every Saturday at midnight). Summary (Monthly) Set this option to (1) to have the SMDR report provide a monthly summary (at midnight on the last day of the month).
0 1
0 1
0 1
3 - 339
Document Revision 1
Item No. 07
Toll Charge Cost
Item
0 1 0 1
Input Data
= Not Displayed = Displayed = Not Displayed = Displayed
Default 1
Set this option to (1) have the SMDR report include toll charges.
08
Incoming Call Enable this option (1) to have the SMDR report include incoming calls. If you disable this option (0), incoming calls will not print.
09
Extension Number or Name Set this option (1) to have the SMDR report include extension numbers. Set this option (0) to have the SMDR report include extension names.
0 1
= Name = Number
10
All Lines Busy (ALB) Output Determine if the All Lines Busy (ALB) indication should be displayed.
0 1 0 1 0 1
11 12
1 0
DID Table Name Output Determine if the DID table name should be displayed.
13
CLI Output When DID to Trunk Determine if the CLI output should be displayed for DID.
14
This option must be set to 0 if the trunk name is set to be displayed in Program 35-02-03.
15
16
17
3 - 340
CLI / DID Number Switching Determine if the CLI/DID Number Switching should be displayed. Trunk Name or Received Dialed Number Determine how the SMDR should print incoming calls on ANI/DNIS or DID trunks. If set to (1), ANI/DNIS trunks can print DNIS digits. If set to (0) trunk names are printed instead. Print Account Code or Caller Name of Incoming Call Determine if SMDR should print Account Code or Caller Name of Incoming Call.
0 1 0 1
= CLI (CLIP) = DID Calling Number = Trunk Port Name = Received Dialed Number = ACC = CNAME
0 1
Document Revision 1
Item No. 18
Item
Print Mode for Caller Name of Incoming Call Determine how SMDR should print Caller Name of Incoming Call.
Input Data
0 1 = Normal = Line Feed
Default 0
Conditions None
3 - 341
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 35-03 : SMDR Port Assignment for Trunk Group to assign the SMDR port for each trunk group. For each Trunk Group, select the SMDR port to which the incoming SMDR information should be sent.
Input Data
Trunk Group Number 1~100
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions None
3 - 342
J J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 35-04 : SMDR Port Assignment for Department Groups to assign the SMDR port for each Department Group. For each Department Group, select the SMDR port to which the outgoing SMDR information should be sent.
J
Input Data
Department Group Number 01~64
Item No. 01
Default 1
Conditions None
3 - 343
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 35-01 : Account Code Setup to set various Account Code options for an extensions Class of Service. Assign a Class of Service to extensions in Program 20-06.
Input Data
Class of Service Number 01~15
Item No. 01
Item
Account Code Mode Use this option to select the Account Code Mode (0~3).
Input Data
0 1 2 3 = Account Codes Disabled (None) = Account Codes optional = Account Codes Required but not verified (No verify) = Account Codes Required and Verified (Verify) = Account Codes for toll and local calls (All) = Account Codes just for toll calls (STD) = Account Codes for incoming calls disabled (No) = Account Codes for incoming calls enabled (Yes) = Account Codes displayed = Account Codes not displayed
Default 0
02
Forced Account Code Toll Call Setup Use this option enable Account Codes for all calls or just toll calls (for mode 2 or 3 in Item 01 above).
0 1
03
Account Codes for Incoming Calls Use this option to allow users to enter Account Codes for incoming calls. If disabled, any codes entered dial out on the connected trunk.
0 1
04
Hiding Account Codes Use this option to either hide or show the Account codes on a telephones display.
0 1
3 - 344
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
3 - 345
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 35-06 : Verified Account Code Table to enter Account Codes into the Verified Account Code list. You can enter up to 2000 codes from 3~6 digits long, using the characters 0~9 or #. Use the LK1 to enter a wild card. For example, the entry FLASH234 means the user can enter 0234-9234.
Input Data
Verified Account Code Bin Number 1~2000
Item No. 01
Default No Setting
Conditions None
3 - 346
Description
Use Program 40-01 : Voice Mail Basic Setup to define the basic operation of Voice Mail (DSPII-U10 Unit).
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Exclusive Channel for Voice Mail
Default 0
Description
Specify the number of channels of DSPII-U10 Unit which voice mail occupies.
02 03
Time Stamp
0 1 0 1
= Disable (Off) = Enable (On) = Not Continue (No) = Continue (Yes) = Disable (Off) = Enable (On)
1 1
Specify whether recording should continue after a hold transfer when recording a conversation.
04
0 1
05
0000
06 07
0 0
2 - 347
margorP
40
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 348
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 40-02 : Mailbox Setup to define the mailbox of the Voice Mail (DSPII-U10 Unit). There are a maximum of 300 mailboxes in the DSPII-U10 Unit. Use this program to set the box number and password linked to the extension number (or pilot number) for each mailbox.
Input Data
DSPII-U10 Message Box Number 01~300
Item No. 01
Item
Mailbox Number
Default No Setting
Description A mailbox number should use the same number of an extension. If not required, leave this option empty.
02
Mailbox Password
Dial (4 digits)
No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 349
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 40-03 : Message Recording Setup to define the auto-answering operation of the Voice Mail (DSPII-U10 Unit).
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 Item
Voice Mail Recording Time Guidance Message in Case Recording not Allowed Response Message Automatically Sent out when Busy
Input Data
1 to 10 minutes 0 1 0 1 = Fixed Guidance Message = Answer Message of Mailbox = Disable (No) = Enable (Yes)
Default 1 0 0
Conditions None
2 - 350
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 40-04 : Live Recording Setup to define the conversation recording operation of the Voice Mail (DSPII-U10 Unit).
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Operation Mode when Destination not Defined
Input Data
0 1 = Temporary Mailbox (Set) = Callback Operation
Default 1
Description
02 03
0 0
Set up the temporary mailbox number. Enables or disables the systems ability to display recording status when the recording feature is active. Specify the recall destination when a transfer destination is not found.
04
Callback
= Starting Extension of Conversation Recording (Start) = Last Extension of Conversation Recording (Last)
Conditions None
2 - 351
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 40-05 : Call Information Setup to define the incoming notice of the Voice Mail (DSPII-U10 Unit).
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 Item
Maximum Number of Outgoing Call Simultaneously Trunk Route Number ISDN Calling Party Number
Input Data 0~16 0~100 1~0, , # (maximum 16 digits) 1~30 minutes 1~30 minutes 1~100 1~100
Default 1 1 No Setting
04 05 06 07
Call Interval for Intercom Call Call Interval for External Call Maximum Number of Intercom Call Maximum Number of External Call
Conditions None
2 - 352
10 10 3 3
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 40-06 : Voice Mail Automated Attendant Data Setup to define the outside lines to use the automated attendant recording operation of the Voice Mail (DSPII-U10 Unit).
Input Data
Trunk Port Number Day/Night Mode 1~200 1~8
Item No. 01 02 03
Item
Operation Mode
Input Data
0 1 = Automated Attendant = Not Used
Default 0 0 0
0~48 0~300
Conditions None
2 - 353
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 40-07 : Voice Prompt Language Assignment for VRS to specify the language to be used for the VRS prompts.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item Voice Prompt Language Assignment for VRS
0 1 2 3
Input Data
= = = = Japanese English German Norwegian
Default 1
Conditions None
2 - 354
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 40-08 : Voice Prompt Language Assignment for Mailboxes to select the language to be used for the mailboxes.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Voice Prompt Language Assignment for Mailboxes
Input Data
0 1 2 3 = = = = Japanese English German Norwegian
Default 1
Conditions None
2 - 355
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 40-09 : Voice Mail Multiple Address Group Setup to define the broadcast group of a Voice Mail (DSPII-U10 Unit) mailbox.
Input Data
Multiple Address Group Number 1~10
Item No. 01
Default No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 356
Document Revision 1
Description
In Program 40-10 : Voice Announcement Service Option define the system options for the Voice Announcement feature.
Input Data
Item No. 01
VRS Fixed Message Enable (1) or disable (0) the systems ability to play the fixed VRS messages (such as You have a message.).
Item
Input Data
0= Not Used 1= Used
Default 0
02
General Message Number This item assigns the VRS message number to be used as the General Message.
0~48 (0=No General Message Service) 0~100 (Incoming Ring Group Number)
03
VRS No Answer Destination This item assigns the transferred Ring Group when the VRS is unanswered after Call Forwarding with Personal Greeting Message.
0 (No Setting)
04
VRS No Answer Time If an extension has Personal Greeting enabled and all VRS ports are busy, a DIL or DISA call to the extension will wait this interval for a VRS port to become free.
0~64800 sec.
05
Park and Page Repeat Timer (VRS Msg Resend) If a Park and Page is not picked up within this interval, the Paging announcement repeats.
0~64800 sec.
06
Set VRS Message for Private Call Refuse (VRS Msg Private Call) This item assigns the VRS Message number to be used as Private Call Refuse. When Fixed message is set, VRS message guidance is: Service finished. Disconnect the line, please.
2 - 357
Document Revision 1
Input Data
07
Set VRS Message for Caller ID Refuse (VRS Msg CID) This item assigns the VRS Message number to be used as Caller ID Refuse. When Fixed Message is set, VRS message guidance is: Service finished. Disconnect the line, please.
Conditions None
2 - 358
Document Revision 1
Description
In Program 40-11 : Pre-Amble Message Assignment to assign the VRS message number to be used as the Pre-amble Message for each trunk. When the extension user answers the incoming call, the assigned VAU message will be sent to the outside caller.
Input Data
Trunk Port Number 001~200
Item No. 01
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 359
Document Revision 1
2 - 360
Description
In Program 41-01 : System Options for ACD define the system options for the ACD feature.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04 Item
System Supervisory Extension Login ID Code Digit
Default No Setting 0 0
Description
Conditions None
2 - 361
margorP
41
Document Revision 1
Description
In Program 41-02 : ACD Group and Agent Assignments, for each ACD extension number, assign an ACD Group (1~64). An ACD Group number is assigned to each Work Period number (1~8). The assigned extension will work as an ACD agent extension in the following cases:
The trunk belonging to an ACD group receives an incoming call while an ACD agent is logged in. An extension calls or transfers a call to an ACD group using the ACD group pilot number. An incoming call is received with a DID/DISA number which is assigned as an ACD pilot number.
2 - 362
J J J J
Input Data
Extension Number Up to 8 digits
Item No. 01
Default 0
Conditions None
Document Revision 1
Description
In Program 41-03 : Incoming Ring Group Assignments for ACD Group, for each incoming trunk group set up in Program 22-05, designate into which ACD Group (1~64) the trunks should ring for each of the eight Work Periods. Also use this program to assign an Incoming Trunk Ring Group as priority or normal. Use Program 41-05 and 41-06 to set up the Work Schedules and Work Periods for trunks. Use Program 41-07 to assign the Work Schedules to the days of the week.
Input Data
Incoming Ring Group Number ACD Work Period Mode Number 1~100 1~8
Item No. 01 02 03
Item
ACD Group Number Night Announcement Service
Default 0 0 0
Priority Determine whether an incoming call to a trunk ring group should follow a priority assignment. 0 = Normal 1~7: 1 = Lowest Priority 7 = Highest Priority
2 - 363
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 364
J J
Document Revision 1
Description
For each ACD Group (1~64), use Program 41-04 : ACD Group Supervisor to assign the groups supervisor extension and operating mode. Operating modes are:
0 = Supervisors extension does not receive ACD Group calls. 1 = Supervisors extension receives ACD Group overflow calls only. 2 = Supervisors extension receives ACD Group calls just like all other agents.
J J J J
An ACD Group can have only one supervisor. In addition, an extension can be a supervisor for only one ACD Group.
Input Data
ACD Group No. 01~64
Item No. 01 02
Item
Group Supervisor Extension Operation Type
Input Data
Extension Number (Up to 8 digits) 0 1 2 = Not receive any ACD incoming calls (No) = Receive ACD incoming calls in case of overflow (Busy) = Receive ACD incoming calls all the time (Yes)
Default No Setting 0
Conditions
If you assign an extension as a ACD Group Supervisor in this program, you cannot program the same extension as a System Supervisor in Program 41-01-01.
2 - 365
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-05 : ACD Agent Work Schedules to set up the Work Schedules for ACD Agents and Groups. For each ACD Work Schedule (1~4), designate the start and stop times for each of the eight Work Periods. Once you set up the schedules in this program, assign them to days of the week in Program 41-07. (This is the same program used by the Trunk Work Schedules.) ACD extensions can log in only during their work period. ACD extensions will receive the following types of calls when they are logged in.
ACD Call on a Trunk When the incoming ring group is assigned in the operating time (Program 41-03 and 41-06) ACD Pilot Number Call Any time - if ACD extensions are available
2 - 366
J J J
Input Data
ACD Work Schedule Time Pattern 1~4
Item No. 01
Conditions None
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-06 : Trunk Work Schedules to set up the Work Schedules for trunks. For each Work Schedule (1~4), designate the start and stop times for each of the eight Work Periods. Once you set up the schedules, assign them to days of the week in Program 41-07. (This is the same program used by the ACD Agent Work Schedules.)
Input Data
ACD Work Schedule Time Pattern Number 1~4
Item No. 01
Conditions None
2 - 367
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-07 : ACD Weekly Schedule Setup to assign the four Work Schedules (1~4) to days of the week. The assignments you make in this program apply to both the ACD Agent Work Schedules (Program 41-05) and the Trunk Work Schedules (Program 41-06).
Item No. 01
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Day Number
= Sunday = Monday = Tuesday = Wednesday = Thursday = Friday = Saturday
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 368
Document Revision 1
Description
For each ACD Group (1~64), use Program 41-08 : ACD Overflow Options to assign the overflow mode (0~9), destination and announcement message types. Delay announcement functions are not available for ACD pilot number call. Each ACD Group can have unique overflow options. The table below outlines the entry options.
Input Data
ACD Group No. 01~64
Item No. 01
Item
Overflow Operation Mode
Input Data
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 = = = = = = = = = = No overflow (None) Overflow with No Announcement No Overflow with First Announcement Only No Overflow with First & Second Announcements Overflow with First Announcement Only Overflow with First & Second Announcement --- Not Used ----- Not Used --No Overflow with Second Announcement Only Overflow with Second Announcement Only
Default 0
02
0 = No Setting 1~64= ACD Group 65 = Overflow Table (Program 41-09) 66 = Voice Mail Integration 67 = System Speed (Program 41-08-05) 68 = Incoming Ring Group (Program 41-08-06) 0 1 = ACI = VRS
03
Delay Announcement Source Type ACD Overflow Transfer Time System Speed Dial Bin (Used when 41-08-02 is set to 67)
04 05
30 1999
2 - 369
Document Revision 1
06
1~100
Conditions
Delay announcement functions are not available for ACD pilot number call.
2 - 370
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-09 : ACD Overflow Table Setting to define the ACD group to which a call will be transferred when overflow occurs.
Input Data
ACD Group No. 01~64
Item No. 01
Transfer ACD Group Number With Overflow 0~65 0 = No Setting 65 = In-Skin Voice Mail Integration
Default 0
Conditions
If, while the call is ringing, the extension to which the call was transferred becomes available, both the extension and the overflow ACD group will ring.
2 - 371
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-10 : ACI Delay Announcement to define the ACI port number to be used for the delay announcement. This program is activated when the delay announcement source and options are assigned as ACI in Program 41-08-03.
Input Data
ACD Group No 01~64
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05
Item
1st Delay Announcement ACI Port Number
Input Data 0~96 0 = No Setting 0~96 0 = No Setting 0~64800 (sec) 0~64800 (sec) 0~64800 (sec)
Default 0 0 4 60 0
1st Delay Announcement Connection Timer 2nd Delay Announcement Connection Timer 2nd Delay Announcement Sending Duration Set the timer for the 2nd Delay announcement. Once this timer expires, the call will disconnect. To keep the call in queue, set this timer to 0.
Conditions None
2 - 372
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-11 : VRS Delay Announcement to assign the VRS message number to be used as the message source for the 1st and 2nd Delay Announcement Messages. Turn to Program 41-08 for more on setting up the ACD overflow options. This program is activated when the delay announcement source and options are assigned as VRS in Program 41-08.
Input Data
ACD Group No. 01~64
Item No. 01 02
Item
Delay Message Start Timer 1st Delay Message Number
Input Data 0~64800 (sec) 0~49 0 = No Message 49 = Fixed Message 0~255 0~49 0 = No Message 49 = Fixed Message 0~255 0 = Ring Back Tone 1 = MOH Tone 2 = BGM Source 0~64800 (sec) 0 = Disable 1 = After 1st (1st) 2 = After 2nd (2nd) 3 = After 1st and 2nd (1st and 2nd)
Default 0 0
03 04
0 0
05 06
0 0
07 08
ACD Forced Disconnect Time After the After 2nd Delay Message Queue Depth Announcement (Requires VRS)
60 0
2 - 373
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 374
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-12 : Night Announcement Setup to define the night announce voice resource and sending time for each ACD group. Night announcement availability depends on the setting in Program 41-03-02. The night announcement function is not available for ACD pilot number calls.
Input Data
ACD Group Number 01~64
Item No. 01 02 03
Item
Night Announcement Source Type
Input Data
0 1 = ACI = VRS
Default 0 0 30
Conditions
The night announcement function is not available for ACD pilot number call.
2 - 375
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-13 : VRS Night Announcement to define the VRS message number to be used as the night announcement. This program is activated when the night announcement source is assigned as VRS in Program 41-12.
Input Data
ACD Group No. 01~64
Item No. 01 02
Item
VRS Message Number
Input Data
0~48 0 = No Message 0 1 2 = Ring Back Tone = MOH Tone = BGM Source
Default 0 0
Conditions None
2 - 376
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-14 : ACD Options to set various options for ACD Groups. When you set an option for an ACD Group, the setting is in force (if applicable) for all agents within the group. The chart below shows each of the ACD options, the entries available, and the default entry.
Input Data
ACD Group No 01~64
Item No. 01
Item
Emergency Call Operation Mode The supervisor must be logged in and have an Emergency Key programmed for this feature. By pressing the key once, the supervisor monitors the call - pressing twice barges in on the call.
Input Data
0 = Call to system supervisory extension when group supervisory extension is busy. = No calls to system supervisory extension when group supervisory extension is busy. = After wrap up mode key is pressed. (Manual) = After call is finished automatically. (Auto) = Own groups priority = Priority order by Program 41-03-03
Default 0
02
0 1
03
ACD Priority for Overflow Calls Determine whether the ACD group should use its own priority assignment or if it should follow the priority assigned in Program 41-03-03.
0 1
04
0 1
= Off = On
05
2 - 377
Document Revision 1
Item No. 06
Item
Call Queuing after 2nd Announcement Use this option to determine whether an outside caller should hear a final announcement [ex: the company is closed] (1) or whether the caller should be placed back into queue for the ACD group (0).
Input Data
0 1 = Enable (Yes) = Disable (No)
Default 0
07
Automatic Off Duty for SLT Enable/disable Automatic Off Duty (rest) mode for agents with SLT phones.
0 1 0 1
= No change to off duty mode = Change to off duty mode automatically (Skip) = Can not receive internal call = Can receive internal call
08 09 10
0 0 10
Automatic Wrap Up End Time ACD No Answer Skip Time Set how long a call into the ACD Group will ring an idle extension before routing to the next agent. This timer must be greater than Program 20-04-03 : Delay Ring Timer for the ACD Call Coverage Key with delayed ringing to work.
11 12
Cancel Headset Ear Piece Ringing (for MLT) Start Headset Ear Piece Ringing (for SLT)
0 0
Conditions None
2 - 378
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-15 : ACD Queue Alarm Information to assign the options for Audible Indication for Log Out / Off Duty mode for each ACD group. These program settings will provide an alarm to the agents, but no Queue Status Display is indicated. Do not use these programs if the alarm options are defined in Program 41-20-01 through 41-20-05.
Feature
Queue Status Display Queue Status Display Time Alarm Alarm Send Time Interval Time of Queue Status Display Class of Service Timing of Alarm and Display Queue Status Program 41-15-02 determines the length/interval of the alarm. --Alarm triggered after the number of calls in Program 41-15-01 is exceeded.
Input Data
ACD Group No. 01~64
Item No. 01 02
Item
Number of Calls in ACD Queue to Activate Alarm Information Interval time of Alarm Information
Default 0 0
2 - 379
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 380
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-16 : ACD Threshold Overflow to define the value of the ACD threshold call overflow and the mode for each ACD group.
Input Data
ACD Group No. 01~64
Item No. 01
Item
Number of Calls in Queue Define the maximum number of calls allowed in the ACD queue before overflow occurs.
Input Data
0~200 (0 = No Limitation)
Default 0
02
Operation Mode for ACD Queue Define how the system should handle calls when the number of calls in queue exceeds the threshold.
0 1 2
= The longest waiting call is transferred = The last waiting call is transferred = Send Busy Tone
Conditions None
2 - 381
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-17 : ACD Login Mode Setup to define the ACD login mode for each extension. If the AIC Login Mode is enabled, set the AIC Login and AIC Logout service codes for the AIC members in Program 11-13-08 and 11-13-09.
Input Data
Extension Number Up to 8 digits
Item No. 01
0 1
Login Mode
= Normal Login Mode = AIC Login Mode
Default 0
Conditions
If set to 1, note that a supervisor can not log in/out an AIC member as they are not normal ACD agents.
2 - 382
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-18 : ACD Agent Identity Code Setup to define the ACD Agent Identity Code Table.
Input Data
AIC Table No. 001~512
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10
Item
ACD Agent Identity Code Default ACD Group Number
Input Data Up to 4 digits 0~64 0 = No Setting 0~64 0 = No Setting 0~64 0 = No Setting 0~64 0 = No Setting 0~64 0 = No Setting 0~64 0 = No Setting 0~64 0 = No Setting 0~64 0 = No Setting 0~64 0 = No Setting
Default No Setting 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
2 - 383
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 41-20 : ACD Queue Display Settings to assign the options for the ACD Queue Status Display feature. This program allows the Queue Status Display, as well as an alarm to sound, when the parameters in this program are met. Program 41-15 can also provide a queue alarm to the agents. The options in Program 41-20 should not be used if 41-15 is set.
Feature
Queue Status Display Queue Status Display Time Alarm Alarm Send Time Interval Time of Queue Status Display Class of Service Timing of Alarm and Display Queue Status Program 41-15-02 determines the length/interval of the alarm. ---
2 - 384
Document Revision 1
Input Data
ACD Group No. 01~64
Item No. 01
Item
Number of Calls in Queue Set the number of calls that can accumulate in the ACD queue before the Queue Status Display (and optional queue alarm) occurs.
Input Data
0 = No Display, 1~200
Default
02
Queue Status Display Time Set how long the Queue Status display remains on the telephones display.
0~64800 (sec)
5 (sec)
03
Queue Status Display Interval Set the interval that refreshes the Queue Status Alarm time in queue display and causes the optional queue alarm to occur on phones active on a call, logged out, or in wrap-up.
0~64800 (sec)
60 (sec)
04
0 1
05
ACD Call Waiting Alarm Hold Time Set how long the Call Waiting Alarm should sound.
0~64800 (sec)
Conditions None
2 - 385
Document Revision 1
2 - 386
Description
Use Program 42-01 : System Options for Hotel/Motel to assign the system options for Hotel/Motel Service.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Answering Message Mode for Wake Up Call (Hotel Mode)
Input Data
0 1 2 = MOH (Hold Time) = VRS Message = VRS Message + Time
Default 0
02
Wake Up Call Message Assignment VRS Message for Wake Up Calls. Youll need to make an entry for this program if you have selected option 2 or 3 in Item 1 above.
0~48 (0 = No Setting)
03 04
0 1 0 1 2
= No Transfer = Transfer to the Operator = Only Confirmation Tone = VRS Message = Time Information and VRS
0 0
05
Conditions None
2 - 387
margorP
42
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 42-02 : Hotel/Motel Telephone Setup to define the basic operation of the Hotel/Motel extensions.
Input Data
Extension Number Up to 8 digits
Item No. 01
Hotel Mode
Item
Input Data
0 = Normal 1 = Hotel
Default 0
If you want an extension to operate in the Hotel/ Motel mode, enter 1. If you want the telephone to operate in the business mode, enter 0.
02
Toll Restriction Class When Check In Assign an extensions Toll Restriction Class when it is checked in. The system has 15 Toll Restriction Classes (1~15). The entry you make in this option affects the telephone in all Night Service modes. (Refer to Programs 21-05 and 21-06 to set up the Toll Restriction dialing options.) When the extension is checked out, it uses the Toll Restriction Class set in Program 21-04.
1~15
Conditions None
2 - 388
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 42-03 : Class of Service Options (Hotel) to set the Hotel/Motel Class of Service (COS) options. Assign Class of Service to extensions in Program 42-02 : Hotel/Motel Telephone Setup. There are 15 Classes of Service. Refer to the following chart for a description of each COS option, its range and default setting. For additional Class of Service options, refer to Programs 20-06 ~ 20-14.
Input Data
Class of Service Number 01~15
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10
Check-In Operation
0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On 0 = Off 1 = On
Check-Out Operation
Restriction Class Changing for Other Extension Room to Room Call Restriction
2 - 389
Document Revision 1
11 12
Enable (1) or disable (0) a single line telephones ability to use Room Monitor. 13
--- Not Used ---
0 = Off 1 = On
Conditions None
2 - 390
J J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 42-04 : Hotel Mode One-Digit Service Codes to set up the Hotel Mode one-digit service codes which are assigned in 42-02-01. For each Department Calling Group (1~64), you enter the destination for each single digit code (1-9, 0, ., #). The destination can be any code up to four digits long, such as an extension number or access code.
Input Data
Department (Extension) Group Number 01~64
Item No. 01
Default No Setting
Conditions
The 1-digit codes you assign in this program wait until the interdigit timer expires before executing.
2 - 391
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 42-05 : Hotel Room Status Printer to set the CTA port to output the Hotel Data (Check-Out sheet, Room Status, etc.) and the output options for the Hotel/Motel feature.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 Item
Output Port Type
Input Data
0 1 = No Setting = CTA
Default 0 No Setting
Up to 8 digits (Extension number which CTA/CTU is equipped) 0 1 0 1 = Not Output = Output = Not Output = Output
03 04
0 0
Check-Out Sheet
Conditions
2 - 392
Description
Use Program 44-01 : System Options for ARS/F-Route to define the system options for the ARS/F-Route feature.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
ARS/F-Route Time Schedule If this option is set to 0, the F-Route table selected is determined only by the digits dialed without any relation to the day or time of the call. If this option is set to 1, the system first refers to Program 44-10. If there is a match, the pattern defined in that program is used. If not, the F-Route pattern in Program 44-09 and time setting in 44-08 are used.
Input Data
0 = Not Used 1 = Used
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 393
margorP
44
J J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 44-02 : Dial Analysis Table for ARS/F-Route Access to set the Pre-Transaction Table for selecting ARS/F-Route.
Input Data
Dial Analysis Table Number 1~120
Item No. 01
Dial
Item
Input Data
Up to 8 digits
(Use line key 1 for a Dont Care digit, @)
Default No Setting
Set the number of digits to be analyzed by the system for ARS routing.
02
Service Type Service Type 1 (Extension Number) The number goes to an extension after deleting the front digit(s). Additional Data Assign the digit(s) to be deleted on top of the number for extension number usage. There must be at least one digit deleted. Service Type 2 (ARS/F-Route) The number is controlled by ARS/F-Route table. Additional Data: If the ARS/F-Route Time Schedule is not used, assign the ARS/F-Route table number for Program 44-05. If the ARS/F-Route Time Schedule is used, assign the ARS/F-Route selection number for Program 44-04. Service Type 3 (Dial Extension Analyze Table) The total length of the number exceeds more than 8 digits. Additional Data: Assign the Dial Extension Analysis Table number to be used in Program 44-03.
0 1 2 3
= No setting (None) = Extension Call (Own) = ARS/F-Route Table (F-Route) = Dial Extension Analyze Table (Option)
2 - 394
H H H
Document Revision 1
Item No. 03
Additional Data
Item
Input Data
1: Delete Digit = 0~255 (255 : Delete All Digits) 2: 0~500 (0 = No Setting) 3: Dial Extension Analyze Table Number = 0~4 (0 = No Setting)
Default 0
For the Service Type selected in 44-02-02, enter the additional data required. 1: Delete Digit = 0~255 (255 = Delete All Digits) 2: [Program 44-01 : 0] ARS/F-Route Table Number = 0~500 (0 = No Setting) Refer to Program 44-05. [Program 44-01 : 1] ARS/F-Route Select Table Number = 0~500 (0 = No Setting) Refer to Program 44-04. 3: Dial Extension Analyze Table Number = 0~4 (0 = No Setting) Refer to Program 44-03.
04
Conditions None
H H H
Dial Tone Simulation If enabled, this option sends dial tone to the calling party once the routing is determined. This may be required if the central office at the destination does not send dial tone.
0 1
= Off = On
2 - 395
Document Revision 1
Description
When Program 44-02-02 is set to type 3, use Program 44-03 : Dial Analysis Extension Table to set the dial extension analysis table. These tables are used when the analyzed digits must be more than 8 digits. If the received digits do not match the digits set in tables 1~250, table number 252 is used refer to the next Extension Table Area (1~4) to be searched. If the received digits are not identified in tables 1~250, the F-Route selection table number defined in table 251 is used.
02
0~500 (ARS/F-Route Table Number) With Program 44-01 set to 0, Program 44-05 is then checked. With Program 44-01 set to 1, Program 44-04 is then checked.
2 - 396
01
The item numbers indicated below are different when using PCPro/WebPro due to the window layout of the applications. Refer to the program within the PCPro/WebPro application to determine the correct item number.
Input Data
Extension Table Area Number Dial Analysis Table Number 1~4 1~252
Item
Input Data Up to 24 digits Digits = 1~9, 0, , #, @ (Press Line Key 1 for wild character @)
Default No Setting
Document Revision 1
Input Data 0~500 (ARS/F-Route Table Number) With Program 44-01 set to 0, Program 44-05 is then checked. With Program 44-01 set to 1, Program 44-04 is then checked.
Default 0
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 397
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 44-04 : ARS/F-Route Selection for Time Schedule to assign each ARS/ F-Route Selection number to an ARS/F-Route table number for each ARS/F-Route time mode. There are 8 time modes for ARS/F-Route Access.
Input Data
ARS/F-Route Selection Number 1~500
Item No. 01
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 398
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 44-05 : ARS/F-Route Table to set the ARS/F-Route table. There are 4 kinds of order. If the higher priority trunk groups are busy, the next order group will be used. If a lower priority route is selected, the caller may be notified with a beep tone.
Input Data
ARS/F-Route Table Number Priority Number 1~500 1~4
Item No. 01
Trunk Group Number
Item
Input Data 0~100, 101~150, 255 0 = No Setting 101~150 = Networking 255 = Extension Call 0~255 (255 = Delete All)
Default 0
Select the trunk group number to be used for the outgoing ARS call.
02
Delete Digits Enter the number of digits to be deleted from the dialed number.
03
Additional Dial Number Table Enter the table number (defined in Program 44-06) for additional digits to be dialed.
0~1000
04
Beep Tone Select whether or not a beep is heard if a lower priority trunk group is used to dial out.
0 = Off 1 = On
05
Gain Table Number for Internal Calls Select the gain table number to be used for the internal call (defined in Program 44-07).
0~500 0 = No Setting
06
Gain Table Number for Tandem Connections Select the gain table number to be used for the tandem call (defined in Program 44-07).
0~500 0 = No Setting
2 - 399
Document Revision 1
Item No. 07
ARS Class of Service
Item
Default 0
Select the ARS Class of Service to be used for the table. An extensions ARS COS is determined in Program 26-04-01.
08
Dial Treatment Select the Dial Treatment to be used for the table. If a Dial Treatment is selected, Programs 44-05-02 and 44-05-03 are ignored and the Dial Treatment defined in Program 26-03-01 is used instead.
0~15
09 10
0~24 0 ~ 16367
0 0
Conditions None
2 - 400
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 44-06 : Additional Dial Table to set the additional dial table to add prior to the dialed ARS/F-Route number. The Additional Dial Table used is determined in Program 44-05-03.
Input Data
Additional Dial Table Number 1~1000
Item No. 01
Additional Dial Up to 24 digits Enter: 1-9, 0, , #, Pause (press line key 1 to enter a pause)
Default No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 401
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 44-07 : Gain Table for ARS/F-Route Access to set the gain/PAD table. If an extension dials ARS/F-Route number:
The Extension Dial Gain Table is activated, which is assigned in Program 44-05. The Extension Dial Gain Table follows Outgoing transmit and Outgoing receive settings.
2 - 402
J J J J
Input Data
Gain Table Number 1~500
Item No. 01 02 03 04
Item
Incoming Transmit
Input Data 1~63 (-15.5 ~ +15.5dB) 1~63 (-15.5 ~ +15.5dB) 1~63 (-15.5 ~ +15.5dB) 1~63 (-15.5 ~ +15.5dB)
Default 32 32 32 32
Incoming Receive
Outgoing Transmit
Outgoing Receive
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 403
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 44-08 : Time Schedule for ARS/F-Route to define the daily pattern of the ARS/F-Route feature. ARS/F-Route has 10 time patterns. These patterns are used in Program 44-09 and 44-10. The daily pattern consists of 20 time settings.
Input Data
Schedule Pattern Number 01~10
Item No. 01
Mode 1~8
Time Number 01 : 00:00 08:00 Time Number 02 : 08:00 18:00 Time Number 03 : 18:00 22:00 Time Number 04 : 22:00 00:00 Pattern 2
0:00 Mode 2
0:00
2 - 404
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 405
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 44-09 : Weekly Schedule for ARS/F-Route to define a weekly schedule for using ARS/F-Route. The pattern number is defined in Program 44-08-01.
Input Data
Item No. 01
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Day Number
= Sunday = Monday = Tuesday = Wednesday = Thursday = Friday = Saturday
Schedule Pattern Number 1~10 1~10 1~10 1~10 1~10 1~10 1~10
Conditions None
2 - 406
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 44-10 : Holiday Schedule for ARS/F-Route to define a yearly schedule for ARS/F-Route. This schedule is used for setting special days such as national holidays. The pattern number is defined in Program 44-08-01.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Date 0101~1231 Schedule Pattern Number 0~10 0 = No Setting Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 407
Document Revision 1
2 - 408
Description
Use Program 45-01 :Voice Mail Integration Options to customize certain voice mail integration options.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Voice Mail Department Group Number Assign which Extension (Department) Group number is to be assigned as the voice mail group (non-networked system).
Default 0
02
Voice Mail Master Name Enter the Voice Mail master name (non-networked system).
Up to 12 Characters
Voice Mail
03 04
--- Not Used --Park and Page Enable/disable the systems ability to process the Voice Mails Park and Page ( ) commands. You should normally enable this option.
0 = Off 1 = On
05
Message Wait Enable/disable the systems ability to process the Voice Mails Message Wait (#) commands. You should normally enable this option. If enabled, be sure that the programmed Message Notification strings dont contain the code for trunk access.
0 = Off 1 = On
06
Record Alert Tone Interval Time This timer sets the interval between voice Mail Conversation Record alerts
0~64800 (sec)
30
14
CCIS Centralized Voice Mail Number Assign the pilot number to Centralized Voice Mail over CCIS Link. This is only assigned in the remote switches.
No Setting
2 - 409
margorP
45
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 410
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-01 : IPK II In-Mail System Options
Level: IN
Description
Use Program 47-01 : IPK II In-Mail System Options to set up the IPK II In-Mail system-wide options.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
DSPDB Voice Mail Type (DSPDB VM Type) Use this option to enable the IPK II In-Mail. Enter 0 for this option when IPK II In-Mail is installed. The KSU must be reset for a change to this program to take effect.
0 1
Input Data
= In-Mail = VRS
Default
1 (VRS)
02
IPK II In-Mail Master Name (MasterName) Use this option to modify the name for all IPK II In-Mail ports. The system briefly displays this name when a display multiline terminal user calls a Voice Mail port (either by pressing Message, their voice mail key, or by dialing the master number). You should always end the name with the ## characters. The system substitutes the port number for the last #. Using the default name In-Mail ## for example, the keyset display shows IPK II In-Mail #1 when calling port 1.
Up to 12 characters
In-Mail ## (The system substitutes the port number for the # when calling the port).
2 - 411
margorP
47
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 03 Item
Subscriber Message Length (Subs Msg Length) Use this option to set the maximum length of recorded messages for: Subscriber Mailbox users dialing RS to record and send a message. Extension users leaving a message in a Subscriber Mailbox. Outside Automated Attendant callers accessing a mailbox via a GOTO command and then dialing RS to record and send a message. Subscriber Mailbox Greetings. Announcement Messages. Call Routing Mailbox Instruction Menus.
Input Data
1~4095 (sec)
Default
120 (sec)
04
Non-Subscriber Message Length (Mbox Msg Length) Use this option to set the maximum length of recorded messages for: Automated Attendant callers leaving a message or Quick Message in a Subscriber Mailbox. Outside callers transferred by an extension user to a Subscriber Mailbox.
05
Message Backup/Go Ahead Time (Msg Bkup/Adv Time) Use this option to set the backup/go ahead interval. This interval sets how far IPK II In-Mail backs up when a user dials B while listening to a message. This interval also sets how far IPK II In-Mail jumps ahead when a user dials G while listening to a message.
2 - 412
H H H H H H H H
The length of a Conversation Record is 10 times the Subscriber Message Length. Since the Conversation Record time cannot exceed 4095 seconds, any settings in Subscriber Message Length larger than 409 has no effect on the length of recorded conversations.
1~4095 (sec) 120 (sec)
1~60 (sec)
5 (sec)
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 06
Fax Extension (Fax Extension) Use this option to specify which system extension is the fax machine. When the Automated Attendant answers a call and detects fax (CNG) tone, it automatically transfers the call to this extension.
Item
Input Data
Up to 8 digits
Default
No Setting
(Pager CBack) Use this option to set the Digital Pager Callback Number portion of the Message Notification callout number for a digital pager. This is the portion of the callout number that is appended to the pager service telephone number. Normally, this option should be X*M#, where: X is the number of the extension that generated the notification. is a visual delimiter (to make the pager display easier to read). M is the number of new messages in the extensions mailbox. # is the digit normally used by the pager service for positive disconnect.
M (Number of messages - entered by pressing LK1) No entry (Entered by pressing HOLD). X (Extension number - entered by pressing LK2) IPK II In-Mail automatically replaces the X command with the number of the extension that initially received the message.
07
X M#
, H
H H H
2 - 413
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 08 Item
Delay in Dialing Digital Pager Callback Number (Pager Dial Delay) Use this option to set the delay (0~99 seconds) that occurs just before IPK II In-Mail dials the Digital Pager Callback Number portion of the Message Notification callout number for a digital pager. Set this delay so the pager service has enough time to connect to the digital pager before sending the callback number. Your pager service may be able to help you determine the best value for this option (0~99 seconds). By default, this option is 9 seconds. When placing a digital pager notification, the system: Seizes the trunk specified. Dials the user-entered notification number (in Message + OP + N). Waits the 47-01-08: Delay in Dialing Digital Pager Callback Number interval. Dials the number entered in 47-01-07: Digital Pager Callback Number. The system assumes that the notification number will complete dialing approximately 4 seconds after trunk seizure. This means that, by default, the Digital Pager Callback Number will be dialed into the pager service about 13 seconds after trunk seizure.
Input Data
0~99 (sec)
Default
9 (sec)
09
Wait Between Digital Pager Callout Attempts (Notify Pager Intvl) Use this option to set the minimum time (1~255 minutes) between unacknowledged or unanswered digital pager Message Notification callouts. (A subscriber acknowledges a digital pager notification by logging onto their mailbox.) After this interval expires, IPK II In-Mail will try the callout again (for up to the number of times set in 47-01-14: Number of Callout Attempts). If the system dials the callout number and the pager service is busy, it will retry the number in one minute.
1~255 (min)
15 (min)
2 - 414
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 10 Item
Wait Between Non-Pager Callout Attempts (Notify N-Pgr Intvl) Use this option to set the minimum time (1~255 minutes) between non-pager Message Notification callouts in which the destination answers, says Hello, dials 1 to acknowledge and then enters the wrong security code.
Input Data
1~255 (min)
Default
20 (min)
11
Wait Between Busy Non-Pager Callout Attempts (Notify Busy Intvl) Use this option to set how long IPK II In-Mail will wait (1~255 minutes), after it dials a busy non-pager callout destination, before retrying the callout number.
1~255 (min)
15 (min)
12
Wait Between RNA Non-Pager Callout Attempts (Notify RNA Intvl) Use this option to set how long IPK II In-Mail will wait (1~255 minutes), after it dials an unanswered non-pager callout destination, before retrying the callout number. There are three types of unanswered non-pager callouts: If the callout rings the destination longer than the 47-01-13: Wait for Answer Non-Pager Callout Attempts option. If the destination answers, says Hello (or the system detects answer supervision) and then hangs up without dialing 1 to log onto their mailbox. This typically happens if someone unfamiliar with notification answers the callout, or if the callout is picked up by an answering machine. If the destination answers and then hangs up without saying Hello. This typically happens if someone unfamiliar with the notification answers the callout (like the above example), or if the call is picked up by an answering machine with insufficient outgoing message volume.
1~255 (min)
30 (min)
H H H
2 - 415
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 13 Item
Wait for Answer Non-Pager Callout Attempts (Notify RNA Rings) If a non-pager callout rings the destination longer than this interval (1-99 rings), IPK II In-Mail marks the call as unanswered (Ring No Answer) and hangs up.
Input Data
1~99 (rings)
Default
5 (rings)
14
Number of Callout Attempts (Notify Call Attmpt) Use this option to set how many times (1~99 attempts) IPK II In-Mail will retry an incomplete Message Notification callout. This total includes unacknowledged callouts, callouts to a busy destination, and callouts to an unanswered destination. This option applies to pager and non-pager callouts.
1~99 (attempts)
5 (attempts)
15
Send Pager Callout Until Acknowledged (Retry Until Ack) When this option is enabled (1), IPK II In-Mail will continue to retry a digital pager Message Notification callout until the notification is acknowledged. If this option is disabled (0), IPK II In-Mail will retry a digital pager Message Notification the number of times specified in 47-01-14 Number of Callout Attempts. This option does not apply to Message Notification callouts to telephone numbers. A digital pager notification is considered acknowledged when the recipient logs onto the mailbox.
0 (Disabled)
16
Name Format Specify if names will be displayed in First Last format or Last First.
0 (1st Last)
17
In-Mail Port Specify the port number of the first In-Mail Port.
0~249
2 - 416
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Conditions
When changing 47-01-01, a system reset is required for the new setting to take effect.
2 - 417
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-02 : IPK II In-Mail Station Mailbox Options
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-02: IPK II In-Mail Station Mailbox Options to set up a stations (extensions) mailbox. Station mailboxes are automatically assigned as Subscriber Mailboxes. Normally, IPK II In-Mail Station Mailbox numbers 1~26 should correspond to extensions 101~126.
2 - 418
Item No. 01 02
Station Mailboxes are one of three mailbox categories: Station, Routing, and Master. You can also set up Master Mailboxes as Subscriber Mailboxes.
Input Data
Item
Mailbox Active (Mailbox Active) Use this option to enable or disable the mailbox. An extensions mailbox is not accessible when it is disabled (even though its stored messages and configuration are retained in memory.) If disabled, a user pressing Message initiates a remote logon and is asked to enter their mailbox number. A voice prompt then announces, That mailbox does not exist. To make programming easier, consider associating a mailbox number with a station port. For example, mailbox 1 could correspond to port 1, which in turn corresponds to extension 101. Mailbox Number (Mailbox Number) Use this option to select the extension number associated with the mailbox you are programming. Normally, mailbox 1 should use Mailbox Number 101, mailbox 2 should use Mailbox Number 102, etc. To make programming easier, consider associating a mailbox number with a station port. For example, mailbox 1 could correspond to port 1, which in turn corresponds to extension 101. Digits (8 maximum, using 0~9) Mailboxes 1~8 = 101~108. For all other mailboxes, there is no entry.
Input Data
0 (No = Disabled) 1 (Yes = Enabled)
Default
Mailboxes 1~8 = 1 (Enabled) All Other Mailboxes = 0 (Disabled)
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 03
Number of Messages (Number of Messages) Use this option to set the maximum number of messages that can be left in the Subscriber Mailbox. If a caller tries to leave a message once this limit is reached, they hear, That mailbox is full. IPK II In-Mail then hangs up.
Item
Input Data
0~99 messages To conserve storage space, enter 0 for all unused mailboxes.
Default
99 messages for mailbox 1 20 messages for all other mailboxes
04
Message Playback (Message Playback) Use this option to set the Subscriber Mailbox message playback order. When a subscriber listens to their messages, IPK II In-Mail can play the oldest messages first (first-infirst-out, or FIFO), or the newest messages first (last-infirst-out, or LIFO).
0 (FIFO = first-in/ first-out, or oldest messages first). 1 (LIFO = last-in/ first-out, or newest messages first)
05
Auto Erase/Save of Messages (Auto Erase/Save) Use this option to determine what happens when a Subscriber Mailbox user completely listens to a new message and then exits their mailbox without either saving (SA) or erasing (E) the message. Depending on the setting of this option, IPK II In-Mail will either automatically save or erase the message. If the mailbox user hangs up before listening to the entire new message, IPK II In-Mail retains the message as a new message.
0 (Erase) After the subscriber listens to the entire new message and hangs up, IPK II In-Mail erases the message. 1 (Save) After the subscriber listens to the entire new message and hangs up, IPK II In-Mail saves the message. 1~90 Days 0 (Indefinite)
1 (Save)
06
Message Retention (Message Retention) Use this option to determine how long a Subscriber Mailbox will retain held and saved messages. If a message is left in a Subscriber Mailbox longer than this interval, IPK II In-Mail deletes it.
0 (Indefinite)
2 - 419
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 07 Item
Recording Conversation Beep (Rec Conv Beep) Use this option to enable or disable the Conversation Record beep. If enabled, all parties on a call will hear the voice prompt Recording followed by a single beep when the extension user initiates Conversation Record. If disabled, the voice prompt and beep will not occur. When you disable the Conversation Record beep, the following voice prompts do not occur while IPK II In-Mail records the conversation: Recording (followed by a beep) That mailbox is full (if the mailbox message storage capacity is reached) You have reached the recording limit (if the recorded message is too long) The Electra Elite IPK II telephone system software provides an additional Conversation Record beep. This beep repeats according to the setting of Program 45-01-06: Voice Mail Integration Options: Record Alert Tone Interval Time (0~64800 seconds). To disable the Electra Elite IPK II telephone system Conversation Record beep, enter 0 for this option.
Input Data
0 = No (Disabled) 1 = Yes (Enabled)
Default
1 (Yes - Enabled)
08
Message Waiting Lamp (Update MW Lamp) Use this option to enable or disable Message Waiting lamping at the extension associated with the Subscriber mailbox. For Subscriber Mailboxes, you should leave this option enabled. For Guest Mailboxes, you should leave this option disabled.
1 (Yes - Enabled)
09
Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb (Auto-ATT DND) Use this option to enable or disable Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb. When a subscriber enables Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb, an Automated Attendant caller will route directly to the mailbox, hear the greeting, and be asked to leave a message. A subscriber can also enable Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb while recording their mailbox greeting.
0 (No - Disabled)
2 - 420
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 10 Item
Forced Unscreened Transfer (Forced UTRF) Use this option to enable or disable Automated Attendant Forced Unscreened Transfer for the Subscriber Mailbox. If enabled, each Screened Transfer (TRF) to the extension is converted to an Unscreened Transfer (UTRF). If disabled, Screened Transfers from the Automated Attendant occur normally.
Input Data
0 = No (Disabled) 1 = Yes (Enabled)
Default
0 (No - Disabled)
11
Auto Time Stamp (Auto Time Stamp) Use this option to enable or disable Auto Time Stamp for the Subscriber Mailbox. If enabled, after the subscriber listens to a message IPK II In-Mail will announce the time and date the message was left. Auto Time Stamp will also announce the message sender (if known). A subscriber can also enable Auto Time Stamp from their mailbox.
0 (No - Disabled)
12
System Administrator (System Admin) Use this option to designate the Subscriber Mailbox as a System Administrator. This allows the subscriber to use the SA options after logging onto their mailbox.
13
Dialing Option (Dialing Option) Dialing Option provides additional dialing options for Next Call Routing Mailbox calls (see Next Call Routing Mailbox below). If enabled, a caller who accesses the Subscriber Mailbox to leave a message can dial any of the options in the Next Call Routing Mailboxs Dial Action Table. If disabled, the caller can only dial 0 (to use the Next Call Routing Mailboxs 0 action).
0 (No - Disabled)
14
Next Call Routing Mailbox (Next CR Mbox) Use this option to assign a Next Call Routing Mailbox to the Subscriber Mailbox. This provides callers with additional dialing options while listening to a Subscriber Mailbox recorded or default greeting. The digits the caller can dial depends on the setting of the Next Call Routing Mailbox and Alternate Next Call Routing Mailbox options.
Call Routing Mailbox Number (1~3 digits, 01~016) No entry (Entered by pressing CLEAR)
1 (Call Routing Mailbox 01) By default, Call Routing Mailbox numbers are 01~08.
15
Directory List
0 (None)
2 - 421
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 422
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-03 : IPK II In-Mail Master Mailbox Options
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-03: IPK II In-Mail Master Mailbox Options to set up the 16 Master Mailboxes (01~16). A Master Mailbox is used for Department Group overflow and can be a Subscriber, Call Routing, or Announcement Mailbox.
Input Data
Item No. 01
Master Mailbox Active (Mailbox Active) Use this option to enable or disable the Master Mailbox. A Master Mailbox is not accessible when it is disabled.
Item
Input Data
0 = No (Disabled) 1 = Yes (Enabled)
Default
0 (No - Disabled)
02
Master Mailbox Number (Mailbox Number) The Master Mailbox Number is the same as the Department Group master (pilot) number. Use this option to select the Department Group master (pilot) number associated with the Master Mailbox you are programming.
No Setting
03
Master Mailbox Type (Mailbox Type) Use this option to set the Master Mailbox type. There are four types of IPK II In-Mail mailboxes: Call Routing (1), Announcement (2), Subscriber (3), and Directory (4). If the Master Mailbox is a Call Routing Mailbox (1), go to 47-04 : Master Call Routing Mailbox Options to set up the Master Mailbox options. If the Master Mailbox is an Announcement Mailbox (2), go to 47-05 : Master Announcement Mailbox Options to set up the Master Mailbox options. If the Master Mailbox is a Subscriber Mailbox (3), go to 47-06 : Master Subscriber Mailbox Options to set up the Master Mailbox options. If the Master Mailbox is a Directory Mailbox (4), go to 47-14 : Master Directory Mailbox Options to set up the Master Mailbox options.
3 (Subscriber)
H H H H
2 - 423
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 424
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-04 : Master Call Routing Mailbox Options
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-04: Master Call Routing Mailbox Options to set up a Master Mailbox (01~16) assigned as a Call Routing Mailbox in 47-03-03: Master Mailbox Type.
Input Data
Item No. 01
Dial Action Table (Dial Action Table) Use this option to assign the Dial Action Table to the Call Routing Mailbox. The Dial Action Table defines the dialing options for the call Routing Mailbox.
Item
Input Data
1~16 (Dial Action Table 1~16)
Default
1 (Dial Action Table 1)
02
Screened Transfer Timeout (Scrn Trf Timeout) Use this option to set how long a Screened Transfer (TRF) from the Automated Attendant will ring an unanswered extension before recalling. This option has a similar function as Customize: Mailbox Options: Call Routing: [Call Handling] Options: Delay Rings Before Redirect Transfer in IPK II In-Mail.
15 (sec)
03
Time Limit for Dialing Commands (Dialing Timeout) This option determines how long IPK II In-Mail will wait for an Automated Attendant caller to dial before routing the call to the Timeout destination. Be sure your Dial Action Tables have a Timeout action programmed. If the caller waits too long to dial: When the associated Dial Action Table has a Timeout action programmed, the caller routes to that destination. When the associated Dial Action Table does not have a Timeout action programmed, the Instruction Menu repeats 3 times and then IPK II In-Mail hangs up.
0~99 seconds Entering 0 causes the Automated Attendant to immediately route callers to the Timeout destination programmed in the active Dial Action Table.
5 (sec)
2 - 425
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 04
Fax Detection (Fax Detection) Use this option to enable or disable Fax Detection for the Call Routing Mailbox. In enabled, the IPK II In-Mail Automated Attendant (when using this Call Routing Mailbox) will detect incoming fax CNG tone. The fax call will then route to the company fax machine according to the setting of 47-01-06 : Fax Extension. If disabled, the Automated Attendant will not detect incoming fax calls.
Item
Input Data
0 = No (Disabled) 1 = Yes (Enabled)
Default
0 (No - Disabled)
Conditions None
2 - 426
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-05 : Master Announcement Mailbox Options
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-05: Master Announcement Mailbox Options to set up a Master Mailbox (01~16) assigned as an Announcement Mailbox in 47-03-03: Master Mailbox Type.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Next Call Routing Mailbox (Next CR Mbox) If you set up an Announcement Mailbox to answer Automated Attendant calls, use this option to provide additional routing options to the Automated Attendant callers. This option interacts with Repeat Count and Hang Up After below. For more detail on this interaction, refer to Routed Announcement Mailbox Routing in the Electra Elite IPK II IPK II In-Mail System Guide.
Input Data
Call Routing Mailbox Number (01~16) Undefined (0)
Default
Undefined (0)
02
Repeat Count (Repeat Count) Enter the number of times you want the Announcement Mailbox message to repeat to callers. After an Announcement Mailbox caller initially listens to the message, it will repeat the number of times specified in this option. This option interacts with Next Call Routing Mailbox and Hang Up After when providing routing options. For more detail on this interaction, refer to Direct Announcement Mailbox Routing in the IPK II In-Mail System Guide and Routed Announcement Mailbox Routing in the IPK II In-Mail System Guide.
0 (No Repeats)
2 - 427
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 03
Hang Up After (HangUp) Use this option along with Next Call Routing Mailbox and Repeat Count above to provide additional routing options to Automated Attendant callers. For more detail on the interaction of these options, refer to Direct Announcement Mailbox Routing in the IPK II In-Mail System Guide and Routed Announcement Mailbox Routing in the IPK II In-Mail System Guide.
Item
Input Data
0 = No (Disabled) 1 - Yes (Enabled)
Default
0 (No - Disabled)
Conditions None
2 - 428
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-06 : Master Subscriber Mailbox Options
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-06: Master Subscriber Mailbox Options to set up a Master Mailbox assigned as a Subscriber Mailbox in 47-03-03: Master Mailbox Type.
Input Data
Item No. 01
Number of Messages (Number of Messages) Use this option to set the maximum number of messages that can be left in the Subscriber Mailbox. If a caller tries to leave a message once this limit is reached, they hear, That mailbox is full. IPK II In-Mail then hangs up. To conserve storage space, enter 0 for all unused mailboxes.
Item
Input Data
0~99 messages 20
Default
02
Message Playback (Message Playback) Use this option to set the Subscriber Mailbox message playback order. When a subscriber listens to their messages, IPK II In-Mail can play the oldest messages first (first-in/first-out, or FIFO), or the newest messages first (last-in/first-out, or LIFO).
0 (FIFO = first-in/firstout, or oldest messages first). 1 (LIFO = last-in/firstout, or newest messages first).
0 (FIFO)
03
Auto Erase/Save of Messages (Auto Erase/Save) Use this option to determine what happens when a Subscriber Mailbox user completely listens to a new message and then exits their mailbox without either saving (SA) or erasing (E) the message. Depending on the setting of this option, IPK II In-Mail will either automatically save or erase the message. If the mailbox user hangs up before listening to the entire new message, IPK II In-Mail retains the message as a new message.
0 (Erase) After the subscriber listens to the entire new message and hangs up, IPK II In-Mail erases the message. 1 (Save) After the subscriber listens to the entire new message and hangs up, IPK II In-Mail saves the message.
1 (Save)
2 - 429
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 04
Message Retention (Message Retention) Use this option to determine how long a Subscriber Mailbox will retain held and saved messages. If a message is left in a Subscriber Mailbox longer than this interval, IPK II In-Mail deletes it.
Item
Input Data
1~90 days 0 (Indefinite)
Default
0 (Indefinite)
05
Recording Conversation Beep (Rec Conv Beep) Use this option to enable or disable the Conversation Record beep. If enabled, all parties on a call will hear the voice prompt Recording followed by a single beep when the extension user initiates Conversation Record. If disabled, the voice prompt and beep will not occur. When you disable the Conversation Record beep, the following voice prompts do not occur while IPK II In-Mail records the conversation: Recording (followed by a beep) That mailbox is full (if the mailbox message storage capacity is reached) You have reached the recording limit (if the recorded message is too long) The Electra Elite IPK II telephone system software provides an additional Conversation Record beep. This beep repeats according to the setting of Program 45-01-06: Voice Mail Integration Options: Record Alert Tone Interval Time (0~64800 seconds). To disable the Electra Elite IPK II telephone system Conversation Record beep, enter 0 for this option.
1 (Yes - Enabled)
06
Message Waiting Lamp (Update MW Lamp) Use this option to enable or disable Message Waiting lamping at the extension associated with the Subscriber mailbox. For Subscriber Mailboxes, you should leave this option enabled. For Guest Mailboxes, you should leave this option disabled.
1 (Yes - Enabled)
07
Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb (Auto-ATT DND) Use this option to enable or disable Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb. When a subscriber enables Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb, an Automated Attendant caller will route directly to the mailbox, hear the greeting, and be asked to leave a message. A subscriber can also enable Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb while recording their mailbox greeting.
0 (No - Disabled)
2 - 430
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 08 Item
Forced Unscreened Transfer (Forced UTRF) Use this option to enable or disable Automated Attendant Forced Unscreened Transfer for the Subscriber Mailbox. If enabled, each Screened Transfer (TRF) to the extension is converted to an Unscreened Transfer (UTRF). If disabled, Screened Transfers from the Automated Attendant occur normally.
Input Data
0 = No (Disabled) 1 = Yes (Enabled)
Default
0 (No - Disabled)
09
Auto Time Stamp (Auto Time Stamp) Use this option to enable or disable Auto Time Stamp for the Subscriber Mailbox. If enabled, after the subscriber listens to a message IPK II In-Mail will announce the time and date the message was left. Auto Time Stamp will also announce the message sender (if known). A subscriber can also enable Auto Time Stamp from their mailbox.
0 (No -Disabled)
10
System Administrator (System Admin) Use this option to designate the Subscriber Mailbox as a System Administrator. This allows the subscriber to use the options after logging onto their mailbox.
0 (No - Disabled)
11
Dialing Option (Dialing Option) Dialing Option provides additional dialing options for Next Call Routing Mailbox calls (see Next Call Routing Mailbox below). If enabled, a caller who accesses the Subscriber Mailbox to leave a message can dial any of the options in the Next Call Routing Mailboxs Dial Action Table. If disabled, the caller can only dial 0 (to use the Next Call Routing Mailboxs 0 action).
0 (No - Disabled)
12
Next Call Routing Mailbox (Next CR Mbox) Use this option to assign a Next Call Routing Mailbox to the Subscriber Mailbox. This provides callers with additional dialing options while listening to a Subscriber Mailbox recorded or default greeting. The digits the caller can dial depends on the setting of the Next Call Routing Mailbox and Alternate Next Call Routing Mailbox options.
Call Routing Mailbox Number (1~3 digits) No entry (entered by pressing CLEAR)
1 (Call Routing Mailbox 01) By default, Call Routing Mailbox numbers are 01=16.
2 - 431
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 13
Directory List
Item
Input Data
0 = None 1~8 = List Number = All 0
Default
Conditions None
2 - 432
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-07 : IPK II In-Mail Routing Mailbox Options
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-07: IPK II In-Mail Routing Mailbox Options to set up the 16 Routing Mailboxes. Routing Mailboxes can be either Announcement or Call Routing Mailboxes.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Routing Mailbox Active (Mailbox Active) Use this option to enable or disable the mailbox. A Routing Mailbox is not accessible when it is disabled.
Input Data
0 = No (Disabled) 1 = Yes (Enabled)
Default
1 (Yes - Enabled)
02
Routing Mailbox Type (Mailbox Type) Use this option to set the Routing Mailbox type.
Conditions None
2 - 433
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-08 : Call Routing Mailbox Options
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-08: Call Routing Mailbox Options to set the options for mailboxes assigned as Call Routing Mailboxes in 47-07-02: Routing Mailbox Type.
Input Data
Item No. 01
Dial Action Table (Dial Action Table) Use this option to assign the Dial Action Table to the Call Routing Mailbox. The Dial Action Table defines the dialing options for the call Routing Mailbox.
Item
Input Data
1~16 (Dial Action Table 1~16)
Default
1 (Dial Action Table 1)
02
Screened Transfer Timeout (Scrn Trf Timeout) Use this option to set how long a Screened Transfer (TRF) from the Automated Attendant will ring an unanswered extension before recalling. This option has a similar function as Customize: Mailbox Options: Call Routing: [Call Handling] Options: Delay Rings Before Redirect Transfer in Electra Elite IPK II In-Mail.
15 (sec)
03
Time Limit for Dialing Commands (Dialing Timeout) This option determines how long IPK II In-Mail will wait for an Automated Attendant caller to dial before routing the call to the Timeout destination. Be sure your Dial Action Tables have a Timeout action programmed. If the caller waits too long to dial: When the associated Dial Action Table has a Timeout action programmed, the caller routes to that destination. When the associated Dial Action Table does not have a Timeout action programmed, the Instruction Menu repeats three times and then IPK II In-Mail hangs up.
0~99 (sec) Entering 0 causes the Automated Attendant to immediately route callers to the Timeout destination programmed in the active Dial Action Table.
5 (sec)
2 - 434
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 04
Fax Detection (Fax Detection) Use this option to enable or disable Fax Detection for the Call Routing Mailbox. In enabled, the IPK II In-Mail Automated Attendant (when using this Call Routing Mailbox) will detect incoming fax CNG tone. The fax call will then route to the company fax machine according to the setting of 47-01-06 : Fax Extension. If disabled, the Automated Attendant will not detect incoming fax calls.
Item
Input Data
0 = No (Disabled) 1 = Yes (Enabled)
Default
0 (No-Disabled)
Conditions None
2 - 435
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-09 : Announcement Mailbox Options
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-09: Announcement Mailbox Options to set the options for mailboxes assigned as Announcement Mailboxes in 47-07-02: Routing Mailbox Type.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Next Call Routing Mailbox (Next CR Mbox) If you set up an Announcement Mailbox to answer Automated Attendant calls, use this option to provide additional routing options to the Automated Attendant callers. This option interacts with Repeat Count and Hang Up After below. For details on the interaction of these options, refer to Direct Announcement Mailbox Routing in the IPK II In-Mail System Guide and Routed Announcement Mailbox Routing in the IPK II InMail System Guide.
Input Data
Call Routing Mailbox Number (1~16) Undefined (0)
Default
0 (Undefined)
02
Repeat Count (Repeat Count) Enter the number of times you want the Announcement Mailbox message to repeat to callers. After an Announcement Mailbox caller initially listens to the message, it will repeat the number of times specified in this option. This option interacts with Next Call Routing Mailbox and Hang Up After when providing routing options. For details on the interaction of these options, refer to Direct Announcement Mailbox Routing in the IPK II In-Mail System Guide and Routed Announcement Mailbox Routing in the IPK II InMail System Guide.
0 (No Repeats)
2 - 436
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 03
Hang Up After (HangUp) Use this option along with Next Call Routing Mailbox and Repeat Count above to provide additional routing options to Automated Attendant callers. For details on the interaction of these options, refer to Direct Announcement Mailbox Routing in the IPK II In-Mail System Guide and Routed Announcement Mailbox Routing in the IPK II In-Mail System Guide.
Item
Input Data
0 = No (Disabled) 1 = Yes (Enabled)
Default
0 (No - Disabled)
Conditions None
2 - 437
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-10 : IPK II In-Mail Trunk Options
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-10: IPK II In-Mail Trunk Options to assign IPK II In-Mail options for each trunk. Currently, only 47-10-01: Answer Table Assignment is available.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Answer Table Assignment (Answer Table) Use this option to assign an IPK II In-Mail Answer Table to each Direct Inward Line (DIL) the Automated Attendant should answer. The Automated Attendant follows the routing specified by the selected Answer Table.
Conditions None
2 - 438
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-11 : IPK II In-Mail Answer Table Options
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-11: IPK II In-Mail Answer Table Options to set options for the Answer Tables. IPK II In-Mail provides 8 Answer Tables (1~8). To set up the schedules for each Answer Table, go to 47-12: IPK II In-Mail Answer Table Schedule.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Answer Schedule Override (Schedule Override) Use this option to enable or disable Answer Schedule Override for the selected Answer Table. If enabled (and you make an entry for Override Mailbox below), the active Answer Table will route calls to the Override Mailbox.
Input Data
0 = No (Disabled) 1 = Yes (Enabled)
Default
0 (No - Disabled)
2 - 439
Document Revision 1
Input Data
0 (Undefined) 1 (Subscriber Mailbox - STA) 2 (Master Mailbox) 3 (Routing Mailbox)
Default
0 (Undefined)
2 - 440
H H H
Override Mailbox Number (Override MB Num) Use this option to specify the mailbox to which Automated Attendant calls should route when you enable Answer Schedule Override. The mailbox number you select in this option should match the mailbox category specified in 47-11-02: Override Mailbox Category above.
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Input Data
0 (Undefined) 1 (Subscriber Mailbox - STA) 2 (Master Mailbox) 3 (Routing Mailbox)
Default
Answer Table 1 = 3 (Routing Mailbox) Answer Table 2~8 = 0 (Undefined)
04
H H H
Default Mailbox Number (Default MB Num) Use this option to set the Answer Tables Default Mailbox number. IPK II In-Mail uses the Default Mailbox whenever an Answer Schedule is not in effect. By default, this occurs at all times other than Monday through Friday from 8:30 AM to 5:00 PM. Next Answer Table (Next Answer Table) When 10 Answer Schedules within an Answer Table are not sufficient, use this option to link two Answer Tables together. IPK II In-Mail treats the two linked tables as a single 20 entry Answer Table.
0 (Undefined)
2 - 441
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 442
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-12 : IPK II In-Mail Answer Schedules
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-12: IPK II In-Mail Answer Schedules to set up the IPK II In-Mail Automated Attendant Answer Schedules. There are eight Answer Tables, with up to 10 Answer Schedules in each Answer Table.
Input Data
Item No. 01
Schedule Type (Entryxx Schedule Type) Use this option to assign a Schedule Type to the selected Answer Schedule. The Schedule Type determines how the Answer Schedule answers calls. The schedule can be one of the following types: 1. Day of the Week A Type 1 Answer Schedule runs on a specific day of the week. For this type of schedule, you select: The day of the week the schedule should run: The schedule start time. The schedule end time. The Call Routing or Announcement Mailbox used to answer calls. 2. Range of Days A Type 2 Answer Schedule runs for a range of days. For this type of schedule, you select: The day of the week the schedule should start. The day of the week the schedule should stop. The time on the start day the schedule should start. The time on the stop day the schedule should stop. The Call Routing or Announcement Mailbox used to answer the calls.
Item
Input Data
1 (Day of the Week) 2 (Range of Days) 3 (Date) 0 (Undefined)
Default
Answer Table 1/ Schedule 1 = 2 (Range of Days) All other schedules = 0 (Undefined)
H H
2 - 443
Document Revision 1
Default
Answer Table 1/ Schedule 1 = 2 (Range of Days) All Other Schedules = 0 (Undefined)
02
Answering Mailbox Category (Entryxx MB Ctg) Use this option to specify the category of mailbox to which Automated Attendant calls should route when the schedule is in effect. IPK II In-Mail mailbox categories are Subscriber Mailbox, Master Mailbox, or Routing Mailbox. IPK II In-Mail handles the routing according to the exact type of Subscriber, Master, or Routing Mailbox specified. If the Answering Mailbox is a Subscriber Mailbox, the outside caller hears the mailbox greeting (if recorded) and can leave a message. If the Answering Mailbox is an Announcement Mailbox, the outside caller will hear the recorded announcement. Depending on how the Announcement Mailbox is programmed, IPK II In-Mail will then hang up, reroute the call, or provide additional dialing options. If the Answering Mailbox is a Call Routing Mailbox, the outside caller will hear the instruction menu and can dial any options allowed by the associated Dial Action Table. Answering Mailbox Number (Entryxx MB Num) Use this option to set the number of the Answering Mailbox the Automated Attendant uses when the selected schedule is in effect. This mailbox is defined in 47-12-02: Answering Mailbox Category.
2 - 444
3 (Routing Mailbox)
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Item
Input Data
1 = Sunday 2 = Monday 3 = Tuesday 4 = Wednesday 5 = Thursday 6 = Friday 7 = Saturday
Default
1 (Sunday)
04
Start Day (Entryxx Start Day) For Range of Days (Type 2) Answer Schedules, use this option to select the day of the week the Answer Schedule should start.
1 (Sunday) Answer Table 1/ Schedule 1 = 2 (Monday) All Other Schedules = 1 (Sunday) Answer Table 1/ Schedule 1 = 6 (Friday) All Other Answer Schedules = 1 (Sunday)
05
End Day (Entryxx End Day) For Range of Days (Type 2) Answer Schedules, use this option to select the day of the week the Answer Schedule should end.
06
Date (Entryxx Date) For Date (Type 3) Answer Schedules, use this option to select the date the Answer Schedule should be active.
MMDD For example: - 0101 = January 1 - 1231 = December 31 - 0000 = No date set HHMM (24-hour clock) For example: - 0130 = 1:30AM - 1700 = 5:00PM
07
Schedule Start Time (Entryxx Start Time) Use this option to specify the time the Answer Schedule should start. It applies to Day of the Week (Type 1), Range of Days (Type 2), and Date (Type 3) schedules. (To make a schedule run continuously, make the same entry for 47-12-07: Schedule Start Time and 47-12-08: Schedule End Time.)
Answer Table 1/ Schedule 1 = 08:30 (8:30AM) All other schedules are undefined.
08
Schedule End Time (Entryxx End Time) Use this option to specify the time the Answer Schedule should end. It applies to Day of the Week (Type 1), Range of Days (Type 2), and Date (Type 3) schedules. (To make a schedule run continuously, make the same entry for 47-12-07: Schedule Start Time and 47-12-08: Schedule End Time.)
Answer Table 1/ Schedule 1 = 1700 (5:00PM). All Other Schedules = 0000 (Undefined).
2 - 445
Document Revision 1
Example
Type 1 (Day of the Week) Answer Schedule Options Type 1 (Day of Week) Example In this example, Answer Table 1 routes calls as follows:
Schedule 1 uses Routing Mailbox 2 and runs Sunday from 8:30AM to 5:00PM. Schedule 2 uses Subscriber Mailbox 3 and runs Wednesday from 10:30AM to 5:00PM. Schedule 3 uses Routing Mailbox 4 and runs Tuesday from 9:00AM to 10:00AM. At all other times, routing is handled by the Default Mailbox specified in 47-11-03: Default Mailbox Category and 47-11-03: Default Mailbox Number.
2 - 446
J J J J J J J
When setting up Answer Tables with multiple types, build the Answer Schedules in the following order:
Range of Days Day of Week Date
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
2 - 447
Document Revision 1
Type 2 (Range of Days) Answer Schedule Options Type 2 (Range of Days) Example
In this example, Answer Table 1 routes calls as follows: Schedule 1 uses Routing Mailbox 1 and runs Sunday through Wednesday from 8:30AM to 5:00PM. Schedule 2 uses Routing Mailbox 2 and runs Thursday and Friday from 11:00AM to 1:00PM. At all other times, routing is handled by the Default Mailbox specified in 47-11-03: Default Mailbox Category and 47-11-03: Default Mailbox Number.
2 - 448
J J J J J J J
When setting up Answer Tables with multiple types, build the Answer Schedules in the following order:
Range of Days Day of Week Date
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
2 - 449
Document Revision 1
Type 3 (Date) Answer Schedule Options Type 3 (Date) Example In this example, Answer Table 1 routes calls as follows:
Schedule 1 uses Routing Mailbox 1 and runs every day from 8:30AM to 5:00PM. Schedule 2 uses Routing Mailbox 9 and runs only on Christmas day from 8:30AM to 5:00PM. At all other times, routing is handled by the Default Mailbox specified in 47-11-03: Default Mailbox Category and 47-11-03: Default Mailbox Number.
Answer Table 1 Answer Schedule 1 Answer Schedule 1 is a Range of Days schedule that starts schedule that runs every day from 8:30AM to 5:00PM. 47-12-01: Entry01 Schedule Type = 2 47-12-02: Entry01 MB Ctg = 3 47-12-02: Entry01 MB Num = 1 47-12-03: Entry01 Day = 1 (Entry does not matter) 47-12-04: Entry01 Start Day = 1 (Sunday) 47-12-05: Entry01 End Day = 1 (Sunday) 47-12-06: Entry01 Date (MMDD) = 0000 (Entry does not matter) 47-12-07: Entry01 Start Time = 0830 (8:30AM) 47-12-08: Entry01 End Time = 1700 (5:00PM) Answer Schedule 2 Answer Schedule 2 is a Date schedule that runs only on Christmas day from 8:30AM to 5:00PM. 47-12-01: Entry01 Schedule Type = 3 47-12-02: Entry01 MB Ctg = 3 47-12-02: Entry01 MB Num = 9 47-12-03: Entry01 Day = 1 (Entry does not matter) 47-12-04: Entry01 Start Day = 1 (Entry does not matter) 47-12-05: Entry01 End Day = 1 (Entry does not matter) 47-12-06: Entry01 Date (MMDD) = 1225 (December 25, Christmas day) 47-12-07: Entry01 Start Time = 0830 (8:30AM) 47-12-08: Entry01 End Time = 1700 (5:00PM)
2 - 450
J J J J J J
When setting up Answer Tables with multiple types, build the Answer Schedules in the following order:
Range of Days Day of Week Date
Type 3 (Date) Example
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 451
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-13 : IPK II In-Mail Dial Action Tables
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-13: IPK II In-Mail Dial Action Tables to set up the IPK II In-Mail Dial Action Tables. The Dial Action Table defines the options than an Automated Attendant caller can dial. A Dial Action Table is associated with a Call Routing Mailbox, which is in turn associated with an Answer Table. When an Answer Table is active, its associated Call Routing Mailbox selects the Dial Action Table which provides dialing options to callers. The illustration below shows how this works in a default IPK II In-Mail system. There are 16 Dial Action Tables.
DIL to Voice Mail Master (200) 22-01-01 Incoming Call Trunk Setup 22-07-01 DIL Setup
In-Mail
Default Automated Attendant Answering
Answer Table 1
47-11 Answer Table Options
All calls route to Call Routing Mailbox 1 Schedule 1 active M-F 8:30AM-5:00PM Default Mailbox active all other times
From a System Administrator mailbox, record an Instruction Menu (SA + I) for the active Call Routing Mailbox.
Dial Action Table 1 Dialing Options: Dial an extension number, or O for the operator
2 - 452
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
J J
Use this action to allow an Automated Attendant caller to place a Screened Transfer to an extension. After an Automated Attendant caller dials an extension, IPK II In-Mail calls (screens) the destination to see if the transfer can go through. If the destination is available, the Automated Attendant rings it. If the destination answers, the call goes through. If the destination does not answer within a preset interval, is busy, or is in Do Not Disturb, the Automated Attendant does not extend the call. It then provides the caller with additional options. Number Option Normally, the corresponding Number option should be XXX. Note that the key you choose for this action is the first digit of the called extension number.
For example, to allow callers to place Screened Transfers to extensions 301~399, for key 3 enter TRF for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Number.
To have Screened Transfer call a specific extension, the corresponding Number option should be that extensions number. The caller then dials that single digit to reach the extension.
For example, to have callers dial 8 to reach extension 303, for key 8 enter TRF for the Action and 303 for the corresponding Number. UTRF Action - Unscreened Transfer (2) (UTRF)
Use this action to allow an Automated Attendant caller to place an Unscreened Transfer to an extension. This is similar to telephone system unscreened transfers in which the transferring party immediately extends the call. After an Automated Attendant caller dials an extension, IPK II In-Mail transfers the call to the destination and hangs up. Any recalls or additional routing are handled by the telephone system - just as with any other unscreened transfer. Number Option Normally, the corresponding Number option should be XXX. Note that the key you choose for this action is the first digit of the called extension number.
For example, to allow callers to place Unscreened Transfers to extensions 301-399, for key 3 enter UTRF for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Number.
2 - 453
Document Revision 1
To have Unscreened Transfer call a specific extension, the corresponding Number option should be that extensions number. The caller then dials that single digit to reach the extension.
For example, to have callers dial 8 to reach extension 303, for key 8 enter UTRF for the Action and 303 for the corresponding Number. REC1 Action - Quick Message With Greeting (3) (REC1)
2 - 454
J J
Use this action to allow an Automated Attendant caller to leave a Quick Message at an extension. With this action, the caller will hear the extensions greeting prior to leaving the message. Number Options To have the caller leave a quick Message at a specific extension, the corresponding Number option should be the extension number. To have the caller leave a Quick Message at any caller-dialed extension, the corresponding Number option should be IXXX. To have the caller leave a Quick Message at a caller-dialed extension in a specific range, the corresponding Number option should be XXX.
For example, to allow callers to leave a Quick Message extensions 301~399, for key 3 enter REC1 for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Number. REC2 Action - Quick Message Without Greeting (4) (REC2)
Use this action to allow an Automated Attendant caller to leave a Quick Message at an extension. With this action, the caller will not hear the extensions greeting prior to leaving the message. Instead, the caller hears the voice prompt Recording followed by a beep. Number Option To have the caller leave a quick Message at a specific extension, the corresponding Number option should be the extension number. To have the caller leave a Quick Message at any caller-dialed extension, the corresponding Number option should be IXXX. To have the caller leave a Quick Message at a caller-dialed extension in a specific range, the corresponding Number option should be XXX.
For example, to allow callers to leave a Quick Message extensions 301~399, for key 3 enter REC2 for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Number.
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
J J
Use this key action to allow an Automated Attendant caller to log onto Voice Mail. Depending on programming (see Number Option below), the caller is logged directly into a Subscriber Mailbox or is prompted to enter a Subscriber Mailbox of their own choosing. You cannot use the LOGON option with Call Routing and Announcement Mailboxes. Number Option To log directly into a specific Subscriber Mailbox, enter the mailbox number in the corresponding Number option.
For example, to have key 4 log directly into Subscriber Mailbox 305, for key 4 enter LOGON for the Action and 305 for the corresponding Number.
To have IPK II In-Mail request Automated Attendant callers to select a Subscriber Mailbox to log into, enter N in the corresponding Number option. The key you choose must represent the first digit in the Subscriber Mailbox numbers.
For example, to have the Automated Attendant request callers to enter the number of the Subscriber Mailbox into which they wish to log, for key 3 enter LOGON for the Action and N for the corresponding Number. When callers dial 3, they hear, Please enter your mailbox number.
To have IPK II In-Mail require Automated Attendant callers to enter a Subscriber Mailbox to log into (without playing an announcement), enter XXX in the corresponding Number option. The key you choose must represent the first digit in the Subscriber Mailbox numbers.
For example, to allow callers to log onto mailboxes 301~399, for key 3 enter LOGON for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Number.
To log into any valid Subscriber Mailbox, enter IXXX in the corresponding Number option.
For example, to allow callers to dial 1 plus any Subscriber Mailbox number to log on, for key 1 enter LOGON for the Action and IXXX for the corresponding Number. Hang Up Action (6) (HNGUP)
When an Automated Attendant caller presses a key assigned to this action, IPK II In-Mail says Goodbye and immediately hangs up. Number Option There is no entry required in the corresponding Number Option.
2 - 455
Document Revision 1
2 - 456
J J
Use this option to provide Automated Attendant callers with the ability to route to Call Routing and Announcement Mailboxes. For example, a caller can dial a digit for Sales, and then go to the Call Routing or Announcement Mailbox that provides the dialing options and instructions for Sales. Number Option To have Automated Attendant callers dial a single digit to go to a Call Routing or Announcement Mailbox, enter the mailbox number in the corresponding Number option.
For example, to have key 1 go to Call Routing Mailbox 01, for key 1 enter GOTO for the Action and 01 for the corresponding Number.
To have IPK II In-Mail require Automated Attendant callers to enter a Call Routing or Announcement Mailbox to go to, enter XXX in the corresponding Number option. The key you choose must represent the first digit in the mailbox numbers.
For example, to allow callers to go to mailboxes 000-015, for key 0 enter GOTO for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Number.
To log into any valid Call Routing or Subscriber Mailbox, enter IXXX in the corresponding Number option.
For example, to allow callers to dial 1 plus any Call Routing or Announcement Mailbox number to go to, for key 1 enter GOTO for the Action and IXXX for the corresponding Number. UND Action - Undefined Routing (0) (UND)
Use this key action if you want a key to have no routing (no operation). When an Automated Attendant caller presses an undefined key, they hear, That is an invalid entry. The caller can then dial another option.
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Dial Action Table Number 01~16
Key No.
1 2 3 4 5 6
Additional Data
Entry : 0-9, #, and (8 digits max.) Use Dial Action Table digits to route an Automated Attendant call to a specific location (such as an extension). For example, to set up a TRF Action to route to extension 305, for digit 3 enter TRF for the Action and 305 for the corresponding Number. Entry : X (Entered by pressing LK2) Use the X option to route an Automated Attendant call based on digits the caller dials. Each X entry represents one caller-dialed digit. For example, to set up a TRF Action to route to any caller dialed extension in the 301399 range, for digit 3 enter TRF for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Number. Entry : I ( Entered by pressing LK3) Use the I option to represent any digit dialed by the Automated Attendant caller that IPK II In-Mail ignores for routing. An example of this is REC action assigned to the * key in Dial Action Table 1 by default. The Action is REC2 and the Number is IXXX. This means that a caller can dial * + any mailbox number to leave a Quick Message in that mailbox. IPK II In-Mail ignores the first digit dialed by the caller (*), and routes according to the next 3 digits dialed. Entry : N (Entered by pressing LK1) Use the N option when you want no Automated Attendant routing to automatically occur. This can be used with the LOGON action when you want to prompt the caller to enter a mailbox number. To do this for the # key (for example), for the # key enter LOGON for the Action and N for the corresponding Number. When the caller dials #, they hear, Please enter the mailbox number. Or, to exit, press the pound key. Pause Entry : P (Entered by pressing LK4) Use the P option when you want the Automated Attendant to pause while dialing. No Routing Ignore Digits Caller Dialed Digits
UTRF Action Unscreened Transfer (2) (UTRF) REC1 Action - Quick Message With Greeting (3) (REC1) REC2 Action - Quick Message Without Greeting (4) (REC2) LOGON Action - Log Onto Voice Mail (5) (LOGON) Hang Up Action (6) (HNGUP) GOTO Action - Go to Mailbox (7) (GOTO) UND Action - Undefined Routing (0) (UND)
8 9 0
#
TIMEOUT
H H
Digits
H H H H H H H
2 - 457
Document Revision 1
UND
(Undefined)
UND
(Undefined)
UTRF to XXXX 3
(Unscreened Transfer to user-dialed extension)
UND
(Undefined)
4 5 6 7 8 9 0
UND
(Undefined)
UND
(Undefined)
UND
(Undefined)
UND
(Undefined)
UND
(Undefined)
UND
(Undefined)
UND
(Undefined)
UND
(Undefined)
UND
(Undefined)
UND
(Undefined)
HNGUP
(Hangup)
UND
(Undefined)
UTRF to 101
(Unscreened Transfer to 101)
UND
(Undefined)
REC1 to IXXX
(Quick Message with greeting to user-dialed extension)
UND
(Undefined)
TIMEOUT
2 - 458
,
#
LOGON to IXXX
(Logon to user-dialed mailbox)
UND
(Undefined)
UTRF to 101
(Unscreened Transfer to 101)
UND
(Undefined)
J
Program 47 : In-Mail
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-14 : Master Directory Mailbox Options
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-14: Master Directory Mailbox Options to define the Master Directory Mailbox Options. This data will be referred if Program 47-03-03 (Master Mailbox Type) was set to Type 4 (Directory).
Input Data
Master Mailbox Number 1~16
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08
Item
Minimum Number of Letters Directory List Name Match
Input Data 1~3 1~8 0 = First 1 = Last 0 = TRF 1 = UTRF 0~255 0~99 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0~16
Default 1 1 0 0 15 5 0 0
Transfer Option
Screened Transfer Timeout Time Limit for Dialing Timeout Fax Detection
Conditions None
2 - 459
Document Revision 1
Program 47 : In-Mail
47-15 : Routing Directory Mailbox Options
Level: IN
Description
Use 47-15: Routing Directory Mailbox Options to define the Routing Directory Mailbox Options. This data will be referred if Program 47-07-02 (Routing Master Mailbox Type) was set to Type 4 (Directory).
Input Data
Master Mailbox Number 1~16
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08
Item
Minimum Number of Letters Directory List Name Match
Input Data 1~3 1~8 0 = First 1 = Last 0 = TRF 1 = UTRF 0~255 0~99 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0~16
Default 1 1 0 0 15 5 0 0
Transfer Option
Screened Transfer Timeout Time Limit for Dialing Timeout Fax Detection
Conditions None
2 - 460
Program 47 : In-Mail
Description
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
CCIS Availability
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 461
margorP
Use Program 50-01 : CCIS System Setting to set the availability of CCIS in the Electra Elite IPK II. All other CCIS settings will not function if this program is disabled.
50
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 50-02 : Connecting System Settings to define the settings for each CCIS Route ID.
Input Data
CCIS Route ID Route ID 1~8: CCIS via DTI Route ID 9: CCIS via IAD (IP-CCIS)
Item No. 01
Item
Port Number of Common Signaling Channel (DTI only) Common Signaling Channel Data Speed Assignment (DTI only)
Description
Specify the Trunk port to send D-channel information. This program is available for using DTI package. Assign the baud rate of Common Signaling Channel on DTI package.
Default 0
02
0 = 64Kbps 1 = 56Kbps 2 = 48Kbps(1) 3 = 48Kbps (2) 0~16367 0~16367 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0~4 (0 = No Setting)
03 04 05 06
Assign the Point code of own side. Assign the Point code of destination side on the DTI link. Calling name indication will not send to destination party if switch is turned to Disable.
0 0 1 0
2 - 462
Document Revision 1
Conditions
If 56K K-CCIS is used, 24 Multi-Frame (ESF) must be assigned in Program 10-03-02. DPC must be what the OPC is on the opposite side of the link.
H H
2 - 463
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 50-03 : CCIS Destination System Settings to assign remote system IP Network information.
Input Data
CCIS System ID 1~255
Item No. 01 02
Item
Destination Point Code CCIS Route ID
Description
Define the Point Code at the Destination Party. Select the CCIS Route ID defined in Program 14-13 when the user tries to access the system in a CCIS network. Assign the IP Address to a CCIS System ID.
Default 0 0
03
IP Address
0.0.0.0
Conditions None
2 - 464
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 50-04 : CCIS Office Code Assignment to define the Office Code when the CCIS Network is constructed with an Open Numbering Plan.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
CCIS Office Code
Default No Setting
Conditions
This program is only used in an Open Numbering Plan network. This should include the Trunk Access Code and Office Code number.
2 - 465
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 50-05 : CCIS Maximum Call Forwarding Hop Counter to define the maximum hop counter of call forwarding.
Input Data
Item
Maximum Hop Counter
Default 5
Conditions None
2 - 466
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 50-06 : CCIS Feature Availability to define the availability of CCIS features.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Link Reconnect
Default 1
Description If this data is set to 0, Link Reconnect will not run. If this data is turned to 0, Day/Night mode will not be changed even if system receives Switching message from center.
02
Conditions None
2 - 467
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 50-07 : CCIS Centralized Billing Center Office to define the Point Code and CCIS Route ID for the Billing Center Office.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Destination Point Code
Default 0
Description Define the Point Code of Billing Center Office. Define the CCIS Route ID to send Billing Center Office.
02
CCIS Route ID
0~8
Conditions None
2 - 468
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 50-08 : CCIS Centralized BLF Sending Group Assignment to define the destination of BLF for the sending system. Eight sending systems can be registered in this program.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Destination Point Code
Default 0
Description Define the Point Code of Billing Center Office. Define the CCIS Route ID to send Billing Center Office.
02
CCIS Route ID
0~8
Conditions None
2 - 469
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 50-09 : CCIS Centralized BLF Sending Extension Number Assignment to define the extension number for sending BLF messages. One extension number can have a sending switch for each sending group, which is defined in Program 50-08.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Extension Number
Default No Setting
Description Extension number. BLF message will be indicated when the status of the specified extension number is changed.
02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09
0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
2 - 470
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 471
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 50-10 : CCIS Centralized BLF Interval Time Assignment to define the interval time of sending BLF messages.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Type of Interval Time
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 472
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 50-11 : CCIS Centralized Day/Night Switching Sending Group Assignment to define Point Code and CCIS Route ID for sending Day/Night Switching message.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Destination Point Code
Default 0
Description Define the Point Code for Day/Night Switching. Define the CCIS Route ID to send Day/ Night Switching messages.
02
CCIS Route ID
0~8
Conditions None
2 - 473
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 50-12 : CCIS Centralized Day/Night Mode to System Mode Assignment to define corresponding night mode to switch to when Day/Night mode switching message arrives.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02
Day Mode Night Mode
Item
Default 1 2
Conditions None
2 - 474
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 50-13 : CCIS Response Timeout Assignment to define the response timer value.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
IAI Response Timer
Default 30
Conditions None
2 - 475
Document Revision 1
2 - 476
Description
Use Program 80-01 : Service Tone Setup to define up to 64 Service Tones. Each service tone is defined by the combination of 32 Basic Tones.
Input Data
Service Tone Number 01-64
Item No. 01
Item
Repeat Count
Unit Number
1~8
Item No. 02
Item
Basic Tone Number
Input Data 1~33 0 = No Tone 33=Default Time Slot 1~255 (100~25500ms) 1~63 (-15.5 ~ +15.5)
03 04
Duration Count
2 - 477
margorP
80
Document Revision 1
Default
Service Tone No. 1 2 3
Service Tone
No Tone Intercom Dial Tone Stutter Dial Tone
Repeat Count 0 0 0
Duration 10 10 2 1 1 1 1 77 1 1 10
4 5
2 0
Basic 2 Basic 1
2 - 478
Document Revision 1
Service Tone
Internal Busy Tone
Repeat Count 0 0
Duration 5 5 2 2 5 5 3 2 1 1 5 1 0 0 10 20 5 1 1 1 1 1 7 0 2 2 3 4 6 5 2 2 3 4 6 5 2 2 3 4 6 5
Gain Level (dB) 20 (-6dB) 20 (-6dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 20 (-6dB) 20 (-6dB) 20 (-6dB) 20 (-6dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 38 (+3dB) 26 (-3dB) 38 (+3dB) 26 (-3dB) 14 (-9dB) 32 (0dB) 38 (+3dB) 26 (-3dB) 38 (+3dB) 26 (-3dB) 14 (-9dB) 32 (0dB) 38 (+3dB) 26 (-3dB) 38 (+3dB) 26 (-3dB) 14 (-9dB) 32 (0dB)
DND Busy Tone and Selectable Display Message Tone Busy Tone
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
0 0 0 3 0 0 0 1 0 0
Basic 2 Basic 2 Basic 2 Basic 2 Basic 0 Basic 0 Basic 2 Basic 1 Basic 2 Basic 4
18 19
0 3
Basic 0 Basic 6
20
Basic 6
21
Basic 6
2 - 479
Document Revision 1
Service Tone
Door Box Chime 4
Repeat Count 3
Duration 1 1 2 2 3 2 1 1 2 2 3 2 1 1 2 2 3 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Gain Level (dB) 38 (+3dB) 26 (-3dB) 38 (+3dB) 26 (-3dB) 14 (-9dB) 32 (0dB) 38 (+3dB) 26 (-3dB) 38 (+3dB) 26 (-3dB) 14 (-9dB) 32 (0dB) 38 (+3dB) 26 (-3dB) 38 (+3dB) 26 (-3dB) 14 (-9dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB)
23
Basic 6
24
Basic 6
25 26 27 28
3 3 2 1
Talkback Tone
Speaker Monitor Tone This tone is what the originator hears when placing a handsfree speaker ICM call.
29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
1 1 2 1 2 3 1 0
0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 0 6 6 7 0
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 10 2 2
32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB)
Paging Tone
Splash Tone 1
Splash Tone 2
Splash Tone 3
2 - 480
Document Revision 1
Service Tone
Sensor Alarm Tone 2
Repeat Count 0 0 0
Duration 5 5 7 7 5 5 5 5 10 20 2 5 0 8 1 10 30 5 5 0 1 1
Gain Level (dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB)
40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48
Internal Call Waiting Tone Intrusion Tone Conference Tone Intrusion Tone 2 External Dial Tone External Ring Back Tone
1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0
External Busy Tone Voice Mail Message Waiting, Special Dial Stutter Dial Tone (Analog Sets)
49 50
10 12 0 12 4 12 12
10 2 30 3 2 3 10
51 52 53 54 55 56
0 1 1
2 1 1
External Call Waiting Tone External Executive Override Tone --- Not Used --Generate tone for TAPI2.1 Warning Beep Tone Signaling
0 1
Basic 1 Basic 1
3 2
0 8
32 (0dB) 32 (0dB)
2 - 481
Document Revision 1
Service Tone
Headset Ear Piece Ringing Tone
Repeat Count 0
Duration 2 1 1 1 20 2 2 2 2 2 2 6 4 2 2 2 2 2 2 6 4 1 1 1 1 1 1 10 30 0
Gain Level (dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 32 (0dB) 26 (-3dB) 8 (-12dB) 8 (-12dB) 8 (-12dB) 8 (-12dB) 8 (-12dB) 8 (-12dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB) 32 (0dB)
58
Basic 8
59
Basic 8
60 61 62 63 64
1 2 3 0 0
Conditions
The system must be reset in order for any changes to these items take affect.
2 - 482
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 80-02 : DTMF Tone Setup to define the duration (on time) and pause (off time) for DTMF dialing. This option affects all trunk line calls system wide. You make separate entries for duration and pause. It is also possible to adjust the level of both high and low frequency tone.
Item No. 01 02 03
Duration Pause Tone Level (Low) (dB)
Item
65 (-13dB)
04
1~97 -45 : +3
69 (-11dB)
Duration
Pause
2 - 483
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 484
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 80-03 : DTMF Tone Receiver Setup to define the various levels and timers for the DTMF Tone Receiver. DTMF Tone Receiver Type:
1 = DTMF Receiver for Extension 2 = DTMF Receiver for Trunk 3, 4, 5 = Reserved
J J J
Input Data
DTMF Tone Receiver Type No. 1 = DTMF Receiver for Extension 2 = DTMF Receiver for Trunk 3 = --- Reserve --4 = --- Reserve --5 = --- Reserve ---
2 - 485
Document Revision 1
Item No 01
Detect Level
Item
Input Data
0 = 0dBm ~ -25dBm 1 = -5dBm ~ -30dBm 2 = -10dBm ~ -35dBm 3 = -15dBm ~ -40dBm 4 = -20dBm ~ -45dBm 5 = -25dBm ~ -50dBm 6 = -30dBm ~ -55dBm 0~255 (0.25 ms ~ 64 ms) 0~15 detect level 0 : 10dBm(0) detect level 1 : 15dBm(0) detect level 2 : 20dBm(0) detect level 3 : 25dBm(0) detect level 4 : 30dBm(0) detect level 5 : 35dBm(0) detect level 6 : 40dBm(0)
02 03
04
0~15 detect level 0 : 0dBm(0) to 15dBm(15) detect level 1 : 5dBm(0) to 20dBm(15) detect level 2 : 10dBm(0) to 25dBm(15) detect level 3 : 15dBm(0) to 30dBm(15) detect level 4 : 20dBm(0) to 35dBm(15) detect level 5 : 25dBm(0) to 40dBm(15) detect level 6 : 30dBm(0) to 45dBm(15) 0~9 (1dB ~ 10dB) 0~9 (1dB ~ 10dB) 1~255 (15+ 15 ms ~ 3825 ms) 1-255 (15+ 15 ms ~ 3825 ms)
05 06 07 08
Forward twist level Backward twist level ON detect time OFF detect time
2 - 486
Document Revision 1
Default value
Item No 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 Item
Detect Level Start delay time Min. detect level Max. detect level Forward twist level Backward twist level ON detect time OFF detect time
Conditions None
2 - 487
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 80-04 : Call Progress Tone Detector Setup to define the various levels and timers for the Call Progress Tone Detector. Tone Detector Type:
1 = Dial Tone for Trunk 2 = Busy Tone for Trunk 3 = Ring Back Tone for Trunk 4, 5 = Reserved
Item No 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11
No tone time Pulse Count ON min. time ON max. time OFF min. time OFF max. time --- Reserve ----- Reserve ---
2 - 488
J J J J
Input Data
Tone Detector Type No. 1 = Dial Tone for Trunk 2 = Busy Tone for Trunk 3 = Ring Back Tone for Trunk 4 = --- Reserve --5 = --- Reserve ---
Item
Input Data
0~255 (30+30-7680ms) 1~255 1~255 (30+30-7680ms) 0~255 (30+30-7680ms) 1~255 (30+30-7680ms) 0~255 (30+30-7680ms) 0~8 0~8
Document Revision 1
Default values
Item 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 Name
Detect Level Min. detect level S/N ratio No tone time Pulse Count ON min. time ON max. time
Type1 (DT) 0 (-25dBm) 15 (-25dBm) 4 (-20dB) 132 (3990ms) 1 9 (300ms) 0 1 (60ms) 1 (60ms) 1 0
Type2 (BT) 0 (-25dBm) 15 (-25dBm) 4 (-20dB) 132 (3990ms) 1 9(300ms) 14(450ms)[ET] 9(300ms) 14(450ms) 1 0
Type3 (RBT) 0 (-25dBm) 15 (-25dBm) 4 (-20dB) 132 (3990ms) 1 25 (780ms) 40 (1230ms) 83 (2520ms) 115 (3480ms) 1 0
Type4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Type5 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
OFF min. time OFF max. time --- Reserve ----- Reserve ---
Conditions None
2 - 489
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 80-05 : Date Format for SMDR and System to define the date format when printing out the SMDR, alarm report, and system information, etc.
Item No. 01 Item
Date Format
Input Data
0 = American Format (Month / Day / Year) 1 = Japanese Format (Year / Month / Day) 2 = European Format (Day / Month / Year)
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 490
Description
Use Program 81-04 : ISDN BRI Layer 1 (T-Point) Initial Data Setup to define the various basic data for layer 1 of ISDN BRI.
Item No. 01 02 Item
Wait time for Physical activation (Timer 3) Detection time for Physical deactivation
Conditions None
2 - 491
margorP
81
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 81-05 : ISDN BRI & PRI Layer 2 (T-Point) Initial Data Setup to define the various basic data for layer 2 of ISDN BRI and PRI.
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 Item
Timer T200 Timer T201 Timer T202 Timer T203 N200 N201 N202
Input Data 1~255 (100~25500 ms) 1~255 (100~25500 ms) 1~255 (100~25500 ms) 1~255 (100~25500 ms) 1~255 1~65535 (Byte) 1~255
Conditions None
2 - 492
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 81-06 : ISDN BRI & PRI Layer 3 (T-Point) Timer Setup to define the various basic timers for layer 3 of ISDN BRI/PRI (defined in Program 10-03-04).
Input Data
Layer 3 Timer Type Number Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 1~5
Item
T301 T302 T303 T304 T305 T306 T307 T308 T309 T310 T312 T313 T314 T316 T317 T318 T319 T320 T321 T322
Input Data 0,180~254 (sec) 1~254 (sec) 1~254 (sec) 0~254 (sec). 1~254 (sec) 0~254 (sec) 1~254 (sec) 1~254 (sec) 1-254 (sec) 0~180 (sec) 1~254 (sec) 1~254 (sec) 1~254 (sec) (T317+1)~254 (sec) 1~(T316-1) 1~254 (sec) 1~254 (sec) 1~254 (sec) 1~254 (sec) 1~254 (sec)
Default 180 (sec) 15 (sec) 4 (sec) 30 (sec) 30 (sec) 30 (sec) 180 (sec) 4 (sec) 90 (sec) 180 (sec) 6 (sec) 4 (sec) 4 (sec) 120 (sec) 60 (sec) 4 (sec) 4 (sec) 30 (sec) 30 (sec) 4 (sec)
2 - 493
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 494
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 81-10 : COI Initial Data Setup to define the various basic timers for each COI trunk port.
Input Data
Trunk No. 1~ 200
Item No. 01
Item
DP Interdigit Time Selection The DP Interdigit Time is the minimum pause time between dial pulses. Use this Program to select either Pattern A or pattern B.
Input Data 0 = Pattern A (Pattern A: 10pps - 650 ms, 20pps - 500 ms) 1 = Pattern B (Pattern B: 10pps - 800 ms, 20pps - 800 ms) 1~13 (1~13 seconds) (0 = No Setting)
Default 1
02
Prepause Time Selection Specifies the loop open time for a hookflash signal sent to the CO or PBX when the Recall key on a multiline terminal is pressed. A Single Line Telephone (SLT) generates a hookflash to the CO or PBX line when a SLT hookflash is assigned.
9 (600 ms)
03
Incoming Signal Detect Time Selection Specifies the time after the incoming signal from another system is detected before the acknowledge signal is sent out.
3 (200 ms)
04
Disconnect Recognition Time Selection Specifies the minimum time before a disconnected circuit can be accessed again.
3 (300 ms)
05
Auto Release Signal Detection Time Specifies the signal detection time for release of a CO/PBX line after a disconnect signal is received from the distant CO or PBX.
7 (350 ms)
06
3 (200 ms)
2 - 495
Document Revision 1
07
0 = 20 ms 1 = 40 ms 2 = 60 ms 3 = 80 ms 4 = 100 ms 5 = 140 ms 6 = 160 ms 7 = 200 ms 8 = 400 ms 9 = 600 ms 10 = 800 ms 11 = 1.0 seconds 12 = 1.5 seconds 13 = 2.0 seconds 14 = 3.0 seconds 15 = 5.0 seconds 0 = 20 ms 1 = 40 ms 2 = 60 ms 3 = 80 ms 4 = 100 ms 5 = 140 ms 6 = 160 ms 7 = 200 ms 8 = 400 ms 9 = 600 ms 10 = 800 ms 11 = 1.0 seconds 12 = 1.5 seconds 13 = 2.0 seconds 14 = 3.0 seconds 15 = 5.0 seconds
9 (600 ms)
08
14 (3.0 sec.)
Conditions None
2 - 496
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 81-11 : Tie Line Initial Setup to define the various initial data for DID/ TLI/DTI packages.
Input Data
Trunk No. 1~ 200
Item No. 01
Item
DP Interdigit Time Selection The DP Interdigit Time is the minimum pause time between dial pulses. Use this Program to select either Pattern A or pattern B.
Input Data 0 = Pattern A (Pattern A: 10pps - 650 ms, 20pps - 500 ms) 1 = Pattern B (Pattern B: 10pps - 800 ms, 20pps - 800 ms) 1~4 (1~4 = 0.5~2.0 seconds) (5~15 = 3.0~13 seconds) (0 = No Setting)
Default 1
02
Prepause Time Selection Specifies the loop open time for a hookflash signal sent to the Tie Line when the Recall key on a multiline terminal is pressed. A Single Line Telephone (SLT) generates a hookflash to the Tie Line when a SLT hookflash is assigned.
9 (600 ms)
03
Tie Line Answer Detect Time Selection Specifies the time before an IPK II system answer (Off-Hook) is recognized as an answer.
4 (520 ms)
04
Tie Line Release Detect Time Selection Specifies the circuit disconnect detected on the Tie Line on the distant system side is recognized as Tie Line.
4 (520 ms)
05
Incoming Signal Detect Time Selection Specifies the time after the incoming signal from another system is detected before the acknowledge signal is sent out.
[Wink Start] 1~15 (130 ms~1950 ms) (0 = No Setting) [Delay] 1~15 (30 ms~450 ms) (0 = No Setting)
2 - 497
Document Revision 1
06
Loop Off-Guard Time Selection Assign loop off-guard time to prevent noise that could cause the system to be unable to answer an incoming Tie line.
1~4 (0.5 sec~2.0 sec) 5~15 (3 sec~13 sec) (0 = No Setting) 0~15 (30 ms~480 ms)
4 (2.0 sec)
07
Length of Wink Signal Selection Specifies the time a wink pulse is sent to another system.
5 (180 ms)
08
Length of Delay Signal Selection Specifies the time a delay pulse is sent to another system.
1 (300 ms)
09
Incoming Interdigit Timeout Selection To specify the time, in seconds, that an address signal is missing during the incoming call detection process before an error tone is returned to the other system.
6 (6 seconds)
10
Wink/Delay Signal Detect Timeout Selection To specify a maximum time, in seconds, for receiving an acknowledgment signal from a distant system before sending a busy tone.
7 (7 seconds)
11
Disconnect Recognition Time Selection Specifies the minimum time before a disconnected circuit can be accessed again.
3 (0.3 second)
12
Automatic Release Signal Detection Selection Specifies the signal detection time for release of a Tie Line after a disconnect signal is received from the distant CO or PBX.
7 (350 ms)
13 14
1~15 (500~7500 ms) 0 = 20 ms 1 = 40 ms 2 = 60 ms 3 = 80 ms 4 = 100 ms 5 = 140 ms 6 = 160 ms 7 = 200 ms 8 = 400 ms 9 = 600 ms 10 = 800 ms 11 = 1.0 seconds 12 = 1.5 seconds 13 = 2.0 seconds 14 = 3.0 seconds 15 = 5.0 seconds
2 - 498
Document Revision 1
15
0 = 20 ms 1 = 40 ms 2 = 60 ms 3 = 80 ms 4 = 100 ms 5 = 140 ms 6 = 160 ms 7 = 200 ms 8 = 400 ms 9 = 600 ms 10 = 800 ms 11 = 1.0 seconds 12 = 1.5 seconds 13 = 2.0 seconds 14 = 3.0 seconds 15 = 5.0 seconds
14 (3.0 sec.)
Conditions None
2 - 499
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 81-12 : Trunk Gain Level Data Setup to define the various initial data for TLI/DTI/DID/BRT/PRT package.
Input Data
Trunk Number 1~200
Item No. 01 02 03 04
Item
Internal Transmit Gain Level Internal Receive Gain Level External (tandem) Transmit Gain Level External (tandem) Receive Gain Level
Input Data 0 = +2dB 1 = +4dB 2 = +6dB 3 = +8dB 4 = +12dB 5 = +16dB 6 = +3dB 7 = -3dB 8 = 0dB
Conditions None
2 - 500
Description
Input Data
Incoming Ringing Tone Number 1 = Pattern 1 (Trunk Incoming) 2 = Pattern 2 (Trunk Incoming) 3 = Pattern 3 (Trunk Incoming) 4 = Pattern 4 (Trunk Incoming) 5 = Intercom Incoming Pattern
1 = High 2 = Mid 3 = Low
Item No. 01 02
Item
Frequency 1 Frequency 2
Input Data
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 = = = = = = = 520Hz 540Hz 660Hz 760Hz 1100Hz 1400Hz 2000Hz
2 - 501
margorP
Use Program 82-01 : Incoming Ring Tone to set the incoming ring tones, which are the tones a user hears when a call rings an extension. These tones are grouped into four ring tone Ranges (1~4), also called patterns, that consist of a combination of frequencies. (You assign a specific Range to trunks in Program 22-03 and to extensions in Program 15-02.) Within each Range there are three frequency Types: High, Middle and Low. (Service Code 820 allows users to choose the Type for their incoming calls.) Each Type in turn consists of two frequencies and the modulation played simultaneously to make up the tone. These frequencies are determined by their Frequency Number selected in Items 1 and 2 (see below). In this program, you assign the two Frequency Numbers and Modulation for each Type, for each of the four Ranges. The chart below shows the default Frequency Numbers for each Type in each Range.
82
Document Revision 1
Item No. 03
Item
Modulation
Input Data
0 1 2 3 = = = = No Modulation 8Hz Modulation 16Hz Modulation Envelope
Default
Incoming Ringing Tone Number Pattern 1 (Trunk Incoming) Pattern 2 (Trunk Incoming) Pattern 3 (Trunk Incoming) Pattern 4 (Trunk Incoming) Intercom Incoming Pattern Tone Type High Mid Low High Mid Low High Mid Low High Mid Low High Mid Low High Mid Low Frequency 1 1100 660 520 1100 660 520 2000 1400 1100 2000 1400 1100 1100 660 520 760 760 760 Frequency 2 1400 760 660 1400 760 660 760 660 540 760 660 540 1400 760 660 760 760 760 Modulation 16Hz Modulation 16Hz Modulation 16Hz Modulation 8Hz Modulation 8Hz Modulation 8Hz Modulation 16Hz Modulation 16Hz Modulation 16Hz Modulation 8Hz Modulation 8Hz Modulation 8Hz Modulation 8Hz Modulation 8Hz Modulation 8Hz Modulation No Change No Change No Change
Conditions None
2 - 502
J J
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 82-03 : DSS Console LED Pattern Setup to define the LED patterns for special functions on a DSS console.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 Item
ACD Log In ACD Log Out ACD Emergency Call
Default 1 4 3
2 - 503
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 504
Document Revision 1
Description
Program 82-08 : Sidetone Volume Setup allows adjust of the keyset sidetone volume.
There are two levels, based on whether the connected trunk is a digital trunk or analog trunk.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Description
Sidetone Volume
Input 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Digital Sidetone Level -54 (dB) -48 (dB) -42 (dB) -36 (dB) -30 (dB) -24 (dB) -18 (dB) -12 (dB) -12 (dB) -12 (dB)
Analog Sidetone Level -54 (dB) -54 (dB) -54 (dB) -48 (dB) -42 (dB) -36 (dB) -30 (dB) -24 (dB) -18 (dB) -12 (dB)
Conditions None
J J
2 - 505
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 82-11 : SLI Initial Setup to define the various timers for SLI Packages.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Bounce Protect Time
Description
Specify a time for detection of a valid 0ff-Hook indication that is long enough to prevent an unintentional bounce of the receiver from being detected as a new Off-Hook indication from a Single Line Telephone. Specify the minimum hookflash time from a Single Line Telephone or analog Voice Mail system before it is detected as the beginning of a valid hookflash. Specify the maximum hookflash duration from a Single Line Telephone to receive a second dial tone.
Default 3
02
03
Conditions None
2 - 506
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 82-12 : OPX Initial Data to define the various initial data for OPX packages.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Bounce Protect Time
Description
Specify a time for detection of a valid 0ff-Hook indication that is long enough to prevent an unintentional bounce of the receiver from being detected as a new Off-Hook indication from a Single Line Telephone. Specify the minimum hookflash time from a Single Line Telephone or analog Voice Mail system before it is detected as the beginning of a valid hookflash. Specify the maximum hookflash duration from a Single Line Telephone to receive a second dial tone.
Default 3
02
03
Conditions None
2 - 507
Document Revision 1
2 - 508
Description
Use Program 83-11: Wireless DECT Configuration to define the Wireless DECT options.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Location Area Level Use this program to define the location area whether the Base Stations/RFPs are all in the same area or whether each Base Station in located in a different area.
0 1
Input Data
= Whole Area = Each Different
Default
0 (Whole Area)
02
Authentication This program enables (1) or disables (0) the authentication procedure for the phone when placing and receiving calls.
0 1
= Disabled = Enabled
1 (Enabled)
03
Encryption This program enables (1) or disables (0) encryption for the phone when placing and receiving calls.
0 1
= Disabled = Enabled
1 (Enabled)
Conditions None
2 - 509
margorP
83
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 83-12 : Wireless DECT Measurement to define the Wireless DECT Base Station measurement.
Input Data
Item No. 01
DECT Measurement This program measures the length of cables connecting the PCB and Base Stations so that the system can find the best signal transmitting timing for handover. Enter Program 83-12-01, press 1 then HOLD. The system will then restart all Base Stations/RFPs (this takes 3-5 minutes) and then they will use the best timing possible. This program should be used any time the Base Station configuration is changed (adding or deleting Base Stations or changing connecting cables).
Item
Default No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 510
Description
Use Program 84-03 : IP Phone Information Basic Setup to define the details of IP Terminals and Adapters.
Input Data
Terminal Type
1 = Dterm IP / Electra Elite IPK II Multiline Terminal with IP Adapter 2 = Soft Phone 3 = Bundle IP Phone
Item No. 06
Area
Item
0 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 = = = = = = : : :
Input Data
Japan USA Australia EU Asia Other Country Invalid IP Precedence Diffserve
Default 1
Description
07
08
Type of Service
0x00-0xff (use line keys 1~6 for letters A~F) 0~65535 0~255
C0
This data will be sent to IP Phone Terminal when IP Phone Terminal is registered.
10 11
5029 5
2 - 511
margorP
84
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 512
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 84-04 : VoIP DHCP Server Mode Setup to enable or disable the DHCP server on the CPU II( )-U10.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
DHCP Server Mode
Input Data
0 1 = Disable = Enable
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 513
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 84-05 : VoIP Address Setup to define the IP Address of the IP Applications (MG16 ETU, CCISoIP ETU).
Input Data
Slot Number 01~24
Item No. 01
Description
IP Address Set IP Address of IP Application. The IP Address will be increased in accordance with the slot number.
Input Data
1.0.0.1126.255.255.254 128.1.0.1191.254255.254 192.0.1.1223.255.254.254
Default
Slot 1: 172.16.0.20 Slot 2: 172.16.0.21 Slot 3: 172.16.0.22 Slot 4: 172.16.0.23 Slot 5: 172.16.0.24 Slot 6: 172.16.0.25 Slot 7: 172.16.0.26 Slot 8: 172.16.0.27 Slot 9: 172.16.0.28 Slot 10: 172.16.0.29 Slot 11: 172.16.0.30 Slot 12: 172.16.0.31 Slot 13: 172.16.0.32 Slot 14: 172.16.0.33 Slot 15: 172.16.0.34 Slot 16: 172.16.0.35
Related Program
02
0 = Auto Detect 1 = 100 Mbps, Full Duplex 2 = 100 Mbps, Half Duplex 3 = 10 Mbps, Full Duplex 4 = 10 Mbps, Half Duplex
03
Master/Slave
0 = Slave 1 = Master
2 - 514
Document Revision 1
04
Slot 1~24
255.255.0.0
05
Slot 1~24
0.0.0.0
Conditions
The system programming must be exited before these program options to take affect. When configuring the CCISoIP IP Application the IAD(8)-U10 ETU must be reset for system data to take affect.
H H
2 - 515
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 84-06 : VoIP Info to set up threshold levels of the MG16 ETU.
Input Data
Slot Number 01~24
Item No. 01 02 03 04
Item
RTP Port Number RTCP Port Number
Description
0~4294967295 ms
The data will be sent to the CPUII if the value exceeds the defined value. The data will be sent to the CPUII if the value exceeds the defined value. The data will be sent to the CPUII if the value exceeds the defined value. The data will be sent to the CPUII if the value exceeds the defined value. The data will be sent to the CPUII if the value exceeds the defined value. The data will be sent to the CPUII if the value exceeds the defined value.
05
0~4294967295
06
0~4294967295
07
Jitter Threshold
0~4294967295 (sec)
08
0~4294967295
09
0~4294967295
2 - 516
Document Revision 1
Conditions
The system programming must be exited before these program options take affect.
2 - 517
Document Revision 1
Description
(For Future Release) Use Program 84-09 : VLAN Setup to setup the VLAN data.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 Item VLAN VLAN ID Priority Input Data
0 = Disable (Off) 1 = Enable (On)
Default 0 0 0
1~4094 0~7
Conditions
The system programming must be exited before these program options take affect.
2 - 518
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 84-10 : ToS Setup to setup the ToS data.
Input Data
Protocol Type 1 = CPU 2 = MGC 3 = MEGACO 4 = Voice Control 5 = RTP/RTCP 6 = Not Used 7 = CCISoIP
Item No. 01
Item
ToS Mode
Input Data
0 = Disable (Invalid) 1 = IP Precedence 2 = Diffserv
Default 0
Description
Note: When Input Data is set to 1, Item No. 07 is invalid. When Data is set to 2, Item No. 02 ~ 06 are invalid. 1 = Router queing priority
02
Priority, IP Precedence
0~7
0 = Low 7 = High
03
Low Delay
0~1
0 = Normal Delay, Low Delay
1 = Optimize for low delay routing 1 = Optimize for high bandwidth routing 1 = Optimize for reliability routing 1 = Optimize for low cost routing DSCP (Differentiated Services Code Point)
04
0~1
0 = Normal Throughput 1 = High Throughput
05
High Reliability
0~1
0 = Normal Reliability 1 = Low Reliability
06
Low Cost
0~1
0 = Normal Cost 1 = Low Cost
07
0~63
2 - 519
Document Revision 1
Conditions
The system needs to be reset in order for these program options to take affect.
2 - 520
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 84-11 : Dterm IP CODEC Information Basic Setup to set voice (RTP packet) encoding parameters.
Input Data
Type 1-5
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
Item
G711 Audio Frame G711 VAD Mode G711 Type G.711 Jitter Buffer Min G.711 Jitter Buffer Type G.711 Jitter Buffer Max G.729 Audio Frame G.729 VAD Mode G.729 Jitter Buffer Min G.729 Jitter Buffer Type G.729 Jitter Buffer Max --- Not Used ----- Not Used ----- Not Used ----- Not Used ----- Not Used ---
Input Data 3 0: Disable 1: Enable 0: A-law 1: u-law 0~145 ms 0~145 ms 0~145 ms 1~4
0 = Disable 1 = Enable
Description
2 - 521
Document Revision 1
Item No. 17 18
Item
Jitter Buffer Mode VAD Threshold
Input Data
1 2 = Static = Immediate
Default 2 20
Description
0~30 (-19db~+10db, Adaptec Threshold) 0 = Adaptec Threshold 1 = -19db(-49dbm) : 20 = 0db (-30dbm) : 29 = 9dbm(-21dbm) 30 = 10dbm(-20dbm) 0 1 0 1 = Disable = Enable = Disable = Enable
20 22 26
1 0 14
Non-Linear Processing Mode
27
RX Gain
14
28 29 30 31
Audio Capability Priority --- Not Used --Echo Auto Check Sum Mode
0: G711_PT 2: G729_PT
0 1
2 - 522
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 523
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 84-21 : CCIS over IP CODEC to set the various CCIS over IP CODEC parameters.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
G.711 Audio Frame G.711 Type
Item
1~2
Input Data
0 = A-law 1 = u-law 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0~200 ms 0~200 ms 0~200 ms 1~3 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0~500 ms 0~500 ms 0~500 ms 1~2 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0~500 ms 0~500 ms 0~500 ms
G.711 Jitter Buffer Min G711 Jitter Buffer Average G.711 Jitter Buffer Max G.729 Audio Frame G.729 VAD Mode
G729 Jitter Buffer Min G729 Jitter Buffer Average G729 Jitter Buffer Max G.723 Audio Frame G.723 VAD Mode
G723 Jitter Buffer Min G723 Jitter Buffer Average G.723 Jitter Buffer Max
2 - 524
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 17
TX Gain
Item
Input Data
0~28 (-14dbm ~ +14dbm) 0 = -14 dbm 1 = -13 dbm : 14 = 0 dbm : 27 = +13 dbm 28 = +14 dbm 0~28 (-14dbm ~ +14dbm) 0 = -14 dbm 1 = -13 dbm : 14 = 0 dbm : 27 = +13 dbm 28 = +14 dbm 0 = G711 PT 1 = G723 PT 2 = G729 PT 0 = G711 PT 1 = G723 PT 2 = G729 PT 0 = VoIPU 1 = RFC2833 1 = Static 2 = Immediate 0 = -20dbm (-50dbm) 1 = -19dbm (-49dbm) : 20 = 0dbm (-30dbm) : 29 = +9dbm (-21dbm) 30 = +10dbm (-20dbm) 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable
Default 10
18
RX Gain
10
19
20
21 22 23
0 2 20
VAD Threshold
24 25 26
1 1 1
2 - 525
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 526
Description
Use Program 85-01 : HUB(8) LAN Setup to define the LAN setup for each slot.
1~24 0~8
Item No. 01
Item
Auto Negotiation
Input Data
0 = Enable 1 = Disable
Default 0
Description
When enabled, Link Speed, Duplex and MDI/ MDIX setting are negotiated with the other connected device. 85-01-01 - Disable
02 03 04
Link Speed
1 1 2
85-01-01 - Disable
Auto MDI/MDIX
When 85-01-01 is enabled, Auto MDI/MDIX will function. Auto MDI/ MDIX (Media Dependent Interface / Media Dependent Interface Cross-over) enables a switch port to sense the appropriate transmit/ receive pairs of an Ethernet cable. 85-01-01 - Disable, 85-03-01 - Half Duplex When enabled, a switch applies back pressure to a half-duplex ingress port while an output queue is congested.
05
0 = Disable 1 = Enable
2 - 527
margorP
Input Data
85
Document Revision 1
06
0 = Disable 1 = Enable
Full Duplex - 802.3x 85-01-01 - Disable 85-03-01 - Full Duplex When enabled, a switch applies flow control to a full-duplex ingress port while an output queue is congested.
Conditions None
2 - 528
Document Revision 1
Description
(For Future Release) Use Program 85-02 : HUB(8) VLAN Setup to define the VLAN setup for each HUB(8) ETU. The KSU can support up to 16, 802.1q VLANs (numbered 1 - 16). Program Block 85-02 assigns supported VLAN IDs, with a range of 1 - 4095. At default, 802.1q support is disabled. If Program Block 85-02-01 is set to ENABLE, 802.1q VLAN tagging is supported. 85-02-02 through 85-02-09 establish the default VLAN for ports 1 ~ 8 of the HUB(8).
Input Data
Hub Slot 1~24
Item No. 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09
Item
VLAN Mode
Input Data 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 1~4095 1~4095 1~4095 1~4095 1~4095 1~4095 1~4095 1~4095
Default 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Port 1 VLAN ID Port 2 VLAN ID Port 3 VLAN ID Port 4 VLAN ID Port 5 VLAN ID Port 6 VLAN ID Port 7 VLAN ID Port 8 VLAN ID
2 - 529
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 530
Document Revision 1
Description
(For Future Release) Use Program 85-03 : Priority Setup to establish the queuing prioritization rules for the low and high priority queues. Each port has a low and a high priority queue for both ingress and an egress. These queues serve to buffer packets during times of heavy network traffic. The HUB(8) supports 802.1q/p layer 2 Quality of Service.
Input Data
Hub Slot Hub Port 1~24 0~8
Item No. 01
Item
Default Priority
Input Data
0 = Disable 2 = Low 3 = High
Default 0
Description Assigns untagged frames to either the Low or the High queue, and tags them with a priority assigned in Program 85-03-03 (High) or Program 85-03-04 (Low). RX High establishes the minimum threshold for frames designated for the high priority queues. When Program 85-0301 is set to "High", untagged frames are marked with this priority setting. Previously tagged frames are unchanged.
02
RX High
0~7
03
TX High
0~7
2 - 531
Document Revision 1
04
TX Low
0~7
When Program 85-0301 is set to "Low", untagged frames are marked with this priority setting. Previously tagged frames are unchanged.
Conditions None
2 - 532
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 85-04 : Port Mirroring Setup to define the port mirroring for each HUB(8) ETU. This permits traffic from one port to be simultaneously transmitted to a second port. Port mirroring is typically used for debugging with a protocol analyzer.
Input Data
Hub Slot 1~24
Item No. 01 02 03
Item
Port Mirroring
Default 0 1 1
Description
Source Port
Set to the port to be monitored. Set to the port where the protocol analyzer is connected.
Target Port
Conditions
2 - 533
Document Revision 1
Description
(For Future Release) Use Program 85-05 : HUB(8) VLAN Group Settings to define the VLAN group setup for each HUB(8) ETU.
Input Data
Slot VLAN Group 1~24 00~15
Item No. 01 02
Item
VLAN ID Port
Default 0 00000000
Description 802.1q VLAN ID Represents the eight physical ports of the HUB(8), numbered from left to right as 8 to 1. Setting a port to "1" enables the port to allow traffic from the VLAN ID specified in Program 85-05-01. Represents the eight physical ports of the HUB(8), numbered from left to right as 8 to 1. At the point of egress, should VLAN tags be retained or removed? (Many Ethernet devices do not process VLAN tagged packets.) Setting a port to "1" permits VLAN tags to be retained.
03
00000000~11111111
00000000
2 - 534
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
2 - 535
Document Revision 1
2 - 536
Description
Use Program 90-01 : Installation Date to define the installation date of system.
Item No. 01 02 03
Item
Year Month Day
Conditions None
2 - 537
margorP
Input Data
90
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-02 : Programming Password Setup to set the system passwords. For password entry purposes, the system allows eight users to be defined. Each user can have a:
Unique alphanumeric name (up to 10 alphanumeric characters long) Password entry of up to 8 digits (using 0~9, # and ) Password level
The IN level password is used by the System Installer for system programming purposes. The SA or SB level password cannot access the IN level programs. The reverse type (white on black) just beneath the Description heading is the programs access level. You can only use the program if your access level meets or exceeds the level the program requires. (SA level password can access to SA or SB programs, and SB level password can access to SB programs only.)
Before changing your numbering plan, use the PC Programming or Web Programming to make a backup copy of your systems data.
Input Data
User Number 1~8
Item No. 01 02 03
Item
User Name Password User Level
Input Data Maximum 10 characters Up to 8 digits 0 = Prohibited User 1 = MF (Manufacturer Level) 2 = IN (Installer Level) 3 = SA (System Administrator Level 1) 4 = SB (System Administrator Level 2)
2 - 538
NOITUAC
J J J
Document Revision 1
Default
User No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 User Name
necii
Level Description
Manufacturer Level - Access to all system programs. Installer Level - Access to all programs IN level programs. System Administrator Level 1 - Restricted Access System Administrator Level 2 - More Restricted Access
tech
ADMIN1
ADMIN2
--- Not Used ----- Not Used ----- Not Used ----- Not Used ---
Conditions
2 - 539
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 90-03 : Save Data to save the programmed data on the SRAM and Flash ROM to the 16M/32M ATA removable Compact Flash memory card. This program should be used after changing the programmed data.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Save Data
Conditions
When reloading a customer database, the system must be reset (either using Program 90-08 or power down/power up) before all uploaded programming will take affect.
2 - 540
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 90-04 : Load Data to load the system data from the inserted Compact Flash Memory to the SRAM and Flash ROM in the system.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Load Data
Conditions
After uploading the programming, reset the system and wait a few minutes for the system to reset completely before accessing any lines or special system features. Otherwise, some unusual LED indications may be experienced.
2 - 541
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 90-05 : Slot Control to reset or delete (uninstall) circuit boards (slots 1~24). Delete allows you to completely uninstall the ETU. You might want to do this if you want to remove an ETU and plug it into a different slot - and still retain the port assignments. If a different type of interface ETU is being installed into a slot previously used (e.g., changing from a SLI to an ESI ETU), the slot should be deleted (option 1) first before installing the new interface ETU. Reset allows you to send a reset code.
Input Data
Menu Number
1 = Delete 2 = Reset
Item No. 01
Item
Slot Control
Conditions
When you delete or reset a ETU, you must first remove it from its slot then run Program 90-05. When reusing the slot for another ETU, you must plug the ETU in or reset the system before the system will use the slot again.
2 - 542
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 90-06 : Trunk Control is used for the trunk maintenance. Busy Out lets you block a ETU from placing outgoing calls (just like placing the ETU switch down). Once busied out, none of the ports on the ETU can be used for new calls. Existing calls, however, are not torn down.
Input Data
Menu Number
0 = Set Busy Out 1 = Reset/Release Busy Out (idle)
Item No. 01
Item
Trunk Control
Conditions None
2 - 543
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 90-07 : Extension Control is used for the extension maintenance.
Input Data
Menu Number
1 = Hardware Reset 2 = Software Reset
Item No. 01
Item
Extension Control
Conditions None
2 - 544
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 90-08 : System Reset is used to perform a system reset.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
System Reset
Conditions
After restoring a customer database, the system must be reset using Program 9008 or by powering down/powering up before all the restored programming will take affect.
2 - 545
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-09 : Automatic System Reset Time to define the time the system will automatically reset.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 04
Note 1
Item
Month Day Hour Minute
Default 0 0 0 0
If the Month is set to 00 and Day has been set, the system will automatically be reset every month of the predefined day. If the Day is set to 00 and the Time (Hour and Minute) has been set, the system automatically resets every day of the predefined time.
Note 2
Conditions None
2 - 546
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-10 : System Alarm Setup to assign a status to system alarms. You can designate an alarm as Major or Minor. This program also assigns whether or not the alarm is displayed to a multiline terminal and whether or not the alarm information is reported to the pre-defined destination.
Input Data
Alarm Number 001~100
Item No. 01
Item
Alarm Type
Input Data
0 = Not Set 1 = Major Alarm 2 = Minor Alarm 0 = Not Report (No autodial) 1 = Report (autodial)
02
Report
Default
Alarm 1 TYPE
2 (Minor)
Report 0
Note
Board Initialization Error
Is Used To Advise of . . .
Initialization failure or the ETU is defective.
Action
Remove and reinstall the ETU. If RECover message is received in the alarm report, the ETU is good. If not, replace with a new ETU. Remove and reinstall the ETU. If RECover message is received in the alarm report, the ETU is good. If not, replace with a new ETU.
2 (MIN)
2 - 547
Document Revision 1
Alarm 3
TYPE
2 (MIN)
Report 0
Note
Board Installation Error
Is Used To Advise of . . .
ETU was unplugged without using the proper procedure. ETU communication failure has occurred.
Action
Check the ETU installation.
2 (MIN)
Remove and reinstall the ETU. If RECover message is received in the alarm report, the ETU is good. If not, replace with a new ETU. After unblocking the ETU, if RECover message is received in the alarm report, it is corrected. If not, then replace the system flash card.
Download Error
Download may have failed because the ETU is blocked (disabled) or the sub-program does not exist on the system flash card.
6 7
0 1 (Major)
0 0
-- Not Used -Power Failure System power supply may be defective or commercial power is off. Check the system AC switch, fuse and AC outlet. If still faulty, replace the power supply. Check the battery connector. If it is connected correctly, then replace the battery. Check the terminal wiring and reconnect properly. Then unplug and plug in the ETU. If RECover message is received in the alarm report, it is correct. If not, replace the ETU and/or terminal.
1 (MAJ)
Failure may have occurred because: Terminal blocking detected. Terminal is unplugged. Wire is disconnected. DSTU card is defective.
10 11 12 13 :
0 0 0 0 :
0 0 0 0 :
2 - 548
H H H H
Document Revision 1
Alarm 30 31 : 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 : 50 51 52 53 : 100
TYPE
2 (MIN)
Report 0 0 : 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 : 0 0 0 0 : 0
:
Note
SMDR Buffer Full
Is Used To Advise of . . .
The SMDR buffer is full.
Action
Check the printer for the SMDR.
0 : 0 0
CS Blocking CS Error Information 1 CS Transmission Error CSIU Dch Error CSIU Transmission Error CS Error Information 2
0 0
0 : 0 0 0 0 : 0
VM/HD
Conditions None
2 - 549
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-11 : System Alarm Report to define the details of the system alarm report.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
System Alarm Display Telephone Assign the display multiline extension number that should receive system alarms.
Input Data
Extension Number (Up to 8 digits)
Default
No Setting
02
Report Method When alarm reports are to be EMailed, set this option to 1.
03 04 05 06
--- Not Used ----- Not Used ----- Not Used --SMTP Host Name When alarm reports are to be EMailed, set the SMTP name (ex: smtp.yourisp.com). Contact your ISP (internet service provider) for the correct entry if needed. Up to 255 Characters No Setting
07
SMTP Host Port Number When alarm reports are to be EMailed, set the SMTP host port number. Contact your ISP (internet service provider) for the correct entry if needed.
0~65535
25
08
To EMail Address When alarm reports are to be EMailed, set this EMail address to which the report should be sent.
Up to 255 Characters
No Setting
09
Reply Address When alarm reports are to be EMailed, set this EMail address to which any replies should be EMailed.
Up to 255 Characters
No Setting
10
From Address When alarm reports are to be EMailed, set this EMail address from which the report is being sent.
Up to 255 Characters
No Setting
2 - 550
Document Revision 1
Input Data
Item No. 11
DNS Primary Address When alarm reports are to be EMailed, set the DNS primary address.
Item
Input Data
0.0.0.0-255.255.255.255
Default
0.0.0.0
12
DNS Secondary Address When alarm reports are to be EMailed, set the DNS secondary address.
0.0.0.0-255.255.255.255
0.0.0.0
13
Customer Name When alarm reports are to be EMailed, enter a name which will be used to identify the particular system.
Up to 255 Characters
No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 551
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-12 : System Alarm Output to set the options for the alarm report. This program has 6 separate menu options. Define the output port to be used as the output for system alarm report and set the system alarm options. The system can have up to 50 reports.
Input Data
Item No. 01
Output Port Type Indicate the type of connection used for the System Alarms. The baud rate for the COM port should be set in Program 10-21-02.
Item
Input Data
0 = No Setting 1 = COM port (CPUII) 2 = USB port (CPUII) 3 = -- Reserve -4 = CTA/CTU
Default 0
02
Destination Extension Number If the output port type (item 1) is set to CTA, enter the extension number with the CTA connection.
No Setting
03 04 05 06
Output All Alarm Reports Printout New Alarm Reports Clear All Alarm Reports Output Mode
Print All? (Yes = 1) Print New? (Yes = 1) All Clear? (Yes = 1) 0 = Manual 1 = Auto
Conditions None
2 - 552
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-13 : System Information Output to define the output port to be used as the system information output. The baud rate for the COM port should be set in Program 10-21-02.
Input Data
Item No. 01
Output Port Type Indicate the type of connection used to print the system information.
Item
Input Data
0 = No Setting 1 = COM port (CPUII) 2 = USB port (CPUII) 3 = LAN Port (CPUII) 4 = CTA/CTU
Default 0
02
Destination Extension Number If the output port type (item 1) is set to CTA, enter the extension number with the CTA connection.
No Setting
03
Output Command Dialing 1 from this program sends the system report to the connected device.
Conditions None
2 - 553
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-16 : Main Software Information to display the main software information on the CPUII. Main software information can also be viewed outside of system programming by pressing FEATURE and the 3 key on any multiline terminal.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 Item
Version Number
Data
01.00~99.99
Component
ASCII Code (5 Byte) ASCII Code (20 Byte)
Conditions None
2 - 554
Document Revision 1
Description
When the extension number is entered in Program 90-19 : Dial Block Release, the extension will be released from the Dial Block restriction.
Input Data
Extension Number Up to 8 digits
Item No. 01
Item
Dial Block Release
Conditions None
2 - 555
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-20 : Traffic Report Data Setup to define the details of the traffic report.
Input Data
Item No. 01 02 03 Item
Call Traffic Output
Input Data
0 = Not measured 1 = Measure
Default 0
--- Not Used --All Line Busy Output 0 = Not detected 1~256 (Report when the data is reached to the defined value)
04 05 06 07 08 09 10
DTMF Receiver Busy Output Dial Tone Detector Busy Output Caller ID Receiver Busy Output Voice Mail Channel All Busy Output ACD Operator All Busy Output Attendant Channel All Busy Output Base Station All Busy Output
0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Conditions None
2 - 556
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-21 : Traffic Report Output to define the output port to be used as the traffic report output.
Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Output Port Type
Input Data
0 = No Setting 1 = COM port (CPUII) 2 = USB port (CPUII) 3 = LAN Port (CPUII)
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 557
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 90-23 : Deleting Registration of IP Telephones to delete the registered IP telephone from the system.
Input Data
Extension Number Up to 8 digits
Item No. 01
Item
Delete IP Telephone
Conditions None
2 - 558
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-24 : System Alarm Report Notification Time Setup to set up when the alarm report will print.
Input Data
Notification Number 1~12
Item No. 01 02 03 04
Item
Month
Default 0 0 0 0
Conditions None
2 - 559
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-25 : System Alarm Report CC Mail Setup to define the mail address to receive the system alarm report CC Mail setup.
Input Data
CC Number 1~5
Item No. 01
Item
CC Mail Address
Default No Setting
Conditions None
2 - 560
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-26 : Program Access Level Setup to define the password access level required to change a system program.
Input Data
Program Numbers 1001~9201
Item No. 01
Item
Maintenance Level
Input Data
1 = MF Level 2 = IN Level 3 = SA Level 4 = SB Level
Default
Refer to the Level indication for each individual program (located in the upper left corner at the beginning of each program).
Conditions None
2 - 561
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 90-27 : Wireless DECT System ID to define the DECT System ID.
Item No. 01 Item
System ID
Conditions None
2 - 562
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-31 : DIM Access over Ethernet to enable DIM (Diagnostic Information Maintenance) access over the LAN, and to define the user name and password. DIM is a maintenance tool used by engineering to extract trace level information.
Item No. 01 02 03 Item
Access Enabling
Username
Password
Conditions None
2 - 563
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 90-34 : Firmware Information to list the package type and firmware ETUs installed in the system.
Input Data
Slot No. 1~24
Item No. 01 02
Pkg Name
Item
Conditions None
2 - 564
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 90-34 : Wizard Programming Level Setup to set the maintenance level for Wizard Programming.
Item No. 01 Item
Maintenance Level
Display Data 0 = All 1 = SB (System Administrator B) 2 = SA (System Administrator A) 3 = IN (Installer) 4 = MF (Manufacturer) 5 = DEV (Developer)
Default 0
Conditions None
2 - 565
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 90-35 : Firmware Update Time Setting to define the data for the firmware update feature. This data is available to set for the Web/PC Programming FW update feature. A compact flash card must be inserted in the CPUII for this feature. The following firmware is available to update with this feature:
main.bin Dspdbu.bin dsp.bin intradbu.bin
Item No. Item Input Data Year: 0~99 Month: 0~12 01
Firmware Update Schedule Time
2 - 566
J J J J
Description This Program sets the time to update the firmware using a compact flash card. Time registration will fail if a time is registered that has expired.
02
Update mode
This Program activates the Firmware Update feature. If this setting is 1 (Activated), new firmware on the compact flash card will update according to the setting at 90-36-01.
Document Revision 1
Item No. 03
Item
Update Report
Default No Setting
Description This Program will output a report when the update is executed. This report will save one report on the system. If a new update occurs, the new report will overwrite the old report. Refer to Sample Report shown.
Result
Update Success Update Fail Update Fail Update Fail
Report Display
Update is successful with the Update Time. Update failed. Drive 'A' (Compact Flash) was not available. Update failed. The file main.up does not exist on drive 'A'. Update failed. The scheduled time has expired.
Sample Report
Conditions None
2 - 567
Document Revision 1
2 - 568
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Program 91-06 : DECT Obtaining Access Rights is used when registering an Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT phone to the system. You can select the port number to which the new phone will be subscribed, or you can enter 0 to have the system automatically assign an available port. This program is also used to enter the IPEI number assigned to the phone. Possible error messages seen while in this program are detailed below. Refer to Phone Subscribing in the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT Manual for complete details on subscribing a telephone.
Prompt Rejected Canceled Canceled by Timer DECT has Not Worked Already Subscribed No Port to Subscribe Used by Port xxx Meaning The subscription procedure was rejected. You stopped the subscription procedure before it completed by pressing HOLD. The subscription procedure took longer than 10 minutes. The DSIU ETU is not working. The port number chosen it in use by another terminal. There are no available port numbers. The Electra Elite IPK II DECT Wireless telephone which has the IPEI you entered is subscribed to another port.
2 - 569
margorP
91
Document Revision 1
Conditions None
4.
The IPEI number is the 13-digit serial number which is located on the label in the phones battery compartment.
5.
The display shows the port number assigned to the telephone and the 4-digit AC (Authentication Code) number. DO NOT PRESS HOLD at this point or the subscription will be cancelled. Using the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT phone to be registered, press the Menu key then press the left arrow key twice to display the Login option. Press OK. Press the Right Arrow key once to display the Subscription Create option. Press OK. The Wireless phone will search for the DSIU ETU and display the ETU ID number once found.
This may take a few seconds. If the ID number does not appear, check Program 90-27-01 to make sure the ETU is recognized.
6.
7. 8.
2 - 570
J
1. 2. 3.
select
To have the system automatically assign a port number to the telephone, press 0 then HOLD. This assigns an available port within the range of 256~512. To manually select a port number, enter an available port number (002~512) then press HOLD.
The display shows IPEI?. The IPEI (International Portable Equipment Identity) is a unique number embedded into each Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT phone.
Enter the IPEI number for the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT telephone or enter as a wild character and the system will automatically retrieve the number for the phone being set up. Press HOLD. When the display shows Ready?(1:Yes), press 1 then HOLD.
Document Revision 1
9. 10. 11.
Press OK. Enter the 4-digit AC number displayed in Step 4 (Program 91-06-01) and press OK. Once the telephone has been registered, the telephone will beep and (((.))) appears in the lower left-hand corner. Program 91-06-01 shows COMPLETED. Press HOLD and register another telephone if required or continue with the next step.
Prior to deleting an Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT phone from the system using Program 91-07-01 : DECT Deleting Access Rights, make sure the DSIU ETU is installed in the system. If the DSIU is removed when Program 91-07-01 is run, the system will retain the DECT setting. This will prevent the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT telephone(s) from being registered in the system again.
12.
Press MSG until you have exited that series programming section.
2 - 571
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 91-07 : DECT Deleting Access Rights to remove an Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT phone from the system.
2 - 572
J
Prior to deleting an Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT phone from the system, make sure the DSIU ETU is installed in the system. If the DSIU is removed when Program 91-07-01 is run, the system will retain the DECT setting. This will prevent the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT telephone(s) from being registered in the system again. Input Data
Item No. 01 Item
Wireless Subscription, Delete Delete one or all Wireless phones on the system. You can delete an individual phone by entering its port number or you can remove all the Wireless phones by entering 0.
Input Data
Port Number or 0 to remove all Electra Elite IPK II Wireless DECT telephones.
Default -
Conditions None
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 92-01 : Copy Program to copy the data for one program to another multiline terminal, port, group, etc. Refer to the following charts to see which programs can be copied.
Input Data
Program Number XX-XX
Item No. 01
Source Number
Item
Input Data
In case of Trunk Base : Trunk Port Number 1~8 or 1~200 In case of Trunk Group Base : Trunk Group Number 1~8 or 1~100 In case of Extension Base : Extension Number (up to 8 digits) In case of Department Group Base : Department Group Number 1~8 or 1~64 In case of DSS : DSS Console Number 1~4 or 1~32
Destination Number (From) Enter the first extension, trunk, group, etc. number to which the information is to be copied. Destination Number (To) Enter the last extension, trunk, group, etc. number to which the information is to be copied. If the information is only be copied to one extension, trunk, group, etc., enter the information entered in the Destination Number (From) entry.
Enter the extension, trunk, group, etc. from which the data will be copied.
2 - 573
margorP
92
H H H H
Document Revision 1
Note
Copy all data except Trunk Name (Item 01).
Analog Trunk Data Setup Behind PBX Setup Music on Hold Source for Trunks Conversation Recording Destination for Trunk Trunk Group Routing for Trunks ISDN Calling Party Number Setup for Trunk Incoming Service Type Setup Trunk Ring Tone Setup IRG Assignment for Normal Ring Trunk Second IRG Setup for Unanswered DIL / IRG Incoming Ring Tone Audible on External Speaker
Note
Extension Base
Program No. 15-01 15-02 15-03 15-04 15-06 15-07 15-08 Program Name
Extension Basic Data Setup (include Virtual Extension) Multiline Telephone Basic Data Setup Single Line Telephone Basic Data Setup PHS Terminal Basic Data Setup Trunk Access Map for Extension Programmable Function Key Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Setup Copy Item 11, 12, and 13.
Note
Copy all data except extension name (item 01).
2 - 574
Document Revision 1
Program No. 15-09 15-10 15-11 15-12 15-18 20-06 21-02 21-04 21-11 23-02 23-03 23-04 24-03 31-02
Program Name
Virtual Extension Ring Assignment Incoming Virtual Extension Ring Tone Order Setup Virtual Extension Delayed Ring Assignment Conversation Recording Destination for Extension Virtual Extension Key Enhancement Options Class of Service for Extension Trunk Group Routing for Extensions Toll Restriction Class for Extensions Hotline Assignment Call Pickup Groups Ringing Line Preference Ringing Line Preference for Virtual Extensions Park Group Assignment Internal Paging Group Assignment
Note
Note
Copy all data except Group Name (Item 01).
Note
2 - 575
Document Revision 1
Note
Conditions
Using this program to copy a multiline terminals Programmable Function Keys will copy all the keys whether they exist on the phone to which the programming is being copied. This may cause confusion when trying to define a key which is already defined but which does not exist on the phone (will display as DUPLICATE DATA). It is recommend to either clear these non-existent keys or to only copy from an extension which has the same or fewer number of keys than the extension to which the programming is being copied.
2 - 576
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 92-02 : Delete All Extension Numbers to delete all extension numbers. However, the extension number of the first port is not deleted.
Input Data
Extension No. Delete Yes: 1 [Dial 1]+Hold key (Only press Hold key is canceled)
Conditions None
2 - 577
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 92-03 : Copy Program by Port Number to delete all extension numbers. However, the extension number of the first port is not deleted.
Item No. 01 02 03
Source Number
Item
Input Data Enter the port number from which the data will be copied. Enter the first port number to which the information is to be copied. Enter the last port number to which the information is to be copied. If the information is only to be copied to one port, enter the information entered in the Destination Number (From) entry.
Conditions None
2 - 578
Document Revision 1
Description
(This program is available only via telephone programming and not through PC Programming). Use Program 92-04 : Extension Data Swap to swap two extensions data.
Item No. 01 02 Item
1st Extension Number
Input Data
Up to 8 characters.
2nd Extension Number
Conditions None
2 - 579
Document Revision 1
Description
Use Program 92-04 : Extension Data Swap Password to define the 4-digit password for each extension to allow Extension Data Swap.
Item No. 01
Password
Item
Conditions None
2 - 580
LAUNA GNIMMARGOR
M